WO2003020876A2 - Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type b polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof - Google Patents

Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type b polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2003020876A2
WO2003020876A2 PCT/US2002/021342 US0221342W WO03020876A2 WO 2003020876 A2 WO2003020876 A2 WO 2003020876A2 US 0221342 W US0221342 W US 0221342W WO 03020876 A2 WO03020876 A2 WO 03020876A2
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
seq
ceu
polypeptide
vector
expression
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2002/021342
Other languages
French (fr)
Other versions
WO2003020876A3 (en
Inventor
Jan Zur Megede
Susan W. Barnett
Ying Lian
Original Assignee
Chiron Corporation
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Chiron Corporation filed Critical Chiron Corporation
Priority to JP2003525580A priority Critical patent/JP2005521380A/en
Priority to EP02746891A priority patent/EP1427806A4/en
Priority to CA2458995A priority patent/CA2458995C/en
Priority to AU2002316578A priority patent/AU2002316578A1/en
Publication of WO2003020876A2 publication Critical patent/WO2003020876A2/en
Publication of WO2003020876A3 publication Critical patent/WO2003020876A3/en

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K14/00Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K14/005Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from viruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/12Viral antigens
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/12Viral antigens
    • A61K39/21Retroviridae, e.g. equine infectious anemia virus
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • A61P31/18Antivirals for RNA viruses for HIV
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • A61P37/04Immunostimulants
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/63Introduction of foreign genetic material using vectors; Vectors; Use of hosts therefor; Regulation of expression
    • C12N15/79Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts
    • C12N15/85Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts for animal cells
    • C12N15/86Viral vectors
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K2039/51Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies comprising whole cells, viruses or DNA/RNA
    • A61K2039/53DNA (RNA) vaccination
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2740/00Reverse transcribing RNA viruses
    • C12N2740/00011Details
    • C12N2740/10011Retroviridae
    • C12N2740/16011Human Immunodeficiency Virus, HIV
    • C12N2740/16022New viral proteins or individual genes, new structural or functional aspects of known viral proteins or genes
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2740/00Reverse transcribing RNA viruses
    • C12N2740/00011Details
    • C12N2740/10011Retroviridae
    • C12N2740/16011Human Immunodeficiency Virus, HIV
    • C12N2740/16041Use of virus, viral particle or viral elements as a vector
    • C12N2740/16043Use of virus, viral particle or viral elements as a vector viral genome or elements thereof as genetic vector
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2740/00Reverse transcribing RNA viruses
    • C12N2740/00011Details
    • C12N2740/10011Retroviridae
    • C12N2740/16011Human Immunodeficiency Virus, HIV
    • C12N2740/16051Methods of production or purification of viral material
    • C12N2740/16052Methods of production or purification of viral material relating to complementing cells and packaging systems for producing virus or viral particles
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2740/00Reverse transcribing RNA viruses
    • C12N2740/00011Details
    • C12N2740/10011Retroviridae
    • C12N2740/16011Human Immunodeficiency Virus, HIV
    • C12N2740/16111Human Immunodeficiency Virus, HIV concerning HIV env
    • C12N2740/16134Use of virus or viral component as vaccine, e.g. live-attenuated or inactivated virus, VLP, viral protein
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2740/00Reverse transcribing RNA viruses
    • C12N2740/00011Details
    • C12N2740/10011Retroviridae
    • C12N2740/16011Human Immunodeficiency Virus, HIV
    • C12N2740/16211Human Immunodeficiency Virus, HIV concerning HIV gagpol
    • C12N2740/16222New viral proteins or individual genes, new structural or functional aspects of known viral proteins or genes
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2740/00Reverse transcribing RNA viruses
    • C12N2740/00011Details
    • C12N2740/10011Retroviridae
    • C12N2740/16011Human Immunodeficiency Virus, HIV
    • C12N2740/16211Human Immunodeficiency Virus, HIV concerning HIV gagpol
    • C12N2740/16234Use of virus or viral component as vaccine, e.g. live-attenuated or inactivated virus, VLP, viral protein
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2800/00Nucleic acids vectors
    • C12N2800/10Plasmid DNA
    • C12N2800/108Plasmid DNA episomal vectors
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2830/00Vector systems having a special element relevant for transcription
    • C12N2830/42Vector systems having a special element relevant for transcription being an intron or intervening sequence for splicing and/or stability of RNA
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2840/00Vectors comprising a special translation-regulating system
    • C12N2840/20Vectors comprising a special translation-regulating system translation of more than one cistron
    • C12N2840/203Vectors comprising a special translation-regulating system translation of more than one cistron having an IRES

Definitions

  • TECHNICAL FIELD Polynucleotides encoding antigenic HIV polypeptides (e.g., those shown in
  • ADDS Acquired immune deficiency syndrome
  • HIN Human Immunodeficiency Nirus
  • Gag gene products include, but are not limited to, Gag-polymerase and Gag- protease.
  • Env gene products include, but are not limited to, monomeric gpl20 polypeptides, oligomeric gpl40 polypeptides and gpl60 polypeptides.
  • HIN-1 Gag proteins of HIN-1 are necessary for the assembly of virus-like particles. HIN-1 Gag proteins are involved in many stages of the life cycle of the virus including, assembly, virion maturation after particle release, and early post-entry steps in virus replication. The roles of HIN-1 Gag proteins are numerous and complex (Freed, E.O., Virology 251:1-15, 1998).
  • the present invention relates to improved HIV expression cassettes.
  • the present invention relates to generating an immune response in a subject using the expression cassettes of the present invention.
  • the present invention relates to generating an immune response in a subject using the expression cassettes of the present invention, as well as, polypeptides encoded by the expression cassettes ofthe present invention.
  • the present invention relates to enhanced vaccine technologies for the induction of potent neutralizing antibodies and/or cellular immune responses against HIV in a subject.
  • the present invention relates to synthetic polynucleotides and/or expression cassettes encoding HIV polypeptides, including, but not limited to, Env, Gag, Pol, RT, Int, Prot, Vpr, Vpu, Vif, Nef, Tat, Rev and/or fragments or combinations thereof.
  • the present invention also relates to improved expression of HIV polypeptides and production of virus-like particles.
  • Synthetic expression cassettes encoding the HIV polypeptides e.g., Gag-, pol-, protease (prot)-, reverse transcriptase, integrase, RNAseH, Tat, Rev, Nef, Vpr, Vpu, Vif and/or Env- containing polypeptides
  • HIV polypeptides e.g., Gag-, pol-, protease (prot)-, reverse transcriptase, integrase, RNAseH, Tat, Rev, Nef, Vpr, Vpu, Vif and/or Env- containing polypeptides
  • Exemplary synthetic polynucleotides include, but are not limited to, GagComplPolmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:9), GagComplPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 10), GagComplPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 11), gagCpolInaTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 12), GagPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 13), GagPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 14), GagProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 15), GagProtInaRTmutTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 16), GagRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 17), GagTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 18), gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod (SEQ ID NO: 19), gpl40.modSF162.Cwt
  • an expression cassette typically include an HIV- polypeptide encoding sequence inserted into an expression vector backbone.
  • an expression cassette comprises a polynucleotide sequence encoding one or more polypeptides, wherein the polynucleotide sequence comprises a sequence having between about 85% to 100% and any integer values therebetween, for example, at least about 85%, preferably about 90%, more preferably about 95%, and more preferably about 98% sequence identity to the sequences taught in the present specification.
  • polynucleotides encoding the HIV polypeptides of the present invention may also include sequences encoding additional polypeptides.
  • additional polynucleotides encoding polypeptides may include, for example, coding sequences for other viral proteins (e.g., hepatitis B or C or other HIV proteins, such as, polynucleotide sequences encoding an HIV Gag polypeptide, polynucleotide sequences encoding an HIV Env polypeptide and/or polynucleotides encoding one or more of vif, vpr, tat, rev, vpu and nef); cytokines or other transgenes.
  • viral proteins e.g., hepatitis B or C or other HIV proteins, such as, polynucleotide sequences encoding an HIV Gag polypeptide, polynucleotide sequences encoding an HIV Env polypeptide and/or polynucleotides
  • the sequence encoding the HIV Pol polypeptide(s) can be modified by deletions of coding regions corresponding to reverse transcriptase and integrase. Such deletions in the polymerase polypeptide can also be made such that the polynucleotide sequence preserves T-helper cell and CTL epitopes. Other antigens of interest may be inserted into the polymerase as well.
  • an expression cassette comprises a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide, for example, GagComplPolmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:9), GagComplPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 10), GagComplPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 11), gagCpolInaTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 12), GagPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 13), GagPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ TD NO: 14), GagProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 15), GagProtInaRTmutTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 16), GagRTmut.SF2, (SEQ ID NO: 17) GagTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 18), gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod (SEQ TD NO: 19),
  • the native and synthetic polynucleotide sequences encoding the HIV polypeptides of the present invention typically have between about 85% to 100% and any integer values therebetween, for example, at least about 85%, preferably about 90%, more preferably about 95%, and more preferably about 98% sequence identity to the sequences taught herein. Further, in certain embodiments, the polynucleotide sequences encoding the HIV polypeptides of the invention will exhibit 100% sequence identity to the sequences taught herein.
  • polynucleotides of the present invention can be produced by recombinant techniques, synthetic techniques, or combinations thereof.
  • the present invention further includes recombinant expression systems for use in selected host cells, wherein the recombinant expression systems employ one or more of the polynucleotides and expression cassettes of the present invention.
  • the polynucleotide sequences are operably linked to control elements compatible with expression in the selected host cell.
  • control elements include, but are not limited to, the following: transcription promoters, transcription enhancer elements, transcription termination signals, polyadenylation sequences, sequences for optimization of initiation of translation, and translation termination sequences.
  • Exemplary transcription promoters include, but are not limited to those derived from CMV, CMV+intron A, SV40, RSV, HIV-Ltr, MMLV-ltr, and metallothionein.
  • the invention includes cells comprising one or more of the expression cassettes ofthe present invention where the polynucleotide sequences are operably linked to control elements compatible with expression in the selected cell.
  • such cells are mammalian cells.
  • Exemplary mammalian cells include, but are not limited to, BHK, VERO, HT1080, 293, RD, COS-7, and CHO cells.
  • insects e.g., Trichoplusia ni (Tn5) and Sf9
  • bacteria e.g., Bacillus subtilis
  • yeast e.g., Bacillus subtilis
  • antigen presenting cells e.g., macrophage, monocytes, dendritic cells, B-cells, T-cells, stem cells, and progenitor cells thereof
  • primary cells e.g., immortalized cells, tumor-derived cells.
  • the present invention includes compositions for generating an immunological response, where the composition typically comprises at least one of the expression cassettes ofthe present invention and may, for example, contain combinations of expression cassettes such as one or more expression cassettes carrying a Pol-derived-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotide, one or more expression cassettes carrying a Gag-derived-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotide, one or more expression cassettes carrying accessory polypeptide-encoding polynucleotides (e.g., native or synthetic vpu, vpr, nef, vif, tat, rev), and/or one or more expression cassettes carrying an Env-derived-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotide.
  • expression cassettes such as one or more expression cassettes carrying a Pol-derived-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotide, one or more expression cassettes carrying a Gag-derived-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotide, one
  • compositions may further contain an adjuvant or adjuvants.
  • the compositions may also contain one or more HIV polypeptides.
  • the HIV polypeptides may correspond to the polypeptides encoded by the expression cassette(s) in the composition, or may be different from those encoded by the expression cassettes.
  • various expression cassettes of the present invention can be mixed and/or matched with various HIV polypeptides described herein.
  • the present invention includes methods of immunization of a subject. In the method any of the above described compositions are into the subject under conditions that are compatible with expression of the expression cassette(s) in the subject.
  • the expression cassettes (or polynucleotides o the present invention) can be introduced using a gene delivery vector.
  • the gene delivery vector can, for example, be a non-viral vector or a viral vector.
  • Exemplary viral vectors include, but are not limited to eucaryotic layered vector initiation systems, Sindbis-virus (or other alphavirus) derived vectors, retroviral vectors, and lentiviral vectors.
  • Other exemplary vectors include, but are not limited to, pCMVK ⁇ , ⁇ CMV6a, pCMV-link, and pCMVPLEdhfr.
  • compositions useful for generating an immunological response can also be delivered using a particulate carrier (e.g., PLG or CTAB-PLG microparticles). Further, such compositions can be coated on, for example, gold or tungsten particles and the coated particles delivered to the subject using, for example, a gene gun. The compositions can also be formulated as liposomes. In one embodiment of this method, the subject is a mammal and can, for example, be a human.
  • a particulate carrier e.g., PLG or CTAB-PLG microparticles
  • Such compositions can be coated on, for example, gold or tungsten particles and the coated particles delivered to the subject using, for example, a gene gun.
  • the compositions can also be formulated as liposomes.
  • the subject is a mammal and can, for example, be a human.
  • the invention includes methods of generating an immune response in a subject.
  • Any of the expression cassettes described herein can be expressed in a suitable cell to provide for the expression of the HIN polypeptides encoded by the polynucleotides of the present invention.
  • the poly ⁇ eptide(s) are then isolated (e.g., substantially purified) and administered to the subject in an amount sufficient to elicit an immune response.
  • the methods comprise administration of one or more of the expression cassettes or polynucleotides of the present invention, using any of the gene delivery techniques described herein.
  • the methods comprise co-administration of one or more ofthe expression cassettes or polynucleotides of the present invention and one or more polypeptides, wherein the polypeptides can be expressed from these polynucleotides or can be other HIN polypeptides.
  • the methods comprise co- administration of multiple expression cassettes or polynucleotides of the present invention.
  • the methods comprise co-administration of multiple polypeptides, for example polypeptides expressed from the polynucleotides of the present invention and/or other HIV polypeptides.
  • the invention further includes methods of generating an immune response in a subject, where cells of a subject are transfected with any of the above-described expression cassettes or polynucleotides of the present invention, under conditions that permit the expression of a selected polynucleotide and production of a polypeptide of interest (e.g., encoded by any expression cassette of the present invention).
  • a polypeptide of interest e.g., encoded by any expression cassette of the present invention.
  • Transfection of the cells may be performed ex vivo and the transfected cells are reintroduced into the subject. Alternately, or in addition, the cells may be transfected in vivo in the subject.
  • the immune response may be humoral and/or cell-mediated (cellular).
  • this method may also include administration of an HIV polypeptides before, concurrently with, and/or after introduction of the expression cassette into the subject.
  • the polynucleotides of the present invention may be employed singly or in combination.
  • the polynucleotides ofthe present invention, encoding HIV-derived polypeptides may be expressed in a variety of ways, including, but not limited to the following: a polynucleotide encoding a single gene product (or portion thereof) expressed from a promoter; multiple polynucleotides encoding a more than one gene product (or portion thereof) (e.g., polycistronic coding sequences); multiple polynucleotides in-frame to produce a single polyprotein; and, multiple polynucleotides in-frame to produce a single polyprotein wherein the polyprotein has protein cleavage sites between one or more of the polypeptides comprising the polyprotein.
  • Figures IA to ID depict the nucleotide sequence of HIV Type C 8_5_TV1_C.ZA ( SEQ ED NO:l; referred to herein as TV1). Various regions are shown in Table A.
  • Figures 2 A-C depicts an alignment of Env polypeptides from various HIV isolates (SF162, SEQ ID NO:2; TV1.8_2, SEQ TD NO:3; TV1.8_5, SEQ ID NO:4; TV2.12-5/1, SEQ ID NO:5; Consensus Sequence, SEQ TD NO:6).
  • the regions between the arrows indicate regions (of TVl and TV2 clones, both HIV Type C isolates) in the beta and/or bridging sheet region(s) that can be deleted and/or truncated.
  • the "*" denotes N-linked glycosylation sites (of TVl and TV2 clones), one or more of which can be modified (e.g., deleted and/or mutated).
  • Figure 3 presents a schematic diagram showing the relationships between the following forms of the HIV Env polypeptide: gpl60, gpl40, gpl20, and gp41.
  • Figure 4 presents exemplary data concerning transactivation activity of Tat mutants on LTR-CAT plasmid expression in 293 cells.
  • Figure 5 presents exemplary data concerning export activity of Rev mutants monitored by CAT expression.
  • FIG. 6 sheets 1 and 2 presents the sequence of GagComplPolmut.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:9).
  • FIG 8 sheets 1 and 2 presents the sequence of GagComplPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 11).
  • Figure 9 sheets 1 and 2 presents the sequence of gagCpolInaTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 12).
  • FIG 11 sheets 1 and 2 presents the sequence of GagPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 14).
  • FIG 12 sheets 1 and 2 presents the sequence of GagProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 15).
  • FIG. 13 sheets 1 and 2 presents the sequence of GagProtInaRTmutTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 16).
  • Figure 14 sheets 1 and 2 presents the sequence of GagRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 16).
  • Figure 15 presents the sequence of GagTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ED NO: 18).
  • Figure 16 presents the sequence of gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod (SEQ ED NO: 19).
  • Figure 17 presents the sequence of gpl40.modSF162.CwtLnat (SEQ ED NO:20).
  • Figure 18 presents the sequence of gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut7 (SEQ ID NO:21).
  • Figure 19 presents the sequence of gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut8 (SEQ ED NO:22).
  • Figure 20 presents the sequence of int.opt.mut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:23).
  • Figure 21 presents the sequence of int.opt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:24).
  • Figure 22 presents the sequence of nef.D125G.-myr.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:25).
  • Figure 23 presents the sequence of nef.D107G.-myrl8.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:26).
  • Figure 24 presents the sequence of nef. o ⁇ t.D125G.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:27).
  • Figure 25 presents the sequence of nef.opt.SF162 (SEQ TD NO:28).
  • Figure 26 presents the sequence of pl5RnaseH.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:29).
  • Figure 27 presents the sequence of p2Pol.opt.YMWM.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:30).
  • Figure 28 presents the sequence of p2PoUnaopt.YM.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:31).
  • Figure 29 presents the sequence of ⁇ 2Polopt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:32).
  • Figure 30 presents the sequence of p2PolTatRevNef.opt.native_B (SEQ ED NO:33).
  • Figure 32 presents the sequence of pol.opt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:35).
  • Figure 33 presents the sequence of prot.opt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:36).
  • Figure 34 presents the sequence of protIna.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:37).
  • Figure 35 presents the sequence of ⁇ rotInaRT.YM.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:38).
  • Figure 36 presents the sequence of protInaRT.YMWM.opt.SF2 (SEQ HD
  • Figure 37 presents the sequence of ProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:40).
  • Figure 38 presents the sequence of protRT.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:41).
  • Figure 39 presents the sequence of ProtRT.TatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ED NO:42).
  • Figure 40 presents the sequence of ProtRTTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ED
  • Figure 41 presents the sequence of rev.exonl_2.M5-10.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:44).
  • Figure 42 presents the sequence of rev.exonl_2.opt.SFl 62 (SEQ ID NO:45).
  • Figure 43 presents the sequence of RT.opt.SF2 (mutant) (SEQ ED NO:46).
  • Figure 44 presents the sequence of RT.opt.SF2 (native) (SEQ ED NO:47).
  • Figure 45 presents the sequence of RTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:48).
  • Figure 46 presents the sequence of tat.exonl_2.opt.C22-37.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:49).
  • Figure 47 presents the sequence of tat.exonl_2.opt.C37.SF2 (SEQ TD ).
  • Figure 48 presents the sequence of TatRevNef.opt.native.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:51).
  • Figure 49 presents the sequence of TatRevNef.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:52).
  • Figure 50 presents the sequence of TatRevNefGag B (SEQ ED NO:53).
  • Figure 51 presents the sequence of TatRevNefgagCpoUna B (SEQ ID NO:54).
  • FIG 52 sheets 1 and 2 presents the sequence of TatRevNefGagProtlnaRTmut B (SEQ ID NO:55).
  • Figure 53 presents the sequence of TatRevNefp2Pol.opt_B (SEQ ID NO:56).
  • Figure 54 presents the sequence of TatRevNefprotRTopt B (SEQ ED NO:57).
  • Figure 55 presents the sequence of vif.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:58).
  • Figure 56 presents the sequence of vpr.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:59).
  • Figure 57 presents the sequence of vpu.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:60).
  • Figure 58 presents the sequence of gpl40modSF162.GM135-154-186-195
  • Figure 59 presents the sequence of gpl40modSF162.GM154 (SEQ TD NO:62).
  • Figure 60 presents the sequence of g ⁇ l40modSF162.GM154-186-195 (SEQ ID NO:63).
  • Figure 61 presents the sequence of gpl40mut7.modSF162.GM154 (SEQ ID NO:63).
  • Figure 62 depicts alignment of amino acid sequences of various Env glycosylation mutants (GM), including amino acid translation of gpl40modSF162 (SEQ ID NO:65); translation of gpl40.modSF162.GM154 (SEQ TD NO:66); translation of gpl40.modSF162.GM154-186-195 (SEQ ED NO:67); and gpl40.modSF162.GM135-154-186-195 (SEQ ED NO:68).
  • GM Env glycosylation mutants
  • Figure 63 presents an overview of genome organization of HIV-1 and useful subgenomic fragments.
  • Figure 64 presents antibody titer data from immunized rabbits following immunization with HIV Envelope DNA constructs and protein.
  • Figure 65 presents a comparison of ELISA titers against subtype B and C Envelope proteins in rabbit sera collected after three DNA immunizations and a single protein boost.
  • Figure 66 presents data of neutralizing antibody responses against subtype B SF162 EnvdV2 strain in rabbits immunized with subtype C TVl Env in a DNA prime protein boost regimen.
  • Figure 67 presents data of neutralizing antibody responses against subtype C primary strains, TVl and TV2 in 5.25 reporter cell assay after a single protein boost.
  • Figure 68 presents data of neutralizing antibody responses against subtype C, TVl and Dul74, and subtype B, SF162 after a single protein boost (as measured by Duke PBMC assay).
  • Synthetic sequences refers to HIV polypeptide-enc ⁇ dzng polynucleotides whose expression has been modified as described herein, for example, by codon substitution, altered activities, and/or inactivation of inhibitory sequences.
  • Wild-type or “native” sequences refers to polypeptide encoding sequences that are essentially as they are found in nature, e.g., Gag, Pol, Vif, Vpr, Tat, Rev, Vpu, Env and/or Nef encoding sequences as found in HIV isolates, e.g., SF162, SF2, AF110965, AF110967, API 10968, AF110975, 8_5_TV1_C.ZA, 8_2_TV1_C.ZA or 12-5_1_TV2_C.ZA.
  • Table A The various regions of the HIV genome are shown in Table A, with numbering relative to 8_5_TV1_C.ZA ( Figures 1 A- ID).
  • Polymerase p6Pol
  • protease prot
  • reverse transcriptase p66RT or RT
  • RNAseH pl5RNAseH
  • integrase p31Int or Int
  • Identification of gene regions for any selected HIN isolate can be performed by one of ordinary skill in the art based on the teachings presented herein and the information known in the art, for example, by performing alignments relative to 8_5_TN1_C.ZA ( Figures 1A-1D) or alignment to other known HIV isolates, for example, Subtype B isolates with gene regions (e.g., SF2, GenBank Accession number K02007; SF162, GenBank Accession Number M38428) and Subtype C isolates with gene regions (e.g., GenBank Accession Number AF110965 and GenBank Accession Number AF110975).
  • virus-like particle refers to a nonreplicating, viral shell, derived from any of several viruses discussed further below.
  • VLPs are generally composed of one or more viral proteins, such as, but not limited to those proteins referred to as capsid, coat, shell, surface and/or envelope proteins, or particle-forming polypeptides derived from these proteins. VLPs can form spontaneously upon recombinant expression of the protein in an appropriate expression system. Methods for producing particular VLPs are known in the art and discussed more fully below. The presence of VLPs following recombinant expression of viral proteins can be detected using conventional techniques known in the art, such as by electron microscopy, X-ray crystallography, and the like. See, e.g., Baker et al., Biophys. J. (1991) 60: 1445-1456; Hagensee et al., J. Virol. (1994) 68:4503-4505.
  • VLPs can be isolated by density gradient centrifugation and/or identified by characteristic density banding.
  • cryoelectron microscopy can be performed on vitrified aqueous samples of the VLP preparation in question, and images recorded under appropriate exposure conditions.
  • particle-forming polypeptide derived from a particular viral protein is meant a full-length or near full-length viral protein, as well as a fragment thereof, or a viral protein with internal deletions, which has the ability to form VLPs under conditions that favor VLP formation.
  • the polypeptide may comprise the full-length sequence, fragments, truncated and partial sequences, as well as analogs and precursor forms of the reference molecule.
  • the term therefore intends deletions, additions and substitutions to the sequence, so long as the polypeptide retains the ability to form a VLP.
  • the term includes natural variations of the specified polypeptide since variations in coat proteins often occur between viral isolates.
  • the term also includes deletions, additions and substitutions that do not naturally occur in the reference protein, so long as the protein retains the ability to form a VLP.
  • Preferred substitutions are those which are conservative in nature, i.e., those if it..» ⁇ - 'Ljf >::::» tut ic; . E: __ ..”& u "il" «:::::L
  • amino acids are generally divided into four families: (1) acidic ⁇ aspartate and glutamate; (2) basic ⁇ lysine, arginine, histidine; (3) non-polar ⁇ alanine, valine, leucine, isoleucine, proline, phenylalanine, methionine, tryptophan; and (4) uncharged polar — glycine, asparagine, glutamine, cystine, serine threonine, tyrosine. Phenylalanine, tryptophan, and tyrosine are sometimes classified as aromatic amino acids.
  • HIV polypeptide refers to any amino acid sequence that exhibits sequence homology to native HIV polypeptides (e.g., Gag, Env, Prot, Pol, RT, Int, vif, vpr, vpu, tat, rev, nef and/or combinations thereof) and/or which is functional.
  • functions that may be exhibited by HIV polypeptides include, use as immunogens (e.g., to generate a humoral and/or cellular immune response), use in diagnostics (e.g, bound by suitable antibodies for use in ELISAs or other immunoassays) and/or polypeptides which exhibit one or more biological activities associated with the wild type or synthetic HIV polypeptide.
  • Gag polypeptide may refer to a polypeptide that is bound by one or more anti-Gag antibodies; elicits a humoral and/or cellular immune response; and/or exhibits the ability to form particles.
  • an “antigen” refers to a molecule containing one or more epitopes (either linear, conformational or both) that will stimulate a host's immune system to make a humoral and/or cellular antigen-specific response.
  • the term is used interchangeably with the term "immunogen.”
  • a B-cell epitope will include at least about 5 amino acids but can be as small as 3-4 amino acids.
  • a T-cell epitope, such as a CTL epitope, wiU include at least about 7-9 amino acids, and a helper T-cell epitope at least about 12-20 amino acids.
  • an epitope will include between about 7 and 15 amino acids, such as, 9, 10, 12 or 15 amino acids.
  • antigen denotes both subunit antigens, (Le., antigens which are separate and discrete from a whole organism with which the antigen is associated in nature), as well as, killed, attenuated or inactivated bacteria, viruses, fungi, parasites or other microbes.
  • Antibodies such as anti-idiotype antibodies, or fragments thereof, and synthetic peptide mimotopes, which can mimic an antigen or antigenic determinant, are also captured under the definition of antigen as used herein.
  • an oligonucleotide or polynucleotide which expresses an antigen or antigenic determinant in vivo, such as in gene therapy and DNA immunization applications, is also included in the definition of antigen herein.
  • antigens can be derived from any of several known viruses, bacteria, parasites and fungi, as described more fully below.
  • an "antigen" refers to a protein which includes modifications, such as deletions, additions and substitutions (generally conservative in nature), to the native sequence, so long as the protein maintains the ability to elicit an immunological response, as defined herein. These modifications may be dehberate, as through site- directed mutagenesis, or may be accidental, such as through mutations of hosts which produce the antigens.
  • an "immunological response" to an antigen or composition is the development in a subject of a humoral and/or a cellular immune response to an antigen present in the composition of interest.
  • a “humoral immune response” refers to an immune response mediated by antibody molecules
  • a "cellular immune response” is one mediated by T-lymphocytes and/or other white blood cells.
  • CTL cytolytic T-cells
  • CTLs have specificity for peptide antigens that are presented in association with proteins encoded by the major histocompatibihty complex (MHC) and expressed on the surfaces of cells.
  • helper T-cells help induce and promote the destruction of intracellular microbes, or the lysis of cells infected with such microbes.
  • Another aspect of cellular immunity involves an antigen-specific response by helper T-cells.
  • Helper T-cells act to help stimulate the function, and focus the activity of, nonspecific effector cells against cells displaying peptide antigens in association with MHC molecules on their surface.
  • a "cellular immune response” also refers to the production of cytokines, chemokines and other such molecules produced by activated T-cells and/or other white blood ceUs, including those derived from CD4+ and CD8+ T-cells.
  • a composition or vaccine that elicits a cellular immune response may serve to sensitize a vertebrate subject by the presentation of antigen in association with MHC molecules at the cell surface.
  • the cell-mediated immune response is directed at, or near, cells presenting antigen at their surface.
  • antigen-specific T- lymphocytes can be generated to allow for the future protection of an immunized host.
  • the ability of a particular antigen to stimulate a cell-mediated immunological response may be determined by a number of assays, such as by lymphoprohferation (lymphocyte activation) assays, CTL cytotoxic ceU assays, or by assaying for T- lymphocytes specific for the antigen in a sensitized subject. Such assays are well known in the art.
  • Recent methods of measuring cell- mediated immune response include measurement of intracellular cytokines or cytokine secretion by T-cell populations, or by measurement of epitope specific T-cells (e.g., by the tetramer technique) (reviewed by McMichael, A.J., and O'Callaghan, C.A., J. Exp. Med. 187(9)1367-1371, 1998; Mcheyzer-Wilhams, M.G., et al, Immunol. Rev.
  • an immunological response as used herein may be one which stimulates the production of CTLs, and/or the production or activation of helper T- cells.
  • the antigen of interest may also elicit an antibody-mediated immune response.
  • an immunological response may include one or more of the following effects: the production of antibodies by B-cells; and/or the activation of suppressor T-cells and/or ⁇ T-cells directed specifically to an antigen or antigens present in the composition or vaccine of interest.
  • an "immunogenic composition” is a composition that comprises an antigenic molecule where administration of the composition to a subject results in the development in the subject of a humoral and/or a cellular immune response to the antigenic molecule of interest.
  • the immunogenic composition can be introduced directly into a recipient subject, such as by injection, inhalation, oral, intranasal and mucosal (e.g., intra-rectally or intra-vaginally) administration.
  • subunit vaccine is meant a vaccine composition which includes one or more selected antigens but not all antigens, derived from or homologous to, an antigen from a pathogen of interest such as from a virus, bacterium, parasite or fungus. Such a composition is substantially free of intact pathogen cells or pathogenic particles, or the lysate of such cells or particles.
  • a “subunit vaccine” can be prepared from at least partially purified (preferably substantiaUy purified) immunogenic polypeptides from the pathogen, or analogs thereof.
  • the method of obtaining an antigen included in the subunit vaccine can thus include standard purification techniques, recombinant production, or synthetic production.
  • substantially purified general refers to isolation of a substance (compound, polynucleotide, protein, polypeptide, polypeptide composition) such that the substance comprises the majority percent of the sample in which it resides.
  • a substantially purified component comprises 50%, preferably 80%-85%, more preferably 90-95% of the sample.
  • Techniques for purifying polynucleotides and polypeptides of interest are well-known in the art and include, for example, ion- exchange chromatography, affinity chromatography and sedimentation according to density.
  • a “coding sequence” or a sequence which "encodes” a selected polypeptide is a nucleic acid molecule which is transcribed (in the case of DNA) and translated (in the case of mRNA) into a polypeptide in vivo when placed under the control of appropriate regulatory sequences (or “control elements”).
  • the boundaries of the coding sequence are determined by a start codon at the 5' (amino) terminus and a translation stop codon at the 3' (carboxy) terminus.
  • a coding sequence can include, but is not limited to, cDNA from viral, procaryotic or eucaryotic mRNA, genomic DNA sequences from viral or procaryotic DNA, and even synthetic DNA sequences.
  • a transcription termination sequence such as a stop codon may be located 3' to the coding sequence.
  • control elements include, but are not limited to, transcription promoters, transcription enhancer elements, transcription termination signals, polyadenylation sequences (located 3' to the translation stop codon), sequences for optimization of initiation of translation (located 5' to the coding sequence), and translation termination sequences.
  • sequences and/or vectors described herein may also include one or more additional sequences that may optimize translation and/or termination including, but not limited to, a Kozak sequence (e.g., GCCACC placed in front (5') of the ATG of the codon-optimized wild-type leader or any other suitable leader sequence (e.g., tpal, tpa2, wtLnat (native wild-type leader)) or a termination sequence (e.g., TAA or, preferably, TAAA placed after (3') the coding sequence.
  • a Kozak sequence e.g., GCCACC placed in front (5') of the ATG of the codon-optimized wild-type leader or any other suitable leader sequence (e.g., tpal, tpa2, wtLnat (native wild-type leader)
  • a termination sequence e.g., TAA or, preferably, TAAA placed after (3') the coding sequence.
  • a "polynucleotide coding sequence” or a sequence which "encodes” a selected polypeptide is a nucleic acid molecule which is transcribed (in the case of DNA) and translated (in the case of mRNA) into a polypeptide in vivo when placed under the control of appropriate regulatory sequences (or “control elements").
  • the boundaries of the coding sequence are determined by a start codon, for example, at or near the 5' terminus and a translation stop codon, for example, at or near the 3' terminus.
  • Exemplary coding sequences are the modified viral polypeptide-coding sequences of the present invention.
  • the coding regions of the polynucleotide sequences of the present invention are identifiable by one of skill in the art and may, for example, be easily identified by performing translations of all three frames of the polynucleotide and identifying the frame corresponding to the encoded polypeptide, for example, a synthetic nef polynucleotide of the present invention encodes a nef-derived polypeptide.
  • a transcription termination sequence may be located 3' to the coding sequence.
  • control elements include, but are not limited to, transcription regulators, such as promoters, transcription enhancer elements, transcription termination signals, and polyadenylation sequences; and translation regulators, such as sequences for optimization of initiation of translation, e.g., Shine-Dalgarno (ribosome binding site) sequences, Kozak sequences (i.e., sequences for the optimization of translation, located, for example, 5' to the coding sequence), leader sequences, translation initiation codon (e.g., ATG), and translation termination sequences.
  • transcription regulators such as promoters, transcription enhancer elements, transcription termination signals, and polyadenylation sequences
  • translation regulators such as sequences for optimization of initiation of translation, e.g., Shine-Dalgarno (ribosome binding site) sequences, Kozak sequences (i.e., sequences for the optimization of translation, located, for example, 5' to the coding sequence), leader sequences, translation initiation codon (e.g., ATG),
  • one or more translation regulation or initiation sequences are derived from wild-type translation initiation sequences, i.e., sequences that regulate translation of the coding region in their native state. Wild-type leader sequences that have been modified, using the methods described herein, also find use in the present invention.
  • Promoters can include inducible promoters (where expression of a polynucleotide sequence operably linked to the promoter is induced by an analyte, cofactor, regulatory protein, etc.), repressible promoters (where expression of a polynucleotide sequence operably linked to the promoter is induced by an analyte, cofactor, regulatory protein, etc.), and constitutive promoters.
  • a "nucleic acid" molecule can include, but is not limited to, procaryotic sequences, eucaryotic mRNA, cDNA from eucaryotic mRNA, genomic DNA sequences from eucaryotic (e.g., mammalian) DNA, and even synthetic DNA sequences.
  • the term also captures sequences that include any of the known base analogs of DNA and RN .
  • “Operably linked” refers to an arrangement of elements wherein the components so described are configured so as to perform their usual function.
  • a given promoter operably linked to a coding sequence is capable of effecting the expression of the coding sequence when the proper enzymes are present.
  • the promoter need not be contiguous with the coding sequence, so long as it functions to direct the expression thereof.
  • intervening untranslated yet transcribed sequences can be present between the promoter sequence and the coding sequence and the promoter sequence can still be considered “operably linked" to the coding sequence.
  • Recombinant as used herein to describe a nucleic acid molecule means a polynucleotide of genomic, cDNA, semisynthetic, or synthetic origin which, by virtue of its origin or manipulation: (1) is not associated with all or a portion of the polynucleotide with which it is associated in nature; and/or (2) is linked to a polynucleotide other than that to which it is linked in nature.
  • the term "recombinant” as used with respect to a protein or polypeptide means a polypeptide produced by expression of a recombinant polynucleotide.
  • Recombinant host cells “host cells,” “cells,” “cell lines,” “cell cultures,” and other such terms denoting procaryotic microorganisms or eucaryotic cell lines cultured as unicellular entities, are used interchangeably, and refer to cells which can be, or have been, used as recipients for recombinant vectors or other transfer DNA, and include the progeny of the original cell which has been transfected. It is understood that the progeny of a single parental cell may not necessarily be completely identical in morphology or in genomic or total DNA complement to the original parent, due to accidental or dehberate mutation.
  • Progeny of the parental cell which are sufficiently similar to the parent to be characterized by the relevant property, such as the presence of a nucleotide sequence encoding a desired peptide, are included in the progeny intended by this definition, and are covered by the above terms.
  • similarity means the exact amino acid to amino acid comparison of two or more polypeptides at the appropriate place, where amino acids are identical or possess similar chemical and/or physical properties such as charge or hydrophobicity. A so-termed “percent similarity” then can be determined between the compared polypeptide sequences.
  • Techniques for determining nucleic acid and amino acid sequence identity also are well known in the art and include determining the nucleotide sequence of the mRNA for that gene (usually via a cDNA intermediate) and determining the amino acid sequence encoded thereby, and comparing this to a second amino acid sequence.
  • identity refers to an exact nucleotide to nucleotide or amino acid to amino acid correspondence of two polynucleotides or polypeptide sequences, respectively.
  • Two or more polynucleotide sequences can be compared by determining their "percent identity.”
  • Two or more amino acid sequences likewise can be compared by determining their "percent identity.”
  • the percent identity of two sequences, whether nucleic acid or peptide sequences, is generally described as the number of exact matches between two aligned sequences divided by the length of the shorter sequence and multiplied by 100.
  • An approximate alignment for nucleic acid sequences is provided by the local homology algorithm of Smith and Waterman, Advances in
  • percent identity of a particular nucleotide sequence to a reference sequence can be determined using the homology algorithm of Smith and Waterman with a default scoring table and a gap penalty of six nucleotide positions.
  • Another method of establishing percent identity in the context of the present invention is to use the MPSRCH package of programs copyrighted by the University of Edinburgh, developed by John F. Collins and Shane S. Sturrok, and distributed by IntelhGenetics, Inc. (Mountain View, CA). From this suite of packages, the Smith- Waterman algorithm can be employed where default parameters are used for the scoring table (for example, gap open penalty of 12, gap extension penalty of one, and a gap of six).
  • the "Match” value reflects "sequence identity.”
  • Other suitable programs for calculating the percent identity or similarity between sequences are generally known in the art, such as the alignment program BLAST, which can also be used with default parameters.
  • a representative embodiment ofthe present invention would include an isolated polynucleotide comprising X contiguous nucleotides, wherein (i) the X contiguous nucleotides have at least about a selected level of percent identity relative to Y contiguous nucleotides of one or more of the sequences described herein (e.g., in Table C) or fragment thereof, and (ii) for search purposes X equals Y, wherein Y is a selected reference polynucleotide of defined length (for example, a length of from 15 nucleotides up to the number of nucleotides present in a selected full-length sequence).
  • sequences of the present invention can include fragments of the sequences, for example, from about 15 nucleotides up to the number of nucleotides present in the full-length sequences described herein (e.g., see the Figures), including all integer values falling within the above-described range.
  • fragments of the polynucleotide sequences of the present invention may be 30-60 nucleotides, 60-120 nucleotides, 120-240 nucleotides, 240-480 nucleotides, 480-1000 nucleotides, and all integer values therebetween.
  • the synthetic expression cassettes (and purified polynucleotides) of the present invention include related polynucleotide sequences having about 80% to 100%, greater than 80-85%, preferably greater than 90-92%, more preferably greater than 95%, and most preferably greater than 98% up to 100% (including ah integer values falling within these described ranges) sequence identity to the synthetic expression cassette and/or polynucleotide sequences disclosed herein (for example, to the sequences of the present invention) when the sequences of the present invention are used as the query sequence against, for example, a database of sequences.
  • Two nucleic acid fragments are considered to "selectively hybridize" as described herein.
  • the degree of sequence identity between two nucleic acid molecules affects the efficiency and strength of hybridization events between such molecules.
  • a partially identical nucleic acid sequence will at least partially inhibit a completely identical sequence from hybridizing to a target molecule. Inhibition of hybridization of the completely identical sequence can be assessed using hybridization assays that are well known in the art (e.g., Southern blot, Northern blot, solution hybridization, or the like, see Sambrook, et al., supra or Ausubel et al., supra).
  • Such assays can be conducted using varying degrees of selectivity, for example, using conditions varying from low to high stringency.
  • the absence of non-specific binding can be assessed using a secondary probe that lacks even a partial degree of sequence identity (for example, a probe having less than about 30% sequence identity with the target molecule), such that, in the absence of non-specific binding events, the secondary probe will not hybridize to the target.
  • a partial degree of sequence identity for example, a probe having less than about 30% sequence identity with the target molecule
  • a nucleic acid probe When utilizing a hybridization-based detection system, a nucleic acid probe is chosen that is complementary to a target nucleic acid sequence, and then by selection of appropriate conditions the probe and the target sequence "selectively hybridize,” or bind, to each other to form a hybrid molecule.
  • a nucleic acid molecule that is capable of hybridizing selectively to a target sequence under "moderately stringent” typically hybridizes under conditions that allow detection of a target nucleic acid sequence of at least about 10-14 nucleotides in length having at least approximately 70% sequence identity with the sequence ofthe selected nucleic acid probe.
  • Stringent hybridization conditions typically allow detection of target nucleic acid sequences of at least about 10-14 nucleotides in length having a sequence identity of greater than about 90-95% with the sequence of the selected nucleic acid probe.
  • Hybridization conditions useful for probe/target hybridization where the probe and target have a specific degree of sequence identity can be determined as is known in the art (see, for example, Nucleic Acid Hybridization: A Practical Approach, editors B.D. Hames and S.J. Higgins, (1985) Oxford; Washington, DC; IRL Press).
  • stringency conditions for hybridization it is well known in the art that numerous equivalent conditions can be employed to establish a particular stringency by varying, for example, the foUowing factors: the length and nature of probe and target sequences, base composition of the various sequences, concentrations of salts and other hybridization solution components, the presence or absence of blocking agents in the hybridization solutions (e.g., formamide, dextran sulfate, and polyethylene glycol), hybridization reaction temperature and time parameters, as well as, varying wash conditions.
  • the selection of a particular set of hybridization conditions is selected following standard methods in the art (see, for example, Sambrook, et al., supra or Ausubel et al., supra).
  • a first polynucleotide is "derived from” second polynucleotide if it has the same or substantially the same basepair sequence as a region of the second polynucleotide, its cDNA, complements thereof, or if it displays sequence identity as described above.
  • a first polypeptide is "derived from” a second polypeptide if it is (i) encoded by a first polynucleotide derived from a second polynucleotide, or (ii) displays sequence identity to the second polypeptides as described above.
  • a viral polypeptide is "derived from" a particular polypeptide of a virus (viral polypeptide) if it is (i) encoded by an open reading frame of a polynucleotide of that virus (viral polynucleotide), or (ii) displays sequence identity to polypeptides of that virus as described above.
  • Encoded by refers to a nucleic acid sequence which codes for a polypeptide sequence, wherein the polypeptide sequence or a portion thereof contains an amino acid sequence of at least 3 to 5 amino acids, more preferably at least 8 to 10 amino acids, and even more preferably at least 15 to 20 amino acids from a polypeptide encoded by the nucleic acid sequence. Also encompassed are polypeptide sequences which are immunologically identifiable with a polypeptide encoded by the sequence. Further, polyproteins can be constructed by fusing in-frame two or more polynucleotide sequences encoding polypeptide or peptide products.
  • polycistronic coding sequences may be produced by placing two or more polynucleotide sequences encoding polypeptide products adjacent each other, typically under the control of one promoter, wherein each polypeptide coding sequence may be modified to include sequences for internal ribosome binding sites.
  • Polynucleotide refers to a polynucleotide of interest or fragment thereof which is essentially free, e.g., contains less than about 50%, preferably less than about 70%, and more preferably less than about 90%, ofthe protein with which the polynucleotide is naturally associated.
  • Techniques for purifying polynucleotides of interest include, for example, disruption ofthe cell containing the polynucleotide with a chaotropic agent and separation of the polynucleotide(s) and proteins by ion-exchange chromatography, affinity chromatography and sedimentation according to density.
  • nucleic acid immunization is meant the introduction of a nucleic acid molecule encoding one or more selected antigens into a host cell, for the in vivo expression of an antigen, antigens, an epitope, or epitopes.
  • the nucleic acid molecule can be introduced directly into a recipient subject, such as by injection, inhalation, oral, intranasal and mucosal administration, or the like, or can be introduced ex vivo, into cells which have been removed from the host. In the latter case, the transformed cells are reintroduced into the subject where an immune response can be mounted against the antigen encoded by the nucleic acid molecule.
  • Gene transfer or “gene dehvery” refers to methods or systems for reliably inserting DNA of interest into a host ceU. Such methods can result in transient expression of non-integrated transferred DNA, extrachromosomal replication and expression of transferred replicons (e.g., episomes), or integration of transferred genetic material into the genomic DNA of host cells.
  • Gene dehvery expression vectors include, but are not limited to, vectors derived from alphaviruses, pox viruses and vaccinia viruses. When used for immunization, such gene dehvery expression vectors may be referred to as vaccines or vaccine vectors.
  • T lymphocytes or “T cells” are non-antibody producing lymphocytes that constitute a part of the cell-mediated arm of the immune system.
  • T cells arise from immature lymphocytes that migrate from the bone marrow to the thymus, where they undergo a maturation process under the direction of thymic hormones.
  • the mature lymphocytes rapidly divide increasing to very large numbers.
  • the maturing T cells become immunocompetent based on their ability to recognize and bind a specific antigen. Activation of immunocompetent T cells is triggered when an antigen binds to the lymphocyte's surface receptors.
  • transfection is used to refer to the uptake of foreign DNA by a cell.
  • a cell has been "transfected" when exogenous DNA has been introduced inside the cell membrane.
  • transfection techniques are generally known in the art. See, e.g., Graham et al. (1973) Virology, 52:456, Sambrook et al. (1989) Molecular Cloning, a laboratory manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratories, New York, Davis et al. (1986) Basic Methods in Molecular Biology, Elsevier, and Chu et al. (1981) Gene _3:197.
  • Such techniques can be used to introduce one or more exogenous DNA moieties into suitable host cells.
  • the term refers to both stable and transient uptake of the genetic material, and includes uptake of peptide- or antibody-linked DNAs.
  • a “vector” is capable of transferring gene sequences to target cells (e.g., viral vectors, non- viral vectors, particulate carriers, and liposomes).
  • target cells e.g., viral vectors, non- viral vectors, particulate carriers, and liposomes.
  • vector construct e.g., viral vectors, non- viral vectors, particulate carriers, and liposomes.
  • expression vector e.g., a vector, vector, and “gene transfer vector,” mean any nucleic acid construct capable of directing the expression of a gene of interest and which can transfer gene sequences to target cells.
  • the term includes cloning and expression vehicles, as well as viral vectors.
  • suicide gene e.g., a drug-susceptibility gene
  • HSV-tk herpes simplex virus
  • cytochrome P450 Manome et al.
  • human deoxycytidine kinase Manome et al. (1996) Nature Medicine 2(5):567-573
  • cytosine deaminase Dong et al.
  • a “selectable marker” or “reporter marker” refers to a nucleotide sequence included in a gene transfer vector that has no therapeutic activity, but rather is included to aUow for simpler preparation, manufacturing, characterization or testing of the gene transfer vector.
  • a “specific binding agent” refers to a member of a specific binding pair of molecules wherein one of the molecules specifically binds to the second molecule through chemical and/or physical means.
  • One example of a specific binding agent is an antibody directed against a selected antigen.
  • subject any member of the subphylum chordata, including, without limitation, humans and other primates, including non-human primates such as rhesus macaque, chimpanzees and other apes and monkey species; farm animals such ⁇ as cattle, sheep, pigs, goats and horses; domestic mammals such as dogs and cats; laboratory animals including rodents such as mice, rats and guinea pigs; birds, including domestic, wild and game birds such as chickens, turkeys and other gallinaceous birds, ducks, geese, and the like.
  • the term does not denote a particular age. Thus, both adult and newborn individuals are intended to be covered.
  • the system described above is intended for use in any of the above vertebrate species, since the immune systems of all of these vertebrates operate similarly.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable or “pharmacologically acceptable” is meant a material which is not biologically or otherwise undesirable, i.e., the material may be administered to an individual in a formulation or composition without causing any undesirable biological effects or interacting in a deleterious manner with any of the components of the composition in which it is contained.
  • physiological pH or a “pH in the physiological range” is meant a pH in the range of approximately 7.0 to 8.0 inclusive, more typically in the range of approximately 7.2 to 7.6 inclusive.
  • treatment refers to any of (i) the prevention of infection or reinfection, as in a traditional vaccine, (ii) the reduction or elimination of symptoms, and (iii) the substantial or complete elimination ofthe pathogen in question. Treatment may be effected prophylactically (prior to infection) or therapeutically (following infection).
  • co-administration is meant administration of more than one composition or molecule.
  • co-administration includes concurrent administration or sequentially administration (in any order), via the same or different routes of administration.
  • co-administration regimes include, co- administration of nucleic acid and polypeptide; co-administration of different nucleic acids (e.g., different expression cassettes as described herein and/or different gene dehvery vectors); and co-administration of different polypeptides (e.g., different HIV polypeptides and/or different adjuvants).
  • the term also encompasses multiple administrations of one of the co-administered molecules or compositions (e.g., multiple administrations of one or more of the expression cassettes described herein foUowed by one or more administrations of a polypeptide-containing composition).
  • multiple administrations of one of the co-administered molecules or compositions e.g., multiple administrations of one or more of the expression cassettes described herein foUowed by one or more administrations of a polypeptide-containing composition.
  • the time between each administration can be readily determined by one of skill in the art in view of the teachings herein.
  • Lentiviral vector refers to a nucleic acid construct which carries, and within certain embodiments, is capable of directing the expression of a nucleic acid molecule of interest.
  • the lentiviral vector include at least one transcriptional promoter/enhancer or locus defining element(s), or other elements which control gene expression by other means such as alternate splicing, nuclear RNA export, post-translational modification of messenger, or post-transcriptional modification of protein.
  • Such vector constructs must also include a packaging signal, long terminal repeats (LTRS) or portion thereof, and positive and negative strand primer binding sites appropriate to the retrovirus used (if these are not already present in the retroviral vector).
  • LTRS long terminal repeats
  • the recombinant lentiviral vector may also include a signal which directs polyadenylation, selectable markers such as Neo, TK, hygromycin, phleomycin, histidinol, or DHFR, as well as one or more restriction sites and a translation termination sequence.
  • selectable markers such as Neo, TK, hygromycin, phleomycin, histidinol, or DHFR
  • such vectors typically include a 5' LTR, a tRNA binding site, a packaging signal, an origin of second strand DNA synthesis, and a 3'LTR or a portion thereof
  • Lentiviral vector particle refers to a lentivirus which carries at least one gene of interest.
  • the retrovirus may also contain a selectable marker.
  • the recombinant lentivirus is capable of reverse transcribing its genetic material (RNA) into DNA and incorporating this genetic material into a host cell's DNA upon infection.
  • Lentiviral vector particles may have a lentiviral envelope, a non-lentiviral envelope (e.g., an ampho or VSV-G envelope), or a chimeric envelope.
  • Nucleic acid expression vector” or “Expression cassette” refers to an assembly which is capable of directing the expression of a sequence or gene of interest.
  • the nucleic acid expression vector includes a promoter which is operably linked to the sequences or gene(s) of interest. Other control elements may be present as well.
  • Expression cassettes described herein may be contained within a plasmid construct.
  • the plasmid construct may also include a bacterial origin of replication, one or more selectable markers, a signal which allows the plasmid construct to exist as single-stranded DNA (e.g., a Ml 3 origin of replication), a multiple cloning site, and a "mammalian" origin of replication (e.g., a SV40 or adenovirus origin of replication).
  • Packaging cell refers to a cell which contains those elements necessary for production of infectious recombinant retrovirus which are lacking in a recombinant retroviral vector.
  • packaging cells typically contain one or more expression cassettes which are capable of expressing proteins which encode Gag, pol and env proteins.
  • Producer cell or “vector producing cell” refers to a cell which contains all elements necessary for production of recombinant retroviral vector particles.
  • HIN genome and various polypeptide-encoding regions are shown in Table A.
  • the nucleotide positions are given relative to 8_5_TN1_C.ZA ( Figure 1; an HIN Type C isolate).
  • Figure 1 an HIN Type C isolate.
  • it will be readily apparent to one of ordinary skill in the art in view of the teachings of the present disclosure how to determine corresponding regions in other HIN strains or variants e.g., isolates HiN ⁇ , HIN SF2 , HIV-1 SF162 , HIV-1 SF170 , HIN LAV , HIN LAI , HIN M ⁇ , HIV-1 CM235
  • HTV-1 US4 other HIV-1 strains from diverse subtypes(e.g., subtypes, A through G, and O), HIV-2 strains and diverse subtypes (e.g., HIN-2 UC1 and HIN-2 UC2 ), and simian immunodeficiency virus (SIN).
  • Table A Regions of the HIV Genome relative to 8_5_TV1_C.ZA
  • Env polypeptides include a "bridging sheet" comprised of 4 anti-parallel b-strands (b-2, b-3, b-20 and b-21) that form a b-sheet. Extruding from one pair ofthe b-strands (b-2 and b-3) are two loops, NI and N2.
  • the b-2 sheet occurs at approximately amino acid residue 113 (Cys) to amino acid residue 117 (Thr) while b-3 occurs at approximately amino acid residue 192 (Ser) to amino acid residue 194 (Ile), relative to SF-162.
  • V1/N2 region occurs at approximately amino acid positions 120 (Cys) to residue 189 (Cys), relative to SF-162.
  • Extruding from the second pair of b-strands (b-20 and b-21) is a "small-loop" structure, also referred to herein as "the bridging sheet small loop.”
  • the locations of both the small loop and bridging sheet small loop can be determined relative to HXB-2 following the teachings herein and in WO/39303.
  • Also shown by arrows in Figure 2A-C are approximate sites for deletions sequence from the beta sheet region. The denotes ⁇ -glycosylation sites that can be mutated following the teachings of the present specification.
  • One aspect of the present invention is the generation of HJN-1 coding sequences, and related sequences, for example having improved expression relative to the corresponding wild-type sequences.
  • the HIN-1 codon usage pattern was modified so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence was comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes.
  • the HIV codon usage reflects a high content of the nucleotides A or T of the codon-triplet.
  • the effect ofthe HIV-1 codon usage is a high AT content in the D ⁇ A sequence that results in a decreased translation ability and instability of the mR ⁇ A.
  • highly expressed human codons prefer the nucleotides G or C
  • the HIV coding sequences were modified to be comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes.
  • inhibitory (or instability) elements located within the coding sequences of, for example, the Gag coding sequences.
  • the RRE is a secondary RNA structure that interacts with the HIV encoded Rev-protein to overcome the expression down-regulating effects of the INS.
  • the instability elements can be inactivated by introducing multiple point mutations that do not alter the reading frame ofthe encoded proteins.
  • the coding sequence has been altered such that the polynucleotide coding sequence encodes a gene product that is inactive or non- functional (e.g., inactivated polymerase, protease, tat, rev, nef, vif, vpr, and/or vpu gene products).
  • Example 1 describes some exemplary mutations.
  • Example 8 presents information concerning functional analysis of mutated Tat, Rev and Nef antigens.
  • the synthetic coding sequences are assembled by methods known in the art, for example by companies such as the Midland Certified Reagent Company (Midland, Texas).
  • Gag polypeptide coding sequences results in unproved expression relative to the wild-type coding sequences in a number of mammalian cell lines (as well as other types of cell lines, including, but not limited to, insect cells).
  • Some exemplary polynucleotide sequences encoding Gag-containing polypeptides are GagComplPolmut.SF2, GagComplPolmutAtt.SF2,
  • the present invention also includes synthetic Env-encoding polynucleotides and modified Env proteins, for example, gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod, g ⁇ l40.modSF162.CwtLnat, gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut7, and gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut8.
  • synthetic Env-encoding polynucleotides and modified Env proteins for example, gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod, g ⁇ l40.modSF162.CwtLnat, gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut7, and gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut8.
  • the codon usage pattern for Env was modified as described above for Gag so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence was comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes. Experiments performed in support of the present invention show that the synthetic Env sequences were capable of higher level of protein production relative to the native Env sequences.
  • Env polypeptide coding sequences results in improved expression relative to the wild-type coding sequences in a number of mammalian cell lines (as well as other types of cell lines, including, but not limited to, insect cells). Similar Env polypeptide coding sequences can be obtained, modified and tested for improved expression from a variety of isolates, including those described above for Gag.
  • Env include, but are not limited to, generating polynucleotides that encode Env polypeptides having mutations and/or deletions therein.
  • the hypervariable regions, VI and or V2 can be deleted as described herein.
  • other modifications, for example to the bridging sheet region and or to N-glycosylation sites within Env can also be performed following the teachings of the present specification, (see, Figure2A-C, as well as WO 00/39303, WO 00/39302, WO 00/39304, WO 02/04493).
  • Various combinations of these modifications can be employed to generate synthetic expression cassettes as described herein.
  • the present invention also includes expression cassettes which include synthetic Pol sequences.
  • Pol includes, but is not limited to, the protein-encoding regions comprising polymerase, protease, reverse transcriptase and/or integrase-containing sequences (Wan et et al (1996) Biochem. J. 316:569-573; Kohl et al. (1988) PNAS USA 85:4686-4690; Krausslich et al. (1988) J. Virol. 62:4393-4397; Coffin, "Retroviridae and their RepHcation” in Virology, ppl437-1500 (Raven, New York, 1990); Patel et. al.
  • the synthetic expression cassettes exemplified herein include one or more of these regions and one or more changes to the resulting amino acid sequences.
  • Some exemplary polynucleotide sequences encoding Pol-derived polypeptides are presented in Table C. The codon usage pattern for Pol was modified as described above for Gag and Env so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence was comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes.
  • Constructs may be modified in various ways.
  • the expression constructs may include a sequence that encodes the first 6 amino acids ofthe integrase polypeptide.
  • Constructs may include a multiple cloning site (MCS) for insertion of one or more transgenes, typically at the 3' end of the construct.
  • MCS multiple cloning site
  • a cassette encoding a catalytic center epitope derived from the catalytic center in RT is typically included 3' of the sequence encoding 6 amino acids of integrase. This cassette encodes Ile 178 through Serine 191 of RT and may be added to keep this well conserved region as a possible CTL epitope.
  • the constructs contain an insertion mutations to preserve the reading frame, (see, e.g., Park et al. (1991) J. Virol. 65:5111).
  • the catalytic center and/or primer grip region of RT are modified.
  • the catalytic center and primer grip regions of RT are described, for example, in Patel et al. (1995) Biochem. 34:5351 and Palaniappan et al. (1997) J. Biol. Chem. 272(17): 11157.
  • wild type sequence encoding the amino acids YMDD at positions 183-185 of p66 RT, numbered relative to AF110975 may be replaced with sequence encoding the amino acids "AP".
  • the primer grip region (amino acids WMGY, residues 229-232 of p66RT, numbered relative to AFl 10975) may be replaced with sequence encoding the amino acids "PI.”
  • the changes in codon usage are typically restricted to the regions up to the -1 frameshift and starting again at the end ofthe Gag reading frame; however, regions within the frameshift translation region can be modified as well.
  • inhibitory (or instability) elements located within the coding sequences of the protease polypeptide coding sequence can be altered as well.
  • the present invention also includes expression cassettes which include synthetic sequences derived HIV genes other than Gag, Env and Pol, including but not limited to, regions witliin Gag, Env, Pol, as well as, GagComplPolmut.SF2, GagCom ⁇ lPolmutAtt.SF2, GagComplPolmutIna.SF2, gagCpoUnaTatRevNef.opt_B, GagPolmutAtt.SF2, GagPolmutIna.SF2, GagProtInaRTmut.SF2,
  • Sequences obtained from other strains can be manipulated in similar fashion foUowing the teachings of the present specification.
  • the codon usage pattern is modified as described above for Gag, Env and Pol so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence is comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes.
  • typing these synthetic sequences are capable of higher level of protein production relative to the native sequences and that modification of the wild-type polypeptide coding sequences results in improved expression relative to the wild-type coding sequences in a number of mammalian cell lines (as well as other types of cell lines, including, but not limited to, insect cells).
  • nucleic acid sequence can also be modified to introduce mutations into one or more regions of the gene, for instance to alter the function of the gene product (e.g., render the gene product non-functional) and/or to eliminate site modifications (e.g., the myristoylation site in Nef).
  • Synthetic expression cassettes derived from HIV Type B coding sequences, exemplified herein include, but are not limited to, those comprising one or more of the foUowing synthetic polynucleotides: GagComplPolmut.SF2, GagCom ⁇ lPolmutAtt.SF2, GagCompPolmutIna.SF2, gagCpoUnaTatRevNef.
  • Gag-complete refers to in-frame polyproteins comprising, e.g., Gag and pol, wherein the p6 portion of Gag is present.
  • the HIV polypeptide-encoding expression cassettes described herein may also contain one or more further sequences encoding, for example, one or more transgenes.
  • Further sequences (e.g., transgenes) useful in the practice of the present invention mclude, but are not Umited to, further sequences are those encoding further viral epitopes/antigens ⁇ including but not limited to, HCV antigens (e.g., El, E2; Houghton, M.., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,714,596, issued February 3, 1998; Houghton, M.., et al., U.S. Patent No.
  • HCV antigens e.g., El, E2; Houghton, M.., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,714,596, issued February 3, 1998; Houghton, M.., et al., U.S. Patent No.
  • sequences may also be derived from non- viral sources, for instance, sequences encoding cytokines such interleukin-2 (IL-2), stem ceU factor (SCF), interleukin 3 (JX-3), interleukin 6 (IL-6), interleukin 12 (IL-12), G-CSF, granulocyte macrophage-colony stimulating factor (GM-CSF), interleukin-1 alpha (IL-II), interleukin- 11 (EL-ll), ME?- II, tumor necrosis factor (TNF), leukemia inhibitory factor (LE?), c-kit hgand, thrombopoietin (TPO) and flt3 hgand, commercially available from several vendors such as, for example, Genzyme (Framingham, MA), Genentech (South San Francisco, CA), Amgen (Thousand Oaks, CA), R&D Systems and Immunex (Seattle, WA).
  • cytokines such as interleukin-2 (IL-2), stem ceU
  • HIV polypeptide coding sequences can be obtained from other HIV isolates, see, e.g., Myers et al. Los Alamos Database, Los Alamos National Laboratory, Los Alamos, New Mexico (1992); Myers et al., Human Retroviruses and Aids, 1997, Los Alamos, New Mexico: Los Alamos National Laboratory. Synthetic expression cassettes can be generated using such coding sequences as starting material by foUowing the teachings of the present specification.
  • the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention include related polypeptide sequences having greater than 85%, preferably greater than 90%, more preferably greater than 95%, and most preferably greater than 98% sequence identity to the polypeptides encoded by the synthetic expression cassette sequences disclosed herein.
  • HIV-encoding sequences (expression cassettes) of the present invention can be cloned into a number of different expression vectors to evaluate levels of expression and, in the case of Gag-containing constructs, production of VLPs.
  • the synthetic DNA fragments for HIV polypeptides can be cloned into eucaryotic expression vectors, including, a transient expression vector, CMV-promoter-based mammalian vectors, and a shuttle vector for use in baculovirus expression systems.
  • Corresponding whd-type sequences can also be cloned into the same vectors.
  • ceU lines can then be transfected into a several different ceU types, including a variety of mammalian ceU lines (293, RD, COS-7, and CHO, ceU lines avaUable, for example, from the A.T.C.C).
  • the ceU lines are then cultured under appropriate conditions and the levels of any appropriate polypeptide product can be evaluated in supematants. (see, Table A).
  • p24 can be used to evaluate Gag expression
  • gpl60, gpl40 or gpl20 can be used to evaluate Env expression
  • p6pol can be used to evaluate Pol expression
  • prot can be used to evaluate protease
  • pl5 for RNAseH p31 for Integrase
  • other appropriate polypeptides for Vif, Vpr, Tat, Rev, Vpu and Nef.
  • modified polypeptides can also be used, for example, other Env polypeptides include, but are not limited to, for example, native gpl60, oligomeric g ⁇ l40, monomeric gpl20 as weU as modified and/or synthetic sequences of these polypeptides.
  • Exemplary Mammahan ceU lines include, but are not limited to, BHK, VERO, HT1080, 293, 293T, RD, COS-7, CHO, Jurkat, HUT, SUPT, C8166, MOLT4/clone8, MT-2, MT-4, H9, PM1, CEM, and CEMX174 (such ceU lines are available, for example, from the A.T.C.C).
  • a synthetic Gag expression cassette of the present invention will also exhibit high levels of expression and VLP production when transfected into insect ceUs.
  • Synthetic expression cassettes described herein also demonstrate high levels of expression in insect ceUs. Further, in addition to a higher total protein yield, the final product from the synthetic polypeptides consistently contains lower amounts of contaminating baculovirus proteins than the final product from the native sequences.
  • synthetic expression cassettes ofthe present invention can also be introduced into yeast vectors which, in turn, can be transformed into and efficiently expressed by yeast ceUs (Saccharomyces cerevisea; using vectors as described in Rosenberg, S. and Tekamp-Olson, P., U.S. Patent No. RE35,749, issued, March 17, 1998).
  • the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can be incorporated into a variety of expression vectors using selected expression control elements.
  • Appropriate vectors and control elements for any given ceU an be selected by one having ordinary skiU in the art in view of the teachings of the present specification and information known in the art about expression vectors.
  • a synthetic expression cassette can be inserted into a vector which includes control elements operably linked to the desired coding sequence, which aUow for the expression of the gene in a selected ceU-type.
  • typical promoters for mammahan ceU expression include the S V40 early promoter, a CMV promoter such as the CMN immediate early promoter (a CMV promoter can include intron A), RSV, HIV-Ltr, the mouse mammary tumor virus LTR promoter (MMLN- ltr), the adenovirus major late promoter (Ad MLP), and the herpes simplex virus promoter, among others.
  • nonviral promoters such as a promoter derived from the murine metaUothionein gene, wiU also find use for mammahan expression.
  • TypicaUy, transcription termination and polyadenylation sequences wiU also be present, located 3' to the translation stop codon.
  • a sequence for optimization of initiation of translation located 5' to the coding sequence, is also present.
  • transcription terminator/polyadenylation signals include those derived from SN40, as described in Sambrook, et al., supra, as weU as a bovine growth hormone terminator sequence.
  • Introns, containing splice donor and acceptor sites, may also be designed into the constructs for use with the present invention (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986).
  • Enhancer elements may also be used herein to increase expression levels of the mammahan constructs. Examples include the SN40 early gene enhancer, as described in Dijkema et al., EMBO J. (1985) 4:761, the enhancer/promoter derived from the long terminal repeat (LTR) of the Rous Sarcoma Nirus, as described in Gorman et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1982b) 79:6777 and elements derived from human CMN, as described in Boshart et al., Cell (1985) 41:521, such as elements included in the CMN intron A sequence (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986).
  • LTR long terminal repeat
  • the desired synthetic polypeptide encoding sequences can be cloned into any number of commerciaUy avahable vectors to generate expression of the polypeptide in an appropriate host system.
  • These systems include, but are not limited to, the foUowing: baculovirus expression ⁇ ReiUy, P.R., et al, BACULOVIRUS EXPRESSION VECTORS: A LABORATORY MANUAL (1992); Beames, et al., Biotechniques _1:378 (1991); Pharmingen; Clontech, Palo Alto, CA) ⁇ , vaccinia expression ⁇ Earl, P. L., et al.
  • control elements which aUow expression of the coding regions in a suitable host.
  • the control elements generaUy include a promoter, translation initiation codon, and translation and transcription termination sequences, and an insertion site for introducing the insert into the vector.
  • Translational control elements have been reviewed by M. Kozak (e.g., Kozak, M., Mamm. Genome
  • vaccinia virus expression has several advantages including the foUowing: (i) its wide host range; (ii) faithful post- transcriptional modification, processing, folding, transport, secretion, and assembly of recombinant proteins; (iii) high level expression of relatively soluble recombinant proteins; and (iv) a large capacity to accommodate foreign DNA.
  • the recombinantly expressed polypeptides from synthetic HIV polypeptide- encoding expression cassettes are typicaUy isolated from lysed ceUs or culture media.
  • Purification can be carried out by methods known in the art including salt fractionation, ion exchange chromatography, gel filtration, size-exclusion chromatography, size-fractionation, and affinity chromatography.
  • Immunoaffinity chromatography can be employed using antibodies generated based on, for example, HIN antigens.
  • Advantages of expressing the proteins of the present invention using mammahan ceUs include, but are not limited to, the foUowing: weU-estabhshed protocols for scale-up production; the ability to produce VLPs; ceU lines are suitable to meet good manufacturing process (GMP) standards; culture conditions for mammahan ceUs are known in the art.
  • GMP good manufacturing process
  • Synthetic HIV 1 polynucleotides are described herein, see, for example, the figures. Various forms of the different embodiments of the invention, described herein, may be combined. Exemplary expression assays are set forth in Example 2. Exemplary conditions for Western Blot analysis are presented in Example 3.
  • the Gag-containing synthetic expression cassettes ofthe present invention provide for the production of HIV-Gag virus-like particles (VLPs) using a variety of different ceU types, including, but not limited to, mammahan ceUs. Viral particles can be used as a matrix for the proper presentation of an antigen entrapped or associated therewith to the immune system of the host.
  • the Gag-containing synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention may provide superior production of both Gag proteins and VLPs, relative to native Gag coding sequences. Further, electron microscopic evaluation of VLP production can be used to show that free and budding immature virus particles of the expected size are produced by ceUs containing the synthetic expression cassettes.
  • VLPs can be produced in enhanced quantity making isolation and purification of the VLPs easier.
  • VLPs can be produced in a variety of ceU types using the synthetic expression cassettes, in particular, mammahan ceU lines can be used for VLP production, for example, CHO ceUs. Production using CHO ceUs provides (i) VLP formation; (ii) correct myristoylation and budding; (hi) absence of non-MacmiUian ceU contaminants (e.g., insect viruses and/or ceUs); and (iv) ease of purification.
  • the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention are also useful for enhanced expression in ceU-types other than mammahan ceU lines.
  • infection of insect ceUs with baculovirus vectors encoding the synthetic expression cassettes results in higher levels of total Gag protein yield and higher levels of VLP production (relative to wUd-coding sequences).
  • the final product from insect ceUs infected with the baculo virus-Gag synthetic expression cassettes consistently contains lower amounts of contaminating insect proteins than the final product when wUd-coding sequences are used.
  • VLPs can spontaneously form when the particle-forming polypeptide of interest is recombinantly expressed in an appropriate host ceU.
  • the VLPs produced using the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention are conveniently prepared using recombinant techniques.
  • the Gag polypeptide encoding synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can include other polypeptide coding sequences of interest (for example, HIV protease, HIV polymerase, Env; synthetic Env). Expression of such synthetic expression cassettes yields VLPs comprising the Gag polypeptide, as weU as, the polypeptide of interest.
  • coding sequences for the desired particle-forming polypeptides can be cloned into any suitable vector or replicon for expression.
  • Numerous cloning vectors are known to those of sk l in the art, and the selection of an appropriate cloning vector is a matter of choice. See, generaUy, Sambrook et al, supra. The vector is then used to transform an appropriate host ceU.
  • Suitable recombinant expression systems include, but are not limited to, bacterial, mammahan, baculo virus/insect, vaccinia, Semliki Forest virus (SFV), Alphaviruses (such as, Sindbis, Venezuelan Equine Encephahtis (VEE)), mammahan, yeast and Xenopus expression systems, weU known in the art.
  • Particularly preferred expression systems are mammahan ceU lines, vaccinia, Sindbis, eucaryotic layered vector initiation systems (e.g., US Patent No. 6,015,686, US Patent No. 5, 814,482, US Patent No. 6,015,694, US Patent No. 5,789,245, EP 1029068A2, WO 9918226A2/A3, EP 00907746A2, WO 9738087 A2), insect and yeast systems.
  • the synthetic DNA fragments for the expression cassettes of the present invention may be cloned into the foUowing eucaryotic expression vectors: pCMVKm2, for transient expression assays and DNA immunization studies, the pCMNKn ⁇ vector is derived from pCMV6a (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res.
  • the pCMVKm2 vector differs from the pCMV-link vector only in that a polylinker site is inserted into pCMVK ⁇ to generate pCMV-link; pES ⁇ 2dhfr and pCMVPLEdhfr, for expression in Chinese Hamster Ovary (CHO) ceUs; and, pAcC13, a shuttle vector for use in the Baculovirus expression system (pAcC13, is derived from pAcC12 which is described by Munemitsu S., et al., Mol Cell Biol.
  • pCMNPLEdhfr was as foUows.
  • EMCN IRES internal ribosome entry site leader
  • pET-23d ⁇ ovagen, Inc., MUwaukee, WI
  • the dhfr gene was PCR-amplified from pES ⁇ 2dhfr to give a product with a Gly-Gly-Gly-Ser spacer in place of the translation stop codon and inserted as an Nco-Bam ⁇ il fragment to give pET-E-DHFR.
  • the attenuated neo gene was PCR amplified from a pSN2Neo (Clontech, Palo Alto, CA) derivative and inserted into the unique Bam ⁇ Tl site of pET-E-DHFR to give pET-E-DHFR/Neo (m2) .
  • CMN enhancer/promoter plus Intron A was transferred from pCMV6a (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986) as a HzV ⁇ dIII-S ⁇ /1 fragment into pUC19 (New England Biolabs, Inc., Beverly, MA).
  • the vector backbone of pUC19 was deleted from the Ndel to the Sapl sites.
  • the above described D ⁇ FR cassette was added to the construct such that the EMCN IRES foUowed the CMN promoter.
  • the vector also contained an amp r gene and an SN40 origin of rephcation.
  • a number of mammahan ceU lines are known in the art and include immortalized ceU lines avaUable from the American Type Culture CoUection (AT. CC), such as, but not limited to, Chinese hamster ovary (C ⁇ O) ceUs, ⁇ eLa ceUs, baby hamster kidney (B ⁇ K) ceUs, monkey kidney ceUs (COS), as weU as others.
  • AT. CC American Type Culture CoUection
  • C ⁇ O Chinese hamster ovary
  • ⁇ eLa ceUs ⁇ eLa ceUs
  • B ⁇ K baby hamster kidney
  • COS monkey kidney ceUs
  • SimUarly, bacterial hosts such as E. coli, Bacillus subtilis, and Streptococcus spp. , wUl find use with the present expression constructs.
  • Yeast hosts useful in the present invention include inter alia, Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Candida albicans, Candida maltosa, Hansenula polymorpha, Kluyveromyces fragilis, Kluyveromyces lactis, Pichia guillerimondii, Pichia pastoris, Schizosaccharomyces pombe and Yarrowia lipolytica.
  • Insect ceUs for use with baculovirus expression vectors include, inter alia, Aedes aegypti, Autographa californica, Bombyx mori, Drosophila melanogaster, Spodoptera frugiperda, and Trichoplusia ni. See, e.g., Summers and Smith, Texas Agricultural Experiment Station Bulletin No. 555 (1987).
  • Viral vectors can be used for the production of particles in eucaryotic ceUs, such as those derived from the pox famUy of viruses, including vaccinia virus and avian poxvirus.
  • AdditionaUy a vaccinia based infection/transfection system, as described in Tomei et al., J. Virol. (1993) 67:4017-4026 and Selby et al., J. Gen. Virol. (1993) 74: 1103 -1113, wiU also find use with the present invention.
  • ceUs are first infected in vitro with a vaccinia vims recombinant that encodes the bacteriophage T7 RNA polymerase.
  • This polymerase displays unparalleled specificity in that it only transcribes templates bearing T7 promoters.
  • ceUs are transfected with the DNA of interest, driven by a T7 promoter.
  • the polymerase expressed in the cytoplasm from the vaccinia virus recombinant transcribes the transfected DNA into RNA which is then translated into protein by the host translational machinery.
  • T7 can be added as a purified protein or enzyme as in the "Progenitor" system (Studier and Moffatt, . Mol. Biol. (1986) _89: 113-130).
  • the method provides for high level, transient, cytoplasmic production of large quantities of RNA and its translation product(s).
  • the VLPS are produced by growing host ceUs transformed by an expression vector under conditions whereby the particle-forming polypeptide is expressed and VLPs can be formed.
  • the selection of the appropriate growth conditions is within the skUl of the art. If the VLPs are formed intraceUularly, the cells are then disrupted, using chemical, physical or mechanical means, which lyse the ceUs yet keep the VLPs substantiaUy intact.
  • Such methods are known to those of skUl in the art and are described in, e.g., Protein Purification Applications: A Practical Approach, (E.L.V. Harris and S. Angal, Eds., 1990).
  • the particles are then isolated (or substantiaUy purified) using methods that preserve the integrity thereof, such as, by gradient centrifugation, e.g., cesium chloride (CsCl) sucrose gradients, pelleting and the like (see, e.g., Kirnbauer et al. /. Virol. (1993) 67:6929-6936), as weU as standard purification techniques including, e.g., ion exchange and gel filtration chromatography.
  • VLPs produced by ceUs containing the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can be used to ehcit an immune response when administered to a subject.
  • VLPs can be produced by mammahan ceUs carrying the synthetic expression cassettes at levels previously not possible.
  • the VLPs can comprise a variety of antigens in addition to the Gag polypeptide (e.g., Gag-protease, Gag-polymerase, Env, synthetic Env, etc.).
  • Purified VLPs, produced using the synthetic expression cassettes ofthe present invention can be administered to a vertebrate subject, usuaUy in the form of vaccine compositions.
  • Combination vaccines may also be used, where such vaccines contain, for example, an adjuvant subunit protein (e.g., Env).
  • Administration can take place using the VLPs formulated alone or formulated with other antigens.
  • VLPs can be administered prior to, concurrent with, or subsequent to, dehvery of the synthetic expression cassettes for DNA immunization (see below) and/or dehvery of other vaccines.
  • site of VLP administration may be the same or different as other vaccine compositions that are being administered.
  • Gene dehvery can be accomphshed by a number of methods including, but are not limited to, immunization with DNA, alphavirus vectors, pox virus vectors, and vaccinia virus vectors.
  • VLP immune-stimulating (or vaccine) compositions can include various excipients, adjuvants, carriers, auxiliary substances, modulating agents, and the like.
  • the immune stimulating compositions will include an amount of the VLP/antigen sufficient to mount an immunological response.
  • An appropriate effective amount can be determined by one of skiU in the art.
  • Such an amount wiU faU in a relatively broad range that can be determined through routine trials and will generaUy be an amount on the order of about 0.1 ⁇ g to about 1000 ⁇ g, more preferably about 1 ⁇ g to about 300 ⁇ g, of VLP/antigen.
  • a carrier is optionaUy present which is a molecule that does not itseU induce the production of antibodies harmful to the individual receiving the composition.
  • Suitable carriers are typically large, slowly metabolized macromolecules such as proteins, polysaccharides, polylactic acids, polyglycoUic acids, polymeric amino acids, amino acid copolymers, hpid aggregates (such as oU droplets or hposomes), and inactive virus particles.
  • particulate carriers include those derived from polymethyl methacrylate polymers, as weU as microparticles derived from poly(lactides) and poly(lactide-co-glycohdes), known as PLG. See, e.g., Jeffery et al., Pharm. Res.
  • the antigen may be conjugated to a bacterial toxoid, such as toxoid from diphtheria, tetanus, cholera, etc., as weU as toxins derived from E. coli.
  • Adjuvants may also be used to enhance the effectiveness ofthe compositions.
  • adjuvants include, but are not limited to: (1) aluminum salts (alum), such as aluminum hydroxide, aluminum phosphate, aluminum suffate, etc.; (2) oU-in- water emulsion formulations (with or without other specific immunostimulating agents such as muramyl peptides (see below) or bacterial ceU waU components), such as for example (a) MF59 (International Pubhcation No.
  • WO 90/14837 containing 5% Squalene, 0.5% Tween 80, and 0.5% Span 85 (optionaUy containing various amounts of MTP-P ⁇ (see below), although not required) formulated into submicron particles using a microfluidizer such as Model HOY microfluidizer (Microfluidics, Newton, MA), (b) SAF, containing 10% Squalane, 0.4% Tween 80, 5% pluronic-blocked polymer L121, and thr-MDP (see below) either microfluidized into a submicron emulsion or vortexed to generate a larger particle size emulsion, and (c) RibiTM adjuvant system (RAS), (Ribi Immunochem, HamUton, MT) containing 2% Squalene, 0.2% Tween 80, and one or more bacterial ceU waU components from the group consisting of monophosphoryhpid A (MPL), trehalose dimycolate (TDM), and ce
  • ⁇ Polymeric molecules include double and single stranded RNA and DNA, and backbone modifications thereof, for example, methylphosphonate linkages; or (7) detoxified mutants of a bacterial ADP-ribosylating toxin such as a cholera toxin (CT), a pertussis toxin (PT), or an E.
  • CT cholera toxin
  • PT pertussis toxin
  • coli heat-labUe toxin particularly LT-K63 (where lysine is substituted for the wUd-type amino acid at position 63)
  • LT-R72 where arginine is substituted for the wUd-type amino acid at position 72
  • CT-S109 where serine is substituted for the wUd-type amino acid at position 109
  • PT-K9/G129 where lysine is substituted for the wUd-type amino acid at position 9 and glycine substituted at position 129)
  • W093/13202 and W092/19265 International Pubhcation Nos. W093/13202 and W092/19265
  • polymeric molecules include alternative polymer backbone structures such as, but not limited to, polyvinyl backbones (Pitha, Biochem Biophys Acta, 204:39. 1970a; Pitha, Biopolymers, 9:965, 1970b), and morpholino backbones (Summerton, J., et al, U.S. Patent No. 5,142,047, issued 08/25/92; Summerton, J., et al, U.S. Patent No.
  • Muramyl peptides include, but are not limited to, N-acetyl-muramyl-L- threonyl-D-isoglutamine (thr-MDP) , N-acteyl-normuramyl-L-alanyl-D-isogluatme (nor-MDP) , N-acety ⁇ muramyl-L-alanyl-D-isogluatmmyl-L-alanme-2-(r-2'-dipalmitoyl- ->n-glycero-3-huydroxyphosphoryloxy)-ethylamine (MTP-P ⁇ ), etc.
  • thr-MDP N-acetyl-muramyl-L- threonyl-D-isoglutamine
  • nor-MDP N-acteyl-normuramyl-L-alanyl-D-isogluatme
  • MTP-P ⁇ N-acety ⁇
  • Dosage treatment with the VLP composition may be a single dose schedule or a multiple dose schedule.
  • a multiple dose schedule is one in which a primary course of vaccination may be with 1-10 separate doses, foUowed by other doses given at subsequent time intervals, chosen to maintain and/or reinforce the immune response, for example at 1-4 months for a second dose, and if needed, a subsequent dose(s) after several months.
  • the dosage regimen wiU also, at least in part, be determined by the need of the subject and be dependent on the judgment of the practitioner.
  • the antigen carrying VLPs are generaUy administered prior to primary infection with the pathogen of interest. If treatment is desired, e.g., the reduction of symptoms or recurrences, the VLP compositions are generaUy administered subsequent to primary infection.
  • a number of viral based systems have been developed for use as gene transfer vectors for mammahan host ceUs.
  • retroviruses in particular, lentiviral vectors
  • a coding sequence of interest can be inserted into a gene dehvery vector and packaged in retroviral particles using techniques known in the art. Recombinant virus can then be isolated and dehvered to ceUs ofthe subject either in vivo or ex vivo.
  • gene transfer vectors can be constructed to encode a cytokine or other immunomodulatory molecule.
  • nucleic acid sequences encoding native IL-2 and gamma-interferon can be obtained as described in US Patent Nos.
  • immunomodulatory molecules for use herein include the foUowing: EL-1 and IL-2 (Karupiah et al. (1990) J. Immunology 144:290-298, Weber et al. (1987) J. Exp. Med. 166:1716-1733, Gansbacher et al. (1990) J. Exp. Med. 172:1217-1224, and U.S. Patent No. 4,738,927); IL-3 and IL-4 (Tepper et al. (1989) Cell 57:503-512, Golumbek et al. (1991) Science 254:713-716, and U.S. Patent No.
  • Immunomodulatory factors may also be agonists, antagonists, or hgands for these molecules.
  • soluble forms of receptors can often behave as antagonists for these types of factors, as can mutated forms of the factors themselves.
  • Nucleic acid molecules that encode the above-described substances, as weU as other nucleic acid molecules that are advantageous for use within the present invention may be readUy obtained from a variety of sources, including, for example, depositories such as the American Type Culture CoUection, or from commercial sources such as British Bio-Technology Limited (Cowley, Oxford England).
  • BBG 12 containing the GM-CSF gene coding for the mature protein of 127 amino acids
  • BBG 6 which contains sequences encoding gamma interferon
  • A.T.C.C Deposit No. 39656 which contains sequences encoding TNF
  • A.T.C.C. Deposit No. 20663 which contains sequences encoding alpha- interferon
  • A.T.C.C Deposit Nos. 31902, 31902 and 39517 which contain sequences encoding beta-interferon
  • A.T.C.C. Deposit No. 67024 which contains a sequence which encodes Interleukin- lb
  • A.T.C.C Deposit Nos which contains a sequence which encodes Interleukin- lb
  • Plasmids containing cytokine genes or immunomodulatory genes can be digested with appropriate restriction enzymes, and DNA fragments containing the particular gene of interest can be inserted into a gene transfer vector using standard molecular biology techniques. (See, e.g., Sambrook et al., supra., or Ausubel et al. (eds) Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, Greene Pubhshing and WUey-Interscience).
  • Polynucleotide sequences coding for the above-described molecules can be obtained using recombinant methods, such as by screening cDNA and genomic libraries from ceUs expressing the gene, or by deriving the gene from a vector known to include the same.
  • plasmids which contain sequences that encode altered ceUular products may be obtained from a depository such as the A.T.C.C, or from commercial sources.
  • Plasmids containing the nucleotide sequences of interest can be digested with appropriate restriction enzymes, and DNA fragments containing the nucleotide sequences can be inserted into a gene transfer vector using standard molecular biology techniques.
  • cDNA sequences for use with the present invention may be obtained from cells which express or contain the sequences, using standard techniques, such as phenol extraction and PCR of cDNA or genomic DNA. See, e.g., Sambrook et al., supra, for a description of techniques used to obtain and isolate DNA. Briefly, mRNA from a ceU which expresses the gene of interest can be reverse transcribed with reverse transcriptase using oligo-dT or random primers. The single stranded cDNA may then be amplified by PCR (see U.S. Patent Nos. 4,683,202, 4,683,195 and 4,800,159, see also PCR Technology: Principles and Applications for DNA
  • the nucleotide sequence of interest can also be produced syntheticaUy, rather than cloned, using a DNA synthesizer (e.g., an Applied Biosystems Model 392 DNA Synthesizer, available from ABI, Foster City, CaUfornia).
  • the nucleotide sequence can be designed with the appropriate codons for the expression product desired.
  • the complete sequence is assembled from overlapping oligonucleotides prepared by standard methods and assembled into a complete coding sequence. See, e.g., Edge (1981) Nature 292:756; Nambair et al. (1984) Science 223:1299; Jay et al. (1984) J. Biol. Chem. 259:6311.
  • the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can be employed in the construction of packaging ceU lines for use with retroviral vectors.
  • MMV murine leukemia virus
  • Lentiviral vectors typicaUy comprise a 5' lentiviral LTR, a tRNA binding site, a packaging signal, a promoter operably linked to one or more genes of interest, an origin of second strand DNA synthesis and a 3' lentiviral LTR, wherein the lentiviral vector contains a nuclear transport element.
  • the nuclear transport element may be located either upstream (5') or downstream (3') of a coding sequence of interest (for example, a synthetic Gag or Env expression cassette ofthe present invention).
  • the nuclear transport element is not RRE.
  • the packaging signal is an extended packaging signal.
  • the promoter is a tissue specific promoter, or, alternatively, a promoter such as CMN.
  • the lentiviral vector further comprises an internal ribosome entry site.
  • lentiviruses may be utilized within the context of the present invention, including for example, lentiviruses selected from the group consisting of HIN, HIV-1, HIV-2, HV and SIV.
  • host ceUs e.g., packaging ceU lines
  • packaging ceU line comprising an expression cassette that comprises a sequence encoding synthetic Gag-polymerase, and a nuclear transport element, wherein the promoter is operably linked to the sequence encoding Gag-polymerase.
  • Packaging cell lines may further comprise a promoter and a sequence encoding tat, rev, or an envelope, wherein the promoter is operably linked to the sequence encoding tat, rev, Env or sequences encoding modified versions of these proteins.
  • the packaging ceU line may further comprise a sequence encoding any one or more of other HIV gene encoding sequences.
  • the expression cassette (carrying, for example, the synthetic Gag-polymerase) is stably integrated.
  • the packaging ceU line upon introduction of a lentiviral vector, typicaUy produces particles.
  • the promoter regulating expression ofthe synthetic expression cassette may be inducible.
  • the packaging ceU line upon introduction of a lentiviral vector, produces particles that are essentiaUy free of replication competent virus.
  • Packaging ceU hnes comprising an expression cassette which directs the expression of a synthetic Gag-polymerase gene or comprising an expression cassette which directs the expression of a synthetic Env genes described herein. (See, also, Andre, S., et al, Journal of Virology 72(2): 1497-1503, 1998; Haas, J., et al, Current Biology 6(3):315-324, 1996) for a description of other modified Env sequences).
  • a lentiviral vector is introduced into the packaging ceU line to produce a vector producing ceU line.
  • lentiviral vectors can be designed to carry or express a selected gene(s) or sequences of interest.
  • Lentiviral vectors may be readily constructed from a wide variety of lentiviruses (see RNA Tumor Viruses, Second Edition, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1985).
  • Representative examples of lentiviruses included HIV, HIV-1, HIV-2, FIN and SIN.
  • Such lentiviruses may either be obtained from patient isolates, or, more preferably, from depositories or coUections such as the American Type Culture CoUection, or isolated from known sources using avaUable techniques.
  • LTRs may be derived from an HIN, a packaging signal from SIN, and an origin of second strand synthesis from HrN-2.
  • Lentiviral vector constructs may comprise a 5' lentiviral LTR, a tR ⁇ A binding site, a packaging signal, one or more heterologous sequences, an origin of second strand D ⁇ A synthesis and a 3' LTR, wherein said lentiviral vector contains a nuclear transport element that is not RRE.
  • LTRs Long Terminal Repeats
  • U5 Long Terminal Repeats
  • U3 Long Terminal Repeats
  • These elements contain a variety of signals which are responsible for the biological activity of a retrovirus, including for example, promoter and enhancer elements which are located within U3.
  • LTRs may be readUy identified in the pro virus (integrated D ⁇ A form) due to their precise duphcation at either end of the genome.
  • a 5' LTR should be understood to include a 5' promoter element and sufficient LTR sequence to aUow reverse transcription and integration of the D ⁇ A form of the vector.
  • the 3' LTR should be understood to include a polyadenylation signal, and sufficient LTR sequence to aUow reverse transcription and integration of the D ⁇ A form of the vector.
  • the tR ⁇ A binding site and origin of second strand D ⁇ A synthesis are also important for a retrovirus to be biologicaUy active, and may be readUy identified by one of skiU in the art.
  • retroviral tR ⁇ A binds to a tR ⁇ A binding site by Watson-Crick base pairing, and is carried with the retrovirus genome into a viral particle.
  • the tRNA is then utilized as a primer for DNA synthesis by reverse transcriptase.
  • the tRNA binding site may be readUy identified based upon its location just downstream from the 5'LTR.
  • the origin of second strand DNA synthesis is, as its name implies, important for the second strand DNA synthesis of a retrovirus. This region, which is also referred to as the poly-purine tract, is located just upstream of the 3'LTR.
  • recombinant retroviral vector constructs may also comprise a packaging signal, as weU as one or more genes or coding sequences of interest.
  • the lentiviral vectors have a nuclear transport element which, in preferred embodiments is not RRE.
  • suitable nuclear transport elements include the element in Rous sarcoma vims (Ogert, et al, J ViroL 70, 3834- 3843, 1996), the element in Rous sarcoma virus (Liu & Mertz, Genes & Dev., 9, 1766- 1789, 1995) and the element in the genome of simian retrovirus type I (Zolotukhin, et al., J Virol. 68, 7944-7952, 1994).
  • Other potential elements include the elements in the histone gene (Kedes, Annu. Rev. Biochem.
  • Recombinant lentiviral vector constructs typicaUy lack both Gag-polymerase and Env coding sequences.
  • Recombinant lentiviral vector typicaUy contain less than 20, preferably 15, more preferably 10, and most preferably 8 consecutive nucleotides found in Gag-polymerase and Env genes.
  • One advantage ofthe present invention is that the synthetic Gag-polymerase expression cassettes, which can be used to construct packaging ceU lines for the recombinant retroviral vector constructs, have httle homology to wUd-type Gag-polymerase sequences and thus considerably reduce or eliminate the possibihty of homologous recombination between the synthetic and wUd-type sequences.
  • Lentiviral vectors may also include tissue-specific promoters to drive expression of one or more genes or sequences of interest. Lentiviral vector constructs may be generated such that more than one gene of interest is expressed. This may be accomphshed through the use of di- or oligo- cistronic cassettes (e.g., where the coding regions are separated by 80 nucleotides or less, see generally Levin et al., Gene 108:167-174, 1991), or through the use of Internal Ribosome Entry Sites ("IRES").
  • IRS Internal Ribosome Entry Sites
  • Packaging ceU lines suitable for use with the above described recombinant retroviral vector constructs may be readUy prepared given the disclosure provided herein.
  • the parent ceU line from which the packaging ceU line is derived can be selected from a variety of mammahan ceU lines, including for example, 293, RD, COS- 7, CHO, BHK, NERO, HT1080, and myeloma ceUs.
  • one or more expression cassettes are introduced into the ceU line in order to complement or supply in trans components of the vector which have been deleted.
  • suitable synthetic HIN polynucleotide sequences have been described herein for use in expression cassettes ofthe present invention. As described above, the native and/or synthetic coding sequences may also be utilized in these expression cassettes.
  • packaging ceU lines can be generated.
  • packaging cell line comprising an expression cassette that comprises a sequence encoding synthetic Gag-polymerase, and a nuclear transport element, wherein the promoter is operably linked to the sequence encoding Gag-polymerase.
  • packaging ceU lines comprising a promoter and a sequence encoding tat, rev, Env, or other HIN antigens or epitopes derived therefrom, wherein the promoter is operably linked to the sequence encoding tat, rev, Env, or the HIN antigen or epitope.
  • the packaging ceU hne may comprise a sequence encoding any one or more of tat, rev, nef, vif, vpu or vpr.
  • the packaging ceU line may contain only tat, rev, nef, vif, vpu, or vpr alone, tat rev and nef, nef and vif, nef and vpu, nef and vpr, vif and vpu, vif and vpr, vpu and vpr, nef vif and vpu, nef vif and vpr, nef vpu and vpr, vif vpu and vpr, aU four of nef, vif, vpu, and vpr, etc.
  • the expression cassette is stably integrated.
  • the packaging ceU line upon introduction of a lentiviral vector, produces particles.
  • the promoter is inducible.
  • the packaging ceU hne upon introduction of a lentiviral vector, produces particles that are free of replication competent virus.
  • the synthetic cassettes containing modified coding sequences are transfected into a selected ceU line.
  • Transfected ceUs are selected that (i) carry, typicaUy, integrated, stable copies of the HIN coding sequences, and (ii) are expressing acceptable levels of these polypeptides (expression can be evaluated by methods known in the prior art in view of the teachings of the present disclosure). The ability of the ceU line to produce VLPs may also be verified.
  • a sequence of interest is constructed into a suitable viral vector as discussed above.
  • This defective virus is then transfected into the packaging ceU hne.
  • the packaging ceU line provides the viral functions necessary for producing virus-like particles into which the defective viral genome, containing the sequence of interest, are packaged.
  • These VLPs are then isolated and can be used, for example, in gene dehvery or gene therapy.
  • packaging ceU lines can also be used to produce VLPs alone, which can, for example, be used as adjuvants for administration with other antigens or in vaccine compositions.
  • co-expression of a selected sequence of interest encoding a polypeptide (for example, an antigen) in the packaging ceU line can also result in the entrapment and/or association of the selected polypeptide in/with the VLPs.
  • Various forms of the different embodiments of the present invention e.g., synthetic constructs may be combined.
  • HIV antigens can be included in DNA immunization constructs containing, for example, a synthetic Env expression cassettes, a synthetic Gag expression cassette, a synthetic pol-derived polypeptide expression cassette, a synthetic expression cassette comprising sequences encoding one or more accessory or regulatory genes (e.g., tat, rev, nef, vif, vpu, vpr), and/or a synthetic Gag expression cassette fused in-frame to a coding sequence for the polypeptide antigen (synthetic or wUd-type), where expression of the construct results in NLPs presenting the antigen of interest.
  • a synthetic Env expression cassettes e.g., tat, rev, nef, vif, vpu, vpr
  • synthetic Gag expression cassette e.g., tat, rev, nef, vif, vpu, vpr
  • DNA immunization using synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can be performed, for example, as foUows.
  • Mice are immunized with a tat/rev/nef synthetic expression cassette.
  • Other mice are immunized with a tat/rev/nef wUd type expression cassette.
  • Mouse immunizations with plasmid- DNAs typicaUy show that the synthetic expression cassettes provide a clear improvement of immunogenicity relative to the native expression cassettes.
  • a second boost immunization wiU induce a secondary immune response, for example, after approximately two weeks.
  • the results of CTL assays typicaUy show increased potency of synthetic expression cassettes for induction of cytotoxic T- lymphocyte (CTL) responses by DNA immunization.
  • CTL cytotoxic T- lymphocyte
  • Polynucleotide sequences coding for the above-described molecules can be obtained using recombinant methods, such as by screening cDNA and genomic libraries from ceUs expressing the gene, or by deriving the gene from a vector known to include the same. Furthermore, the desired gene can be isolated directly from ceUs and tissues containing the same, using standard techniques, such as phenol extraction and PCR of cDNA or genomic DNA. See, e.g., Sambrook et al., supra, for a description of techniques used to obtain and isolate DNA. The gene of interest can also be produced syntheticaUy, rather than cloned. The nucleotide sequence can be designed with the appropriate codons for the particular amino acid sequence desired.
  • one wiU select preferred codons for the intended host in which the sequence wiU be expressed.
  • the complete sequence is assembled from overlapping oligonucleotides prepared by standard methods and assembled into a complete coding sequence. See, e.g., Edge, Nature (1981) 292:756; Nambair et al., Science (1984) 223:1299; Jay et al., J. Biol. Chem. (1984) 259:6311; Stemmer, W.P.C, (1995) Gene 164:49-53.
  • polynucleotides encoding selected antigens are separately cloned into expression vectors (e.g., Env-coding polynucleotide in a first vector, Gag-coding polynucleotide in a second vector, Pol-derived polypeptide-coding polynucleotide in a third vector, tat-, rev-, nef-, vif-, vpu-, vpr-coding polynucleotides in further vectors, etc.).
  • expression vectors e.g., Env-coding polynucleotide in a first vector, Gag-coding polynucleotide in a second vector, Pol-derived polypeptide-coding polynucleotide in a third vector, tat-, rev-, nef-, vif-, vpu-, vpr-coding polynucleotides in further vectors, etc.
  • the antigen is inserted into or adjacent a synthetic Gag coding sequence such that when the combined sequence is expressed it results in the production of VLPs comprising the Gag polypeptide and the antigen of interest, e.g., Env (native or modified) or other antigen(s) (native or modified) derived from HIV.
  • the antigen of interest e.g., Env (native or modified) or other antigen(s) (native or modified) derived from HIV.
  • Insertions can be made within the coding sequence or at either end of the coding sequence (5', amino terminus of the expressed Gag polypeptide; or 3', carboxy terminus ofthe expressed Gag polypeptide) (Wagner, R., et al, Arch Virol 127:117- 137, 1992; Wagner, R., et al., Virology 200:162-175, 1994; Wu, X., et al., J. Virol.
  • immunogenicity of the high level expressing synthetic Gag expression cassettes can be increased by the insertion of different structural or non-structural HIV antigens, multi- epitope cassettes, or cytokine sequences into deleted regions of Gag sequence. Such deletions may be generated foUowing the teachings of the present invention and information available to one of ordinary skiU in the art.
  • One possible advantage of this approach relative to using fuU-length sequences fused to heterologous polypeptides, can be higher expression/secretion efficiency of the expression product.
  • the polynucleotide can contain coding sequences at the 5' end that encode a signal for addition of a myristic moiety to the Gag-containing polypeptide (e.g., sequences that encode Met-Gly).
  • Gag-containing polypeptide constructs to form VLPs can be empiricaUy determined foUowing the teachings of the present specification.
  • the synthetic expression cassettes can also include control elements operably linked to the coding sequence, which aUow for the expression of the gene in vivo in the subject species.
  • typical promoters for mammahan ceU expression include the S V40 early promoter, a CMV promoter such as the CMV immediate early promoter, the mouse mammary tumor vims LTR promoter, the adenovirus major late promoter (Ad MLP), and the herpes simplex virus promoter, among others.
  • Other nonviral promoters, such as a promoter derived from the murine metaUothionein gene, wiU also find use for mammahan expression.
  • transcription termination and polyadenylation sequences wiU also be present, located 3' to the translation stop codon.
  • a sequence for optimization of initiation of translation located 5' to the coding sequence, is also present.
  • transcription terminator/polyadenylation signals include those derived from S V40, as described in Sambrook et al., supra, as weU as a bovine growth hormone terminator sequence.
  • Enhancer elements may also be used herein to increase expression levels of the mammahan constmcts.
  • Examples include the SV40 early gene enhancer, as described in Dijkema et al., EMBO J. (1985) 4:761, the enhancer/promoter derived from the long terminal repeat (LTR) of the Rous Sarcoma Virus, as described in Gorman et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1982b) 79:6777 and elements derived from human CMV, as described in Boshart et al., Cell (1985) 41:521, such as elements included in the CMV intron A sequence.
  • plasmids can be constructed which include a chimeric antigen- coding gene sequences, encoding, e.g., multiple antigens/epitopes of interest, for example derived from more than one viral isolate.
  • the antigen coding sequences precede or foUow the synthetic coding sequence and the chimeric transcription unit wiU have a single open reading frame encoding both the antigen of interest and the synthetic coding sequences.
  • multi-cistronic cassettes e.g., bi-cistronic cassettes
  • EMCV IRES EMCV IRES
  • a nucleic acid immunizing composition may comprise, for example, the foUowing: a first expression vector comprising a Gag expression cassette, a second vector comprising an Env expression cassette, and a third expression vector comprising a Pol expression cassette, or one or more coding region of Pol (e.g., Prot, RT, RNase, Int), wherein further antigen coding sequences may be associated with the Pol expression, such antigens may be obtained, for example, from accessory genes (e.g., vpr, vpu, vif), regulatory genes (e.g., nef, tat, rev), or portions of the Pol sequences (e.g., Prot, RT, RNase, Int)).
  • accessory genes e.g., vpr, vpu, vif
  • regulatory genes e.g., nef, tat, rev
  • portions of the Pol sequences e.g., Prot, RT, RNase, In
  • a nucleic acid immunizing composition may comprise, for example, an expression cassette comprising any of the synthetic polynucleotide sequences of the present invention.
  • a nucleic acid immunizing composition may comprise, for example, an expression cassette comprising coding sequences for a number of HIV genes (or sequences derived from such genes) wherein the coding sequences are in-frame and under the control of a single promoter, for example, Gag- Env constructs, Tat-Rev-Nef constmcts, P2Pol-tat-rev-nef constmcts, etc.
  • the synthetic coding sequences of the present invention may be combined in any number of combinations depending on the coding sequence products (i.e., HIV polypeptides) to which, for example, an immunological response is desired to be raised.
  • synthetic coding sequences for multiple HIV-derived polypeptides may be constracted into a polycistronic message under the control of a single promoter wherein IRES are placed adjacent the coding sequence for each encoded polypeptide. Once complete, the constmcts are used for nucleic acid immunization using standard gene dehvery protocols. Methods for gene dehvery are known in the art.
  • Genes can be dehvered either directly to the vertebrate subject or, alternatively, dehvered ex vivo, to ceUs derived from the subject and the ceUs reimplanted in the subject.
  • retro viruses provide a convenient platform for gene dehvery systems. Selected sequences can be inserted into a vector and packaged in retroviral particles using techniques known in the art. The recombinant virus can then be isolated and dehvered to ceUs of the subject either in vivo or ex vivo.
  • retroviral systems have been described (U.S. Patent No. 5,219,740; MiUer and Rosman, BioTechniques (1989) 7:980-990; MiUer, A.D., Human Gene Therapy
  • adenovirus vectors have also been described. Unlike retroviruses which integrate into the host genome, adenoviruses persist extrachromosomaUy thus minimizing the risks associated with insertional mutagenesis (Haj-Ahmad and Graham, /. Virol (1986) 57:267-274; Bett et al., J. Virol. (1993) 67:5911-5921; Mittereder et al., Human Gene Therapy (1994) 5:717-729; Seth et al., J. Virol (1994) 68:933-940; Barr et al., Gene Therapy (1994) f.51-58; Berkner, K.L.
  • AAV vectors can be readUy constracted using techniques weU known in the art. See, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 5,173,414 and 5,139,941; International Pubhcation Nos. WO 92/01070 (pubhshed 23 January 1992) and WO 93/03769 (pubhshed 4 March 1993); Lebkowski et al., Molec. Cell. Biol. (1988) 8:3988-3996; Vincent et al., Vaccines 90 (1990) (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory
  • Another vector system useful for delivering the polynucleotides of the present invention is the entericaUy administered recombinant poxvirus vaccines described by SmaU, Jr., P.A., et al. (U.S. Patent No. 5,676,950, issued October 14, 1997).
  • Additional viral vectors which wUl find use for delivering the nucleic acid molecules encoding the antigens of interest include those derived from the pox famUy of viruses, including vaccinia vims and avian poxvirus.
  • vaccinia virus recombinants expressing the genes can be constracted as foUows.
  • the DNA encoding the particular synthetic HIV polypeptide coding sequence is first inserted into an appropriate vector so that it is adjacent to a vaccinia promoter and flanking vaccinia DNA sequences, such as the sequence encoding thymidine kinase (TK). This vector is then used to transfect ceUs which are simultaneously infected with vaccinia.
  • TK thymidine kinase
  • Homologous recombination serves to insert the vaccinia promoter plus the gene encoding the coding sequences of interest into the viral genome.
  • the resulting TK " recombinant can be selected by culturing the ceUs in the presence of 5- bromodeoxyuridine and picking viral plaques resistant thereto.
  • avipoxviruses such as the fowlpox and canarypox viruses, can also be used to dehver the genes. Recombinant avipox viruses, expressing immunogens from mammahan pathogens, are known to confer protective immunity when administered to non-avian species.
  • an avipox vector is particularly desirable in human and other mammahan species since members of the avipox genus can only productively rephcate in susceptible avian species and therefore are not infective in mammahan ceUs.
  • Methods for producing recombinant avipoxviruses are known in the art and employ genetic recombination, as described above with respect to the production of vaccinia viruses. See, e.g., WO 91/12882; WO 89/03429; and WO 92/03545.
  • Molecular conjugate vectors such as the adenovirus chimeric vectors described in Michael et al., J. Biol. Chem. (1993) 268:6866-6869 and Wagner et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1992) 89:6099-6103, can also be used for gene dehvery.
  • Sindbis-virus derived vectors useful for the practice of the instant methods, see, Dubensky et al., J. Virol. (1996) 70:508-519; and International Pubhcation Nos. WO 95/07995 and WO 96/17072; as weU as, Dubensky, Jr., T.W., et al., U.S. Patent No.
  • Preferred expression systems include, but are not mited to, eucaryotic layered vector initiation systems (e.g., US Patent No. 6,015,686, US Patent No. 5, 814,482, US Patent No. 6,015,694, US Patent No. 5,789,245, EP 1029068A2, WO 9918226A2/A3, EP 00907746A2, WO 9738087 A2).
  • a vaccinia based infection/transfection system can be conveniently used to provide for inducible, transient expression of the coding sequences of interest in a host ceU.
  • ceUs are first infected in vitro with a vaccinia vims recombinant that encodes the bacteriophage T7 RNA polymerase.
  • This polymerase displays extraordinar specificity in that it only transcribes templates bearing T7 promoters.
  • ceUs are transfected with the polynucleotide of interest, driven by a T7 promoter.
  • the polymerase expressed in the cytoplasm from the vaccinia virus recombinant transcribes the transfected DNA into RNA which is then translated into protein by the host translational machinery.
  • the method provides for high level, transient, cytoplasmic production of large quantities of RNA and its translation products. See, e.g., Elroy-Stein and Moss, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1990) 87:6743-6747; Fuerst et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1986) 83:8122-8126.
  • an amplification system can be used that wiU lead to high level expression foUowing introduction into host cells.
  • a T7 RNA polymerase promoter preceding the coding region for T7 RNA polymerase can be engineered. Translation of RNA derived from this template wiU generate T7 RNA polymerase which in turn wiU transcribe more template. Concomitantly, there wiU be a cDNA whose expression is under the control of the T7 promoter. Thus, some ofthe T7 RNA polymerase generated from translation of the amplification template RNA wiU lead to transcription of the desired gene. Because some T7 RNA polymerase is required to initiate the amplification, T7 RNA polymerase can be introduced into ceUs along with the template(s) to prime the transcription reaction.
  • the polymerase can be introduced as a protein or on a plasmid encoding the RNA polymerase.
  • T7 systems and their use for transforming ceUs see, e.g., International Pubhcation No. WO 94/26911; Studier and Moffatt, J. Mol Biol. (1986) 189:113-130; Deng and Wolff, Gene (1994) 143 : 245-249 ; Gao et al. , Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. ( 1994) 200: 1201 - 1206; Gao and Huang, Nuc. Acids Res. (1993) 21:2867-2872; Chen et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1994) 22:2114-2120; and U.S. Patent No. 5,135,855.
  • CMN-derived elements include, but are not limited to, the following: pCMNRm2, pCMN-link pCMVPLEdhfr, and ⁇ CMV6a (aU described above).
  • Synthetic expression cassettes of interest can also be dehvered without a viral vector.
  • the synthetic expression cassette can be packaged in hposomes prior to dehvery to the subject or to ceUs derived therefrom.
  • Lipid encapsulation is generaUy accomphshed using hposomes which are able to stably bind or entrap and retain nucleic acid.
  • the ratio of condensed D ⁇ A to hpid preparation can vary but wUl generaUy be around 1:1 (mg DNA:micromoles hpid), or more of lipid.
  • Liposomal preparations for use in the present. invention include cationic
  • Cationic hposomes have been shown to mediate intraceUular dehvery of plasmid DNA (Feigner et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1987) 84:7413-7416); mRNA (Malone et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1989) 86:6077-6081); and purified transcription factors (Debs et al., J. Biol. Chem. (1990) 265:10189-10192), in functional form.
  • Cationic hposomes are readUy avaUable.
  • N[l-2,3- dioleyloxy)propyl]-N,N,N-triethylammonium (DOTMA) hposomes are avaUable under the trademark Lipofectin, from GIBCO BRL, Grand Island, NY. (See, also, Feigner et al, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1987) 84:7413-7416).
  • Other commerciaUy avaUable hpids include (DDAB/DOPE) and DOTAP/DOPE (Boerhinger).
  • Other cationic hposomes can be prepared from readily avaUable materials using techniques weU known in the art.
  • anionic and neutral hposomes are readUy available, such as, from Avanti Polar Lipids (Birmingham, AL), or can be easUy prepared using readUy avaUable materials.
  • Such materials include phosphatidyl choline, cholesterol, phosphatidyl ethanolamine, dioleoylphosphatidyl choline (DOPC), dioleoylphosphatidyl glycerol (DOPG), dioleoylphoshatidyl ethanolamine (DOPE), among others.
  • DOPC dioleoylphosphatidyl choline
  • DOPG dioleoylphosphatidyl glycerol
  • DOPE dioleoylphoshatidyl ethanolamine
  • the hposomes can comprise multUammelar vesicles (MLVs), smaU unUameUar vesicles (SUVs), or large unUameUar vesicles (LUVs).
  • MLVs multUammelar vesicles
  • SUVs smaU unUameUar vesicles
  • LUVs large unUameUar vesicles
  • the various hposome-nucleic acid complexes are prepared using methods known in the art. See, e.g., Straubinger et al., in METHODS OF IMMUNOLOGY (1983), Vol. 101, pp. 512-527; Szoka et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1978) 75:4194-4198; Papahadjopoulos et al., Biochim. Biophys.
  • DNA and/or protein antigen(s) can also be dehvered in cochleate hpid compositions similar to those described by Papahadjopoulos et al., Biochem. Biophys. Acta. (1975) 394:483-491. See, also, U.S. Patent Nos. 4,663,161 and 4,871,488.
  • the synthetic expression cassette of interest may also be encapsulated, adsorbed to, or associated with, particulate carriers.
  • particulate carriers present multiple copies of a selected antigen to the immune system and promote trapping and retention of antigens in local lymph nodes.
  • the particles can be phagocytosed by macrophages and can enhance antigen presentation through cytokine release.
  • particulate carriers include those derived from polymethyl methacrylate polymers, as weU as microparticles derived from poly(lactides) and poly(lactide-co-glycohdes), known as PLG. See, e.g., Jeffery et al., Pharm. Res. (1993) 10:362-368; McGee JP, et al., J Microencapsul.
  • microparticles may also be manufactured in the presence of charged detergents, such as anionic or cationic detergents, to yield microparticles with a surface having a net negative or a net positive charge.
  • charged detergents such as anionic or cationic detergents
  • microparticles manufactured with anionic detergents such as hexadecyltrimethylammonium bromide (CTAB), i.e. CTAB-PLG microparticles, adsorb negatively charged macromolecules, such as DNA. (see, e.g., Infl Apphcation Number PCT/US99/17308).
  • particulate systems and polymers can be used for the in vivo or ex vivo dehvery of the gene of interest.
  • polymers such as polylysine, polyarginine, polyornithine, spermine, spermidine, as weU as conjugates of these molecules, are useful for transferring a nucleic acid of interest.
  • DEAE dextran-mediated transfection, calcium phosphate precipitation or precipitation using other insoluble inorganic salts, such as strontium phosphate, aluminum silicates including bentonite and kaolin, chromic oxide, magnesium sUicate, talc, and the like, wUl find use with the present methods.
  • AdditionaUy biohstic dehvery systems employing particulate carriers such as gold and tungsten, are especiaUy useful for delivering synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention.
  • the particles are coated with the synthetic expression cassette(s) to be dehvered and accelerated to high velocity, generaUy under a reduced atmosphere, using a gun powder discharge from a "gene gun.”
  • a gun powder discharge from a "gene gun” for a description of , such techniques, and apparatuses useful therefore, see, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 4,945,050; 5,036,006; 5,100,792; 5,179,022; 5,371,015; and 5,478,744.
  • needle- less injection systems can be used (Davis, H.L., et al, Vaccine 12:1503-1509, 1994; Bioject, Inc., Portland, OR).
  • compositions for dehvery to the vertebrate subject are formulated into compositions for dehvery to the vertebrate subject.
  • These compositions may either be prophylactic (to prevent infection) or therapeutic (to treat disease after infection).
  • the compositions wiU comprise a "therapeuticaUy effective amount" of the gene of interest such that an amount of the antigen can be produced in vivo so that an immune response is generated in the individual to which it is administered.
  • the exact amount necessary wiU vary depending on the subject being treated; the age and general condition of the subject to be treated; the capacity of the subject's immune system to synthesize antibodies; the degree of protection desired; the severity of the condition being treated; the particular antigen selected and its mode of administration, among other factors.
  • compositions wiU generaUy include one or more "pharmaceutically acceptable excipients or vehicles" such as water, saline, glycerol, polyethyleneglycol, hyaluronic acid, ethanol, etc.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable excipients or vehicles such as water, saline, glycerol, polyethyleneglycol, hyaluronic acid, ethanol, etc.
  • auxiliary substances such as wetting or emulsifying agents, pH buffering substances, and the like, may be present in such vehicles.
  • Certain facilitators of nucleic acid uptake and/or expression can also be included in the compositions or coadministered, such as, but not limited to, bupivacaine, cardiotoxin and sucrose.
  • compositions of the invention can be administered directly to the subject (e.g., as described above) or, alternatively, dehvered ex vivo, to ceUs derived from the subject, using methods such as those described above.
  • methods for the ex vivo dehvery and reimplantation of transformed ceUs into a subject are known in the art and can include, e.g., dextran-mediated transfection, calcium phosphate precipitation, polybrene mediated transfection, hpofectamine and LT-1 mediated transfection, protoplast fusion, electroporation, encapsulation of the polynucleotide(s) (with or without the corresponding antigen) in hposomes, and direct microinjection of the DNA into nuclei.
  • Direct dehvery of synthetic expression cassette compositions in vivo wUl generaUy be accomphshed with or without viral vectors, as described above, by injection using either a conventional syringe or a gene gun, such as the AcceU® gene dehvery system (Powder Ject Technologies, Inc., Oxford, England).
  • the constructs can be injected either subcutaneously, epidermaUy, intradermaUy, intramucosaUy such as nasaUy, rectaUy and vaginaUy, intraperitoneaUy, intravenously, oraUy or intramuscularly.
  • Dehvery of DNA into ceUs of the epidermis is particularly preferred as this mode of administration provides access to skin-associated lymphoid ceUs and provides for a transient presence of DNA in the recipient.
  • Other modes of administration include oral and pulmonary administration, suppositories, needle-less injection, transcutaneous and transdermal apphcations.
  • Dosage treatment may be a single dose schedule or a multiple dose schedule.
  • Administration of nucleic acids may also be combined with administration of peptides or other substances.
  • T ceUs, and related ceU types can be used for ex vivo dehvery of the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention.
  • T ceUs can be isolated from peripheral blood lymphocytes (PBLs) by a variety of procedures known to those skiUed in the art. For example, T ceU populations can be "enriched" from a population of PBLs through the removal of accessory and B ceUs.
  • T ceU enrichment can be accomphshed by the elimination of non-T ceUs using anti-MHC class II monoclonal antibodies.
  • other antibodies can be used to deplete specific populations of non-T ceUs.
  • anti-Ig antibody molecules can be used to deplete B ceUs and anti-Mad antibody molecules can be used to deplete macrophages.
  • T ceUs can be further fractionated into a number of different subpopulations by techniques known to those skUled in the art. Two major subpopulations can be isolated based on their differential expression of the ceU surface markers CD4 and CD8.
  • CD4 + ceUs can be enriched using antibodies specific for CD4 (see Cohgan et al., supra).
  • the antibodies may be coupled to a sohd support such as magnetic beads.
  • CD8+ ceUs can be enriched through the use of antibodies specific for CD4 (to remove CD4 + ceUs), or can be isolated by the use of CD8 antibodies coupled to a sohd support.
  • CD4 lymphocytes from HIN-1 infected patients can be expanded ex vivo, before or after transduction as described by Wilson et. al. (1995) /. Infect. Dis. 172:88.
  • T ceUs FoUowing purification of T ceUs, a variety of methods of genetic modification known to those skUled in the art can be performed using non- viral or viral-based gene transfer vectors constracted as described herein.
  • one such approach involves transduction of the purified T ceU population with vector-containing supernatant of cultures derived from vector producing ceUs.
  • a second approach involves co-cultivation of an irradiated monolayer of vector-producing ceUs with the purified T ceUs.
  • a third approach involves a similar co-cultivation approach; however, the purified T ceUs are pre-stimulated with various cytokines and cultured 48 hours prior to the co-cultivation with the irradiated vector producing ceUs.
  • Gene transfer vectors containing one or more synthetic expression cassette of the present invention (associated with appropriate control elements for dehvery to the isolated T ceUs) can be assembled using known methods and foUowing the guidance of the present specification.
  • a marker can be used which imparts to a mammahan ceU transduced with the gene transfer vector resistance to a cytotoxic agent.
  • the cytotoxic agent can be, but is not limited to, neomycin, aminoglycoside, tetracycline, chloramphenicol, suhonamide, actinomycin, netropsin, distamycin A, anthracycline, or pyrazinamide.
  • neomycin phosphotransferase II imparts resistance to the neomycin analogue geneticin (G418).
  • the T ceUs can also be maintained in a medium containing at least one type of growth factor prior to being selected.
  • a variety of growth factors are known in the art which sustain the growth of a particular ceU type. Examples of such growth factors are cytokine mitogens such as rE -2, IL-10, EL-12, and E -15, which promote growth and activation of lymphocytes. Certain types of ceUs are stimulated by other growth factors such as hormones, including human chorionic gonadotropin (hCG) and human growth hormone. The selection of an appropriate growth factor for a particular ceU population is readUy accomphshed by one of skUl in the art.
  • cytokine mitogens such as rE -2, IL-10, EL-12, and E -15
  • hCG human chorionic gonadotropin
  • the selection of an appropriate growth factor for a particular ceU population is readUy accomphshed by one of skUl in the art.
  • white blood ceUs such as differentiated progenitor and stem ceUs are stimulated by a variety of growth factors. More particularly, E -3, E -4, E -5, TJL- 6, E0-9, GM-CSF, M-CSF, and G-CSF, produced by activated T H and activated macrophages, stimulate myeloid stem ceUs, which then differentiate into pluripotent stem ceUs, granulocyte-monocyte progenitors, eosinophU progenitors, basopbil progenitors, megakaryocytes, and erythroid progenitors. Differentiation is modulated by growth factors such as GM-CSF, IL-3, TL-6, IL-11, and EPO.
  • Pluripotent stem ceUs then differentiate into lymphoid stem ceUs, bone marrow stromal ceUs, T ceU progenitors, B ceU progenitors, thymocytes, T H CeUs, T c ceUs, and B ceUs.
  • This differentiation is modulated by growth factors such as E -3, IL-4, IL-6, E -7, GM-CSF, M-CSF, G-CSF, IL-2, and IL-5.
  • Granulocyte-monocyte progenitors differentiate to monocytes, macrophages, and neutrophils. Such differentiation is modulated by the growth factors GM-CSF, M- CSF, and E -8. Eosinophil progenitors differentiate into eosinophUs. This process is modulated by GM-CSF and IL-5.
  • basopbil progenitors into mast ceUs and basophUs is modulated by GM-CSF, IL-4, and IL-9.
  • Megakaryocytes produce platelets in response to GM-CSF, EPO, and IL-6.
  • Erythroid progenitor ceUs differentiate into red blood ceUs in response to EPO.
  • T ceUs can also be contacted with a mitogen, for example a cytokine such as IL-2.
  • a mitogen for example a cytokine such as IL-2.
  • the IL-2 is added to the population of T ceUs at a concentration of about 50 to 100 ⁇ g/ml.
  • Activation with the CD3-binding agent can be carried out for 2 to 4 days.
  • the T ceUs are geneticaUy modified by contacting the same with a suitable gene transfer vector under conditions that aUow for transfection of the vectors into the T ceUs. Genetic modification is carried out when the ceU density of the T ceU population is between about 0.1 x 10 6 and 5 x 10 6 , preferably between about 0.5 x 10 6 and 2 x 10 6 .
  • a suitable gene transfer vector for use herein.
  • transduced ceUs are selected away from non-transduced ceUs using known techniques. For example, if the gene transfer vector used in the transduction includes a selectable marker which confers resistance to a cytotoxic agent, the ceUs can be contacted with the appropriate cytotoxic agent, whereby non- transduced ceUs can be negatively selected away from the transduced ceUs. If the selectable marker is a ceU surface marker, the ceUs can be contacted with a binding agent specific for the particular ceU surface marker, whereby the transduced ceUs can be positively selected away from the population.
  • the selectable marker is a ceU surface marker
  • the selection step can also entaU fluorescence-activated ceU sorting (FACS) techniques, such as where FACS is used to select ceUs from the population containing a particular surface marker, or the selection step can entaU the use of magneticaUy responsive particles as retrievable supports for target ceU capture and/or background removal.
  • FACS fluorescence-activated ceU sorting
  • positive selection of the transduced ceUs can be performed using a FACS ceU sorter (e.g. a FACSNantageTM CeU Sorter, Becton Dickinson Immunocytometry Systems, San Jose, CA) to sort and coUect transduced ceUs expressing a selectable ceU surface marker.
  • a FACS ceU sorter e.g. a FACSNantageTM CeU Sorter, Becton Dickinson Immunocytometry Systems, San Jose, CA
  • the ceUs are stained with fluorescent-labeled antibody molecules directed against the particular ceU surface marker.
  • the amount of bound antibody on each ceU can be measured by passing droplets containing the ceUs through the ceU sorter.
  • the transduced ceUs can be separated from other ceUs.
  • ceUs are then harvested in sterUe coUection vessels. These ceU sorting procedures are described in detaU, for example, in the FACSVantageTM Training Manual, with particular reference to sections 3-11 to 3-28 and 10-1 to 10-17. Positive selection ofthe transduced ceUs can also be performed using magnetic separation of ceUs based on expression or a particular ceU surface marker. In such separation techniques, ceUs to be positively selected are first contacted with specific binding agent (e.g., an antibody or reagent the interacts specificaUy with the ceU surface marker).
  • specific binding agent e.g., an antibody or reagent the interacts specificaUy with the ceU surface marker.
  • ceUs are then contacted with retrievable particles (e.g., magneticaUy responsive particles) which are coupled with a reagent that binds the specific binding agent (that has bound to the positive ceUs).
  • the ceU-binding agent- particle complex can then be physicaUy separated from non-labeled ceUs, for example using a magnetic field.
  • magneticaUy responsive particles the labeled ceUs can be retained in a container using a magnetic filed while the negative ceUs are removed.
  • the invention includes a kit for genetic modification of an ex vivo population of primary mammahan ceUs.
  • the kit typicaUy contains a gene transfer vector coding for at least one selectable marker and at least one synthetic expression cassette contained in one or more containers, anciUary reagents or hardware, and instructions for use of the kit.
  • any of the polynucleotides e.g., expression cassettes
  • polypeptides described herein dehvered by any of the methods described above
  • Non- limiting examples include co-administration of these molecules, for example, in prime- boost methods where one or more molecules are dehvered in a "priming" step and, subsequently, one or more molecules are dehvered in a "boosting" step.
  • the dehvery of one or more nucleic acid-containing compositions and is foUowed by dehvery of one or more nucleic acid-containing compositions and/or one or more polypeptide-containing compositions e.g., polypeptides comprising HIV antigens.
  • multiple nucleic acid "primes" can be foUowed by multiple polypeptide "boosts” (of the same or different polypeptides).
  • Other examples include multiple nucleic acid administrations and multiple polypeptide administrations.
  • the various compositions can be dehvered in any order.
  • the nucleic acids need not be aU dehvered before the polypeptides.
  • the priming step may include dehvery of one or more polypeptides and the boosting comprises dehvery of one or more nucleic acids and/or one more polypeptides.
  • Multiple polypeptide administrations can be foUowed by multiple nucleic acid administrations or polypeptide and nucleic acid administrations can be performed in any order.
  • the nucleic acid molecules can encode aU, some or none of the polypeptides.
  • nucleic acid molecules e.g., expression cassettes
  • polypeptides described herein can be co-administered in any order and via any administration routes. Therefore, any combination of polynucleotides and/or polypeptides described herein can be used to generate elicit an immune reaction.
  • codon modified Gag and Pol expression cassettes were designed, either for Gag alone or Gag plus Pol. To evaluate possible differences in expression and potency, the expression of these constructs was analyzed and immunogenicity studies carried out in mice.
  • Gag and Pol were designed, including, but not limited to, the foUowing: GagProtease, GagPol ⁇ integrase with frameshift (gagFSpol), and GagPol ⁇ integrase in-frame (gagpol). Versions of GagPol ⁇ integrase in-frame were also designed with attenuated (Att) or non-functional Protease (Ina).
  • nucleic acid sequences were codon modified to correspond to the codon usage of highly expressed human genes. Mice were immunized with titrated DNA doses and humoral and ceUular immune responses evaluated by ELISA and intraceUular cytokine staining (Example 10).
  • mice The immune responses in mice has been seen to be correlated with relative levels of expression in vitro.
  • Vaccine studies in rhesus monkeys wUl further address immune responses and expression levels in vivo.
  • V2-deleted envelope D ⁇ A and protein vaccines were chosen for advancement toward clinical evaluation.
  • SimUar approaches for immunization may be employed using, for example, nucleic acid immunization employing the synthetic HIV polynucleotides of the present invention coupled with corresponding or heterologous HIV-derived polypeptide boosts.
  • Antigens are selected for the vaccine composition(s).
  • Env polypeptides are typicaUy employed in a first antigemc composition used to induce an immune response.
  • Gag polypeptides are typicaUy employed in a second antigenic composition used to induce an immune response.
  • the second antigenic composition may include further HIV-derived polypeptide sequences, including, but not limited to, Pol, Tat, Rev, ⁇ ef, Vif, Vpr, and/or Vpu sequences.
  • a D ⁇ A prime vaccination is typicaUy performed with the first and second antigenic compositions.
  • the prime is typicaUy foUowed by at least one boost.
  • the boost may, for example, include adjuvanted HIV-derived polypeptides (e.g., corresponding to those used for the D ⁇ A vaccinations), coding sequences for HIV-derived polypeptides (e.g., corresponding to those used for the D ⁇ A vaccinations) encoded by a viral vector, further D ⁇ A vaccinations, and/or combinations of the foregoing.
  • a D ⁇ A prime is administered with a first antigenic composition (e.g., a D ⁇ A construct encoding an Envelope polypeptide) and second antigenic composition (e.g., a D ⁇ A construct encoding a Gag polypeptide, a Pol polypeptide, a Tat polypeptide, a ⁇ ef polypeptide, and a Rev polypeptide).
  • the D ⁇ A construct for use in the prime may, for example, comprise a CMV promoter operably linked to the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide sequence.
  • the DNA prime is foUowed by a boost, for example, an adjuvanted Envelope polypeptide boost and a viral vector boost (where the viral vector encodes, e.g., a Gag polypeptide, a Pol polypeptide, a Tat polypeptide, a Nef polypeptide, and a Rev polypeptide).
  • the boost may be an adjuvanted Gag polypeptide, Pol polypeptide, Tat polypeptide, Nef polypeptide, and Rev polypeptide boost and a viral vector boost (where the viral vector encodes, e.g., an Envelope polypeptide).
  • the boost may include aU polypeptide antigens which were encoded in the DNA prime; however, this is not required. Further, different polypeptide antigens may be used in the boost relative to the initial vaccination and visa versa. Further, the initial vaccination may be a viral vector rather than a DNA construct.
  • HIV envelope vaccine design Some factors that may be considered in HIV envelope vaccine design are as foUows. Envelope-based vaccines have demonstrated protection against infection in non-human primate models. Passive antibody studies have demonstrated protection against HIV infection in the presence of neutralizing antibodies against the virus chaUenge stock. Vaccines that exclude Env generaUy confer less protective efficacy. Experiments performed in support of the present invention have demonstrated that monomeric gpl20 protein-derived from the SF2 lab strain provided neutralization of HIV-1 lab strains and protection against virus chaUenges in primate models. Primary gpl20 protein derived from Thai E field strains provided cross-subtype neutralization of lab strains.
  • Primary sub-type B ohgomeric o-gpl40 protein provided partial neutralization of subtype B primary (field) isolates.
  • Primary sub-type B o-gpl40 ⁇ V2 DNA prime plus protein boost provided potent neutralization of diverse subtype B primary isolates and protection against virus chaUenge in primate models.
  • Primary sub-type C o-gpl40 and o-gpl40 ⁇ N2 likely provide similar results to those just described for sub-type B.
  • Vaccine strategies for induction of potent, broadly reactive, neutralizing antibodies may be assisted by construction of Envelope polypeptide structures that expose conserved neutralizing epitopes, for example, variable-region deletions and de- glycosylations, envelope protein-receptor complexes, rational design based on crystal structure (e.g., ⁇ -sheet deletions), and gp41-fusion domain based immunogens.
  • conserved neutralizing epitopes for example, variable-region deletions and de- glycosylations, envelope protein-receptor complexes, rational design based on crystal structure (e.g., ⁇ -sheet deletions), and gp41-fusion domain based immunogens.
  • Stable CHO ceU lines for envelope protein production have been developed using optimized envelope polypeptide coding sequences, including, but not limited to, the foUowing: gpl20, o-gpl40, gpl20 ⁇ V2, o-gpl40 ⁇ V2, gpl20 ⁇ VlV2, o- gpl40 ⁇ VlV2.
  • prime-boost regimes appear to be beneficial to help reduce viral load in infected subjects, as weU as possibly slow or prevent progression of HIV-related disease (relative to untreated subjects).
  • the polynucleotide sequences of the present invention were manipulated to maximize expression of their gene products.
  • the order of the foUowing steps may vary.
  • the HIV-1 codon usage pattern was modified so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence was comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes.
  • the HIV codon usage reflects a high content ofthe nucleotides A or T of the codon-triplet.
  • the effect of the HIV-1 codon usage is a high AT content in the DNA sequence that results in a high AU content in the RNA and in a decreased translation abihty and instability of the mRNA.
  • highly expressed human codons prefer the nucleotides G or C.
  • the wUd-type sequences were modified to be comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes.
  • the fuU length coding region of the Gag- polymerase sequence is included with the synthetic Gag sequences in order to increase the number of epitopes for virus-like particles expressed by the synthetic, optimized Gag expression cassette.
  • synthetic HIV-1 Gag-polymerase expresses the potentiaUy deleterious functional enzymes reverse transcriptase (RT) and integrase (INT) (in addition to the structural proteins and protease), it is important to inactivate RT and INT functions.
  • RT reverse transcriptase
  • INT integrase
  • selected B- and/or T-ceU epitopes can be added to the Gag- polymerase constmcts within the deletions of the RT- and E T-coding sequence to replace and augment any epitopes deleted by the functional modifications of RT and INT.
  • selected B- and T-ceU epitopes (including CTL epitopes) from RT and INT can be included in a minimal VLP formed by expression of the synthetic Gag or synthetic GagProt cassette, described above.
  • the present invention comprises Env coding sequences that include, but are not limited to, polynucleotide sequences encoding the foUowing HIV- encoded polypeptides: gpl60, gpl40, and gpl20 (see, e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,792,459 for a description of the HIV-1 SF2 ("SF2”) Env polypeptide).
  • Env coding sequences that include, but are not limited to, polynucleotide sequences encoding the foUowing HIV- encoded polypeptides: gpl60, gpl40, and gpl20 (see, e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,792,459 for a description of the HIV-1 SF2 ("SF2”) Env polypeptide).
  • polypeptides are indicated as lines, the amino and carboxy termini are indicated on the gpl60 line; the open circle represents the oligomerization domain; the open square represents a transmembrane spanning domain (TM); and "c" represents the location of a cleavage site, in gpl40.mut the "X” indicates that the cleavage site has been mutated such that it no longer functions as a cleavage site).
  • the polypeptide g ⁇ l60 includes the coding sequences for gpl20 and gp41.
  • the polypeptide gp41 is comprised of several domains including an oligomerization domain (OD) and a transmembrane spanning domain (TM).
  • OD oligomerization domain
  • TM transmembrane spanning domain
  • the oligomerization domain is required for the non- covalent association of three gp41 polypeptides to form a trimeric structure: through non-covalent interactions with the gp41 trimer (and itself), the gpl20 polypeptides are also organized in a trimeric structure.
  • a cleavage site exists approximately between the polypeptide sequences for gpl20 and the polypeptide sequences corresponding to g ⁇ 41. This cleavage site(s) can be mutated to prevent cleavage at the site.
  • the resulting gpl40 polypeptide corresponds to a truncated form of gpl60 where the transmembrane spanning domain of gp41 has been deleted.
  • This gpl40 polypeptide can exist in both monomeric and ohgomeric (i.e. trimeric) forms by virtue of the presence of the oligomerization domain in the gp41 moiety.
  • the resulting polypeptide product is designated "mutated" g ⁇ l40 (e.g., gpl40.mut).
  • the cleavage site can be mutated in a variety of ways. (See, also, WO 00/39302).
  • WUd-type HIV coding sequences (e.g., Gag, Env, Pol, tat, rev, nef, vpr, vpu, vif, etc.) can be selected from any known HIV isolate and these sequences manipulated to maximize expression of their gene products foUowing the teachings of the present invention.
  • the wUd-type coding region maybe modified in one or more of the foUowing ways.
  • sequences encoding hypervariable regions of Env, particularly VI and/or V2 were deleted.
  • mutations were introduced into sequences, for example, encoding the cleavage site in Env to abrogate the enzymatic cleavage of ohgomeric gpl40 into gpl20 monomers.
  • encoding the cleavage site in Env to abrogate the enzymatic cleavage of ohgomeric gpl40 into gpl20 monomers.
  • hypervariable region(s) were deleted, N-glycosylation sites were removed and/or cleavage sites mutated.
  • different mutations may be introduced into the coding sequences of different genes (see, e.g., Table B).
  • Tat coding sequences were modified according to the teachings of the present specification, for example to affect the transactivation domain of the gene product (e.g., replacing a cystein residue at position 22 with a glycine, Caputo et al. (1996) Gene Therapy 3:235).
  • the gene cassettes are designed to comprise the entire coding sequence of interest.
  • Synthetic gene cassettes are constracted by ohgonucleotide synthesis and PCR amplification to generate gene fragments. Primers are chosen to provide convenient restriction sites for subcloning. The resulting fragments are then hgated to create the entire desired sequence which is then cloned into an appropriate vector.
  • the final synthetic sequences are (i) screened by restriction endonuclease digestion and analysis,(ii) subjected to DNA sequencing in order to confirm that the desired sequence has been obtained and (hi) the identity and integrity of the expressed protein confirmed by SDS- PAGE and Western blotting.
  • the synthetic coding sequences are assembled at Chiron Corp. (EmeryviUe, CA) or by the Midland Certified Reagent Company (Midland, Texas).
  • constmcts may be combined.
  • Exemplary embodiments ofthe synthetic polynucleotides of the present invention include, but are not limited to, the sequences presented in Table C.
  • .mut or .mut7 or .mut 8 envelope mutated in ceUular protease cleavage site between gpl20/gp41 (i.e., to prevent cleavage; e.g., better for purifying protein) ⁇
  • the synthetic DNA fragments of the present invention are cloned into the foUowing expression vectors: pCMVKm2, for transient expression assays and DNA immunization studies, the pCMNKm2 vector was derived from pCMN6a (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res.
  • the pCMVK ⁇ vector differs from the pCMV-link vector only in that a polylinker site was inserted into pCMNK ⁇ to generate pCMN-link; pES ⁇ 2dhfr and pCMNPLEdhfr (also known as pCMNIII), for expression in Chinese Hamster Ovary (CHO) ceUs; and, pAcC13, a shuttle vector for use in the Baculovirus expression system ( ⁇ AcC13, was derived from pAcC12 which was described by Munemitsu S., et al., Mol Cell Biol.
  • the EMCV IRES (internal ribosome entry site) leader was PCR-amplified from pCite-4a+ ( ⁇ ovagen, Inc., MUwaukee, WI) and inserted into pET-23d ( ⁇ ovagen, Inc., MUwaukee, WI) as an Xba-Nco fragment to give pET- EMCV.
  • the dhfr gene was PCR-amplified from pES ⁇ 2dhfr to give a product with a Gly-Gly-Gly-Ser spacer in place of the translation stop codon and inserted as an Nco- BamHl fragment to give pET-E-DHFR.
  • the attenuated neo gene was PCR amplified from a pS V2Neo (Clontech, Palo Alto, CA) derivative and inserted into the unique R Hl site of pET-E-DHFR to give pET-E-DHFR/Neo (m2) .
  • the bovine growth hormone terminator from pCDNA3 (Invitrogen, Inc., Carlsbad, CA) was inserted downstream ofthe neo gene to give pET-E-DHFR/Neo (m2) BGHt.
  • the EMCV-dhfr/neo selectable marker cassette fragment was prepared by cleavage of pET-E-DHFR/Neo (ra2) BGHt.
  • the CMV enhancer/promoter plus Intron A was transferred frompCMV ⁇ a (Chapman et al, Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986) as a Hind ⁇ T-Sall fragment into pUC19 (New England Biolabs, Inc., Beverly, MA).
  • the vector backbone of pUC19 was deleted from the Ndel to the Sapl sites.
  • the above described DHFR cassette was added to the construct such that the EMCV IRES foUowed the CMV promoter to produce the final construct.
  • the vector also contained an amp r gene and an S V40 origin of rephcation.
  • Expression vectors of the present invention contain one or more of the synthetic coding sequences disclosed herein, e.g., shown in the Figures.
  • the coding sequences may aU be in-frame to generate one polyprotein; alternately, the more than one polypeptide coding sequences may comprise a polycistronic message where, for example, an IRES is placed 5' to each polypeptide coding sequence.
  • Example 2 Expression Assays for the Synthetic Coding Sequences
  • the wUd-type sequences are cloned into expression vectors having the same features as the vectors into which the synthetic HIV-derived sequences were cloned.
  • Expression efficiencies for various vectors carrying the wUd-type (any known isolated) and corresponding synthetic sequence(s) are evaluated as foUows.
  • CeUs from several mammahan ceU lines (293, RD, COS-7, and CHO; aU obtained from the American Type Culture CoUection, 10801 University Boulevard, Manassas, VA 20110-2209) are transfected with 2 ⁇ g of DNA in transfection reagent LTl (PanVera Corporation, 545 Science Dr., Madison, WI).
  • ceUs are incubated for 5 hours in reduced serum medium (Opti-MEM, Gibco-BRL, Gaithersburg, MD).
  • the medium is then replaced with normal medium as foUows: 293 ceUs, IMDM, 10% fetal calf semm, 2% glutamine (BioWhittaker, WalkersvUle, MD); RD and COS-7 ceUs, D-MEM, 10% fetal calf seram, 2% glutamine (Opti-MEM, Gibco-BRL, Gaithersburg, MD); and
  • CHO ceUs Ham's F-12, 10% fetal calf serum, 2% glutamine (Opti-MEM, Gibco-BRL, Gaithersburg, MD). The ceUs are incubated for either 48 or 60 hours. Supematants are harvested and filtered through 0.45 ⁇ m syringe filters and, optionaUy, stored at - 20°C. Supematants are evaluated using the Coulter p24-assay (Coulter Corporation,
  • a suitable monoclonal antibody directed against an HIV antigen e.g, a murine monoclonal directed again an HIV core antigen.
  • the appropriate HIV antigen binds to the coated weUs and biotinylated antibodies against HIV recognize the bound antigen.
  • Conjugated strepavidin- horseradish peroxidase reacts with the biotin. Color develops from the reaction of peroxidase with TMB substrate. The reaction is terminated by addition of 4N H 2 SO 4 . The intensity of the color is directly proportional to the amount of HIV antigen in a sample.
  • CispII Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) ceUs are also transfected with plasmid DNA encoding the synthetic HIV polypeptides described herein (e.g., pESN2dhfr or pCMVi ⁇ vector backbone) using Mi us TransIT-LTl polyamine transfection reagent (Pan Vera) according to the manufacturers instructions and incubated for 96 hours. After 96 hours, media is changed to selective media (F12 special with 250 ⁇ g/ml G418) and ceUs are split 1:5 and incubated for an additional 48 hours. Media is changed every 5-7 days until colonies start forming at which time the colonies are picked, plated into 96 weU plates and screened by Capture ELISA.
  • plasmid DNA encoding the synthetic HIV polypeptides described herein (e.g., pESN2dhfr or pCMVi ⁇ vector backbone) using Mi us TransIT-LTl polyamine transfection reagent (Pan Vera) according
  • Positive clones are expanded in 24 weU plates and are screened several times for HIV protein production by Capture ELISA, as described above. After reaching confluency in 24 weU plates, positive clones are expanded to T25 flasks (Corning, Corning, NY). These are screened several times after confluency and positive clones are expanded to T75 flasks. Positive T75 clones are frozen in LN2 and the highest expressing clones are amplified with 0-5 ⁇ M methotrexate (MTX)at several concentrations and plated in 100mm culture dishes. Plates are screened for colony formation and aU positive closed are again expanded as described above. Clones are expanded an amplified and screened at each step capture ELISA. Positive clones are frozen at each methotrexate level. Highest producing clones are grown in perfusion bioreactors (3L, 100L) for expansion and adaptation to low serum suspension culture conditions for scale-up to larger bioreactors.
  • Example 3 Western Blot Analysis of Expression Western blot analysis of ceUs transfected with the HIV expression cassettes described herein are performed essentiaUy as described in co-owned WO 00/39302. Briefly, human 293 ceUs are transfected as described in Example 2 with pCMV6a- based vectors containing native or synthetic HIV expression cassettes. CeUs are cultivated for 60 hours post-transfection. Supematants are prepared as described. CeU lysates are prepared as foUows. The ceUs are washed once with phosphate- buffered saline, lysed with detergent [1% NP40 (Sigma Chemical Co., St.
  • the plasmid D ⁇ A e.g., pCMNKM2 carrying an expression cassette comprising a synthetic sequence of the present invention
  • the plasmid D ⁇ A is dUuted to the foUowing final concentrations in a total injection volume of 100 ⁇ l: 20 ⁇ g, 2 ⁇ g, 0.2 ⁇ g, and 0.02 ⁇ g.
  • the total D ⁇ A concentration in each sample is brought up to 20 ⁇ g using the vector (pCMVKM2) alone.
  • plasmid D ⁇ A comprising an expression cassette encoding the native, corresponding polypeptide is handled in the same manner. Twelve groups of four Balb/c mice (Charles River, Boston, MA) are intramuscularly immunized (50 ⁇ l per leg, intramuscular injection into the t ⁇ bialis anterior) using varying dosages.
  • the humoral immune response is checked with a suitable anti-HIN antibody ELIS As (enzyme-linked immunosorbent assays) of the mice sera 0 and 4 weeks post immunization (groups 5-12) and, in addition, 6 and 8 weeks post immunization, respectively, 2 and 4 weeks post second immunization (groups 1-4).
  • ELIS As enzyme-linked immunosorbent assays
  • the antibody titers of the sera are determined by anti-HIV antibody ELISA. Briefly, sera from immunized mice were screened for antibodies directed against an appropriate HIV protein (e.g., HIV p55 for Gag). ELISA microtiter plates are coated with 0.2 ⁇ g of HIV protein per weU overnight and washed four times; subsequently, blocking is done with PBS-0.2% Tween (Sigma) for 2 hours. After removal of the blocking solution, 100 ⁇ l of dUuted mouse semm is added. Sera are tested at 1/25 dUutions and by serial 3-fold dUutions, thereafter.
  • an appropriate HIV protein e.g., HIV p55 for Gag
  • ELISA microtiter plates are coated with 0.2 ⁇ g of HIV protein per weU overnight and washed four times; subsequently, blocking is done with PBS-0.2% Tween (Sigma) for 2 hours. After removal of the blocking solution, 100 ⁇ l of dUuted mouse semm is added.
  • Microtiter plates are washed four times and incubated with a secondary, peroxidase-coupled anti-mouse IgG antibody (Pierce, Rockford, IL).
  • ELISA plates are washed and 100 ⁇ l of 3, 3', 5, 5'-tetramethyl benzidine (TMB; Pierce) was added per weU.
  • TMB 3, 3', 5, 5'-tetramethyl benzidine
  • the optical density of each weU is measured after 15 minutes.
  • the titers reported are the reciprocal of the dUution of serum that gave a half-maximum optical density (O.D.).
  • mice immunizations with plasmid-D ⁇ As are used to show that the synthetic expression cassettes provide improvement of immunogenicity relative to the native expression cassettes. Also, the second boost immunization induces a secondary immune response after two weeks (groups 1-3).
  • CTL cytotoxic T-lymphocytes
  • HIV protein-expressing vaccinia virus infected CD-8 ceUs are used as a positive control (vv- protein).
  • spleen ceUs effector ceUs, E
  • the ceUs are cultured, restimulated, and assayed for CTL activity against, e.g., Gag peptide-pulsed target ceUs as described (Doe, B., and Walker, CM., AIDS 10(7):793-794, 1996).
  • Cytotoxic activity is measured in a standard 51 Cr release assay.
  • Target (T) ceUs are cultured with effector (E) ceUs at various E:T ratios for 4 hours and the average cpm from duphcate weUs is used to calculate percent specific 51 Cr release.
  • Cytotoxic T-ceU activity is measured in splenocytes recovered from the mice immunized with HIV DNA constructs described herein. Effector ceUs firom the DNA-immunized animals exhibit specific lysis of HIV peptide-pulsed S V-B ALB (MHC matched) targets ceUs indicative of a CTL response. Target ceUs that are peptide-pulsed and derived from an MHC-unmatched mouse strain (MC57) are not lysed. The results of the CTL assays are used to show increased potency of synthetic HIV expression cassettes for induction of cytotoxic T-lymphocyte (CTL) responses by DNA immunization.
  • CTL Cytotoxic T-ceU
  • Example 5 In Vivo Immunogenicity of Synthetic HIV Expression Cassettes A;.
  • General Immunization Methods To evaluate the immunogenicity of the synthetic HIV expression cassettes, studies using guinea pigs, rabbits, mice, rhesus macaques and baboons are performed. The studies are typicaUy structured as foUows: DNA immunization alone (single or multiple); DNA immunization foUowed by protein immunization (boost); DNA immunization foUowed by Sindbis particle immunization; immunization by Sindbis particles alone.
  • Experiments may be performed using guinea pigs as foUows.
  • Groups comprising six guinea pigs each are immunized intramuscularly or mucosaUy at 0, 4, and 12 weeks with plasmid DNAs encoding expression cassettes comprising one or more the sequences described herein.
  • the animals are subsequently boosted at approximately 18 weeks with a single dose (intramuscular, intradermaUy or mucosaUy) of the HIV protein encoded by the sequence(s) of the plasmid boost and/or other HIV proteins.
  • Antibody titers are measured at two weeks foUowing the third DNA immunization and at two weeks after the protein boost.
  • Rabbits Experiments may be performed using rabbits as foUows. Rabbits are immunized intramuscularly, mucosaUy, or intradermaUy (using a Bioject needless syringe) with plasmid DNAs encoding the HIV proteins described herein. The nucleic acid immunizations are foUowed by protein boosting after the initial immunization.
  • TypicaUy constructs comprising the synthetic HlV-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotides of the present invention are highly immunogenic and generate substantial antigen binding antibody responses after only 2 immunizations in rabbits.
  • the humoral immune response is checked in seram specimens from the immunized animals with an anti-HIV antibody ELISAs (enzyme-linked immunosorbent assays) at various times post-immunization.
  • the antibody titers of the sera are determined by anti-HIV antibody ELISA as described above. Briefly, sera from immunized animals are screened for antibodies directed against the HIV polypeptide/protein(s) encoded by the DNA and/or polypeptide used to immunize the animals. WeUs of ELISA microtiter plates are coated overnight with the selected HZY porypeptide/protein and washed four times; subsequently, blocking is done with PBS-0.2% Tween (Sigma) for 2 hours.
  • A. Baboons Four baboons are immunized 3 times (weeks 0, 4 and 8) bhateraUy, intramuscular into the quadriceps or mucosaUy using the gene dehvery vehicles described herein. The animals are bled two weeks after each immunization and an HTV antibody ELISA is performed with isolated plasma. The ELISA is performed essentiaUy as described above except the second antibody-conjugate is an anti-human IgG, g-chain specific, peroxidase conjugate (Sigma Chemical Co., St. Louis, MD 63178) used at a dilution of 1 :500.
  • yeast extract may be added to the dUutions of plasma samples and antibody conjugate to reduce non-specific background due to preexisting yeast antibodies in the baboons. Lymphoproliferative responses to are observed in baboons two weeks post-fourth immunization (at week 14), and enhanced substantiaUy post-boosting with HIV-polypeptide (at week 44 and 76). Such proliferation results are indicative of induction of T-helper ceU functions.
  • the improved potency of the synthetic, codon-modified H/V-polypeptide encoding polynucleotides of the present invention, when constracted into expression plasmids may be confirmed in rhesus macaques.
  • the macaques have detectable ⁇ IN-specific CTL after two or three 1 mg doses of modified HIV polynucleotide.
  • these results demonstrate that the synthetic ⁇ IV DNA is immunogenic in non-human primates. Neutralizing antibodies may also detected.
  • Example 7 Co-Transfection of Monocistronic and Multicistronic Constructs
  • the present invention includes co-transfection with multiple, monocistronic expression cassettes, as weU as, co-transfection with one or more multi-cistronic expression cassettes, or combinations thereof.
  • Such constmcts in a variety of combinations, may be transfected into 293T ceUs for transient transfection studies.
  • a bicistronic construct may be made where the coding sequences for the different HIV polypeptides are under the control of a single CMV promoter and, between the two coding sequences, an IRES (internal ribosome entry site (EMCV IRES); Kozak, M., Critical Reviews in Biochemistry and Molecular Biology 27(45):385-402, 1992; WithereU, G.W., et al, Virology 214:660-663, 1995) sequence is introduced after the first HIV coding sequence and before the second HIV coding sequence.
  • IRES internal ribosome entry site
  • Supematants coUected from ceU culture are tested for the presence of the HIV proteins and indicate that appropriate proteins are expressed in the transfected ceUs (e.g., if an Env coding sequence was present the corresponding Env protein was detected; if a Gag coding sequence was present the corresponding Gag protein was detected, etc).
  • the production of chimeric VLPs by these ceU hnes may be determined using electron microscopic analysis. (See, e.g., co-owned WO 00/39302).
  • Example 8 Accessory gene components for an HIV-1 vaccine: functional analysis of mutated Tat. Rev and Nef Type C antigens
  • HIV-1 regulatory and accessory genes have received increased attention as components of HIV vaccines due to their role in viral pathogenesis, the high ratio of highly conserved CTL epitopes and their early expression in the viral life cycle. Because of various undesirable properties of these genes, questions regarding their safety and suitabUity as vaccine components have been raised. Experiments performed in support ofthe present invention have analyzed candidate HIV-1 subtype C tat, rev, and nef mutants for efficient expression and inactivation of potential deleterious functions. Other HIV subtype accessory genes may be evaluated simUarly.
  • Sequence-modified, mutant tat, rev, and e genes coding for consensus Tat, Rev and Nef proteins of South African HIV-1 subtype C were constructed using overlapping synthetic ohgonucleotides and PCR-based site-directed mutagenesis. Constructs of the wUd-type genes of the isolates closely resembling the respective consensus sequences were also made by PCR. In vitro expression of the constructs was analyzed by western blotting. The trans-activation activity ofthe Tat mutants and nuclear RNA export activity of the Rev mutants were studied after transfection of various ceU lines using reporter-gene-based functionality assays.
  • TatC22/37 Tat activity assays in three ceU hnes (RD, HeLa and 293). In the background of the subtype C consensus Tat, a single mutation at C22 was insufficient to inactivate LTR-dependent CAT expression. In contrast, this activity was significantly impaired in RD, 293 and HeLa ceUs using the single mutation, C37, or the double mutation, C22C37 (see Table B). Corresponding results were obtained for Tat mutants derived from subtype B strains.
  • ProtRTTatC22RevNef showed reduced Tat activity when compared to TatC22 alone, probably due to structural changes caused by the fusion protein.
  • Nef mutations are described in Table B.
  • FACs analysis is used to look for the presence of MHC 1 and CD4 on ceU surfaces. CeUs are assayed in the presence and absence of Nef expression (for controls), as weU as using the synthetic polynucleotides of the present invention that encode native nef protein and mutated nef protein.
  • Down-regulation of MHC 1 and CD4 expression indicates that the nef gene product is not functional, i.e., if nef is non-functional there is no down regulation.
  • Example 9 Evaluation of immunogenicity of various HIV polypeptide encoding plasmids
  • the immunogenicity of any of the polynucleotides or expression cassettes described herein is readUy evaluated.
  • Table D In the foUowing table (Table D) are exemplified procedures involving a comparison of the hnmunogenicity of subtype B and C envelope plasmids, both individuaUy and as a mixed-subtype vaccine, using electroporation, in rabbits. It wUl be apparent that such methods are equaUy apphcable to any other HIV polypeptide.
  • the MF59C adjuvant is a microfluidized emulsion containing 5% squalene, 0.5% tween 80, 0.5% span 85, in lOmM citrate pH 6, stored in lOmL ahquots at 4°C.
  • Immunogens are prepared as described in the foUowing table (Table E) for administration to animals in the various groups. Concentrations may vary from those described in the table, for example depending on the sequences and/or proteins being used.
  • Subtype B and C plasmids wiU be provided frozen at a concentration of l.Omg/ml in sterUe 0.9% saline. Store at -80°C until use. Thaw DNA at room temperature; the material should be clear or slightly opaque, with no particulate matter. Animals wiU be shaved prior to immunization, under sedation of lx dose IP (by animal weight) of Ketarnine-Xylazine (80mg/ml - 4mg/ml). Immunize each rabbit with 0.5ml DNA mixture per side (EVl/Quadriceps), 1.0ml per animal. FoUow the DNA injection with Electroporation using a 6-needle circular array with 1cm diameter, 1cm needle length. Electroporation pulses were given at 20V/mm, 50ms pulse length, 1 pulse/s.
  • Proteins wiU be provided at 0. lmg/ml in citrate buffer. Store at -80°C untU use. Thaw at room temperature; material should be clear with no particulate matter. Add equal volume of MF59C adjuvant to thawed protein and mix well by inverting the tube. Immunize each rabbit with 0.5ml adjuvanted protein per side, IM/Glut for a total of 1.0ml per animal. Use material within 1 hour of the addition of adjuvant.
  • Immunization 1-3 Combined subtype B and C plasmid DNA in Saline
  • the immunogen wiU be provided at 2.0mg/ml total DNA (lmg/ml of each plasmid) in sterile 0.9% saline. Store at -80°C until use. Thaw DNA at room temperature; the material should be clear or slightly opaque, with no particulate matter. Animals wiU be shaved prior to immunization, under sedation of lx dose IP (by animal weight) of Ketarnine-Xylazine (80mg/ml - 4mg/ml). Immunize each rabbit with 0.5ml DNA mixture per side (IM/Quadriceps), 1.0ml per animal. FoUow the DNA injection with Electroporation using a 6-needle circular array with 1cm diameter, 1cm needle length. Electroporation pulses were given at 20V/mm, 50ms pulse length, 1 pulse/s. Group Preparation
  • Proteins wUl be provided at 0. lmg/ml in citrate buffer. Store at -80°C until use. Thaw at room temperature; material should be clear with no particulate matter. Add equal volume of MF59C adjuvant to thawed protein and mix well by inverting the tube. Immunize each rabbit with 0.5ml adjuvanted protein per side, EVI/Glut for a total of 1.0ml per animal. Use material within 1 hour ofthe addition of adjuvant.
  • Example 10 Mice Immunization Studies with Gag and Pol Constructs CeUular and Humoral immune responses were evaluated in mice (essentiaUy as described in Example 4) for the foUowing constructs: Gag, GagProtease(+FS) (GP1, protease codon optimized and inactivation of INS; GP2, protease only inactivation of INS), GagPol ⁇ integrase with frameshift (gagFSpol), and GagPol ⁇ integrase in-frame (GagPol) (see Figure 63). Versions of GagPol ⁇ integrase in-frame were also designed with attenuated (GagPolAtt) or non-functional Protease (GagPoUna).
  • GagPolAtt attenuated
  • GagPoUna non-functional Protease
  • DNA immunization of mice using Gag vs. GP1 and GP2 in pCMV vectors was performed intramuscularly in the tibiahs anterior. Mice were immunized at the start of the study (0 week) and 4 weeks later. Bleeds were performed at 0, 4, and 6 weeks. DNA doses used were as foUows: 20 ⁇ g, 2 ⁇ g, 0.2 ⁇ g, and 0.02 ⁇ g.
  • DNA immunization of mice using Gag vs. gagFSpol in pCMV vectors was performed intramuscularly in the tibiahs anterior. Mice were immunized at the start of the study (0 week) and chaUenged 4 weeks later with recombinant vaccinia virus encoding Gag (rNVgag). Bleeds were performed at 0 and 4 weeks. D ⁇ A doses used were as foUows: 20 ⁇ g, 2 ⁇ g, 0.2 ⁇ g, and 0.02 ⁇ g.
  • D ⁇ A immunization of mice using Gag vs. gagFSpol and gagpol in pCMN vectors was performed intramuscularly in the tibiahs anterior. Mice were immunized at the start of the study (0 week) and chaUenged 4 weeks later with recombinant vaccinia virus encoding Gag (rNNgag). Bleeds were performed at 0 and 4 weeks. D ⁇ A doses used were as foUows: 2 ⁇ g, 0.2 ⁇ g, 0.02 ⁇ g, and 0.002 ⁇ g.
  • CeUular immune responses against Gag were comparable for aU tested variants, for example, Gag, GagProtease, gagFSpol and GagPoUna aU had comparable potencies.
  • Humoral immune responses to Gag were also comparable with the exception of
  • Humoral immune responses were weaker in constructs comprising functional or attenuated proteases which may be due to less efficient secretion of p55Gag caused by overactive protease.
  • Gene cassettes were designed to express the gpl20 (surface antigen), g l40 (surface antigen plus ectodomain of transmembrane protein, gp41), and fuU-length (gpl20 plus gp41) gpl60 forms of the HIV-1 envelope polyprotein with and without deletions of the variable loop regions, V2 and VI V2.
  • AU of the genes were sequence-modified to enhance expression of the encoded Env glycoproteins in a Rev-independent fashion and they were subsequently cloned into pCMV-based plasmid vectors for DNA vaccine and protein production apphcations as described above.
  • the sequences were codon optimized as described herein. Briefly, aU the modified envelope genes were cloned into the Chiron pCMVlink plasmid vector, preferably into EcoRI/XhoI sites.
  • A. Protein Expression FuU-length (gpl60), truncated g ⁇ l40 (Env ectodomain only) and gpl20 native versions of the TVl Env antigen were produced from the expression cassettes described herein.
  • the gpl40 encoding sequences were transiently transfected into 293T ceUs.
  • the expression levels of the gene products were evaluated by an in-house antigen capture ELISA.
  • the Env protein expressed from the TVl -derived clone 8.2 was found to bind the CD4 receptor protein indicating that this feature of the expressed protein is maintained in a functional conformation.
  • the receptor binding properties/ranctionality of the expressed TVl gpl60 protein result was also confirmed by a ceU-fusion assay.
  • Total expression increased approximately 10-fold for synthetic gpl40 constructs compared with the native gpl40 gene cassettes.
  • Both the modified gpl20 and gpl40 variants secreted high amounts of protein in the supernatant.
  • the V2 and VI V2 deleted forms of gpl40 expressed approximately 2-fold more protein than the intact g ⁇ l40.
  • the transient expression experiment showed that the envelope genes derived from the TVOOl and TV002 virus isolates expressed the desired protein products. Relative neutralization sensitivities of these two viral strains using sera from 18 infected South African individuals (subtypes B and C) were as foUows. At a 1:10 serum dUution, the TV2 strain was neutralized by 18 of 18 sera; at 1:50, 16 of 18; at 1:250, 15/18. In comparison, the TVl isolate was neutralized by 15 of 18 at 1:10; only 6 of 18 at 1:50; and none ofthe specimens at 1:250. In addition, the TVOOl patient serum showed neutralization activity against the TV002 isolate at aU dUutions tested.
  • the DNA immunization used subtype C sequence-modified genes (TVl) — gpl60, gpl60dV2, gpl60dVlV2, gpl40, gpl40dV2 and g pl40dVlV2 - as weU as a subtype B SF162 sequence modified gpl40dV2.
  • DNA immunizations were performed at 0, 4, and 20 weeks by needle injection by the intramuscular route using electroporation to facilitate transfection ofthe muscle ceUs and of resident antigen presenting ceUs.
  • Env protein booster in MF59 adjuvant was given at 20 weeks by intramuscular injection at a separate site.
  • Antibody titers were evaluated by ELISA foUowing each successive immunization. Serum specimens were coUected at 0, 4, 6, 8, 12, 22, and 24 weeks. Serum antibody titers were measured on ELISA. 96-weU plates were coated with a protein in a concentration of lug/ml. Serum samples were diluted seriaUy 3-fold. Goat anti-rabbit peroxidase conjugate (1:20,000) was used for detection. TMB was used as the substrate, and the antibody titers were read at 0.6 OD at 450nm.
  • Neutralizing antibody responses against PBMC-grown R5 HIV-1 strains were monitored in the sera coUected from the immunized rabbits using two different assays in two different laboratories, the 5.25 reporter ceU-line based assay at Chiron and the PBMC-based assay of David Montefiori at Duke University. Results are shown in Figures 66, 67, and 68.
  • the Chiron assay was conducted essentiaUy as foUows.
  • Neutralizing antibody responses against the PBMC-grown subtype C TVOOl and TV002 strains were measured using an in-house reporter ceU line assay that uses the 5.25 ceU line. This ceU has CD4, CCR5, CXCR4 and BONZO receptor/co-receptors on its ceU membrane.
  • the parental CEM ceU line was derived from a 4-year-old Caucasian female with acute lymphoblastic leukemia, which was fused with the human B ceU line 721.174, creating CEMxl74.
  • LTR-GFP was transfected into the ceUs after the CCR5 gene (about 1.1 kb) was cloned into the BamH-I (5') and Sal-I (3') ofthe pBABE puro retroviral vector, and subsequently introduced into the CEMxl74.
  • the green fluorescence protein (GFP) of the cells was detected by flow cytometer (FACScan).
  • % virus Inhibition (virus control- experimental)/( virus control -ceU control) x 100. Any virus inhibition observed in the pre-bleed has been subtracted for each individual animal. Values >50% are considered positive and are highlighted in gray.
  • the "#" indicates that animals had high levels of virus inhibition in pre-bleed serum (>20% virus inhibition) that impacted the magnitude ofthe observed inhibition and in some cases, our ability to score the serum as a positive or negative for the presence of significant neutralizing antibody activity ( ⁇ 50% inhibition).
  • serum samples were coUected after a single protein boost (post-third) were screened in triphcate at a 1:8 dUution with virus (1:24 after addition of ceUs). Values shown are the % reduction in p24 synthesis relative to that in the corresponding pre-bleed control samples. Zero values indicate no or negative values were measured. NV, not vahd due to virus inhibition in pre- immune serum. Neutralization was considered positive when p24 was reduced by at least 80%; these samples are highlighted in dark gray. Sample with lighter gray shading showed at least a 50% reduction in ⁇ 24 synthesis.
  • Figure 64 shows the ELISA data when plates were coated with the monomeric gpl20.TVl protein. This protein is homologous to the subtype C genes used for the immunization.
  • AU immunization groups produced high antibody titers after the second DNA immunization.
  • the groups immunized with gpl40 forms of DNA have relatively higher geometric mean antibody titers as compared to the groups using gpl60 forms after both first and second DNA immunizations.
  • Both the gpl40.TVl and gpl40dVl V2.TV1 genes produced high antibody titers at about 10 4 at two weeks post second DNA; the gpl40dV2.TVl plasmid yielded the highest titers of antibodies (>10 4 ) at this time point and aU others..
  • the binding antibody titers to the gpl20.TVl protein were higher for the group immunized with the homologous gpl40dV2.TVl genes than that with the heterologous gpl40dV2.SF162 gene which showed titers of about 10 3 . AU the groups, showed some decline in antibody titers by 8 weeks post the second DNA immunization.
  • Binding antibody titers were also measured using ELISA plates coated with either ohgomeric subtype C o-gpl40dN2.TNl or subtype B o-gpl40dN2.SF162 proteins ( Figure 65).
  • the antibody titers measured using the ohgomeric protein, o-gpl40dV2.TVl were higher than those measured using the monomeric (non-V2-deleted) protein, gpl20.TNl.
  • the titers observed with the heterologous subtype B o-gpl40dN2.SF162 . _ _ _ ⁇
  • the subtype C TNI -derived Env D ⁇ A and protein antigens are immunogenic inducing high titers of antibodies in immunized rabbits and substantial evidence of neutralizing antibodies against both subtype B and subtype C R5 virus strains.
  • the gpl40dN2.TNl antigens have induced consistent neutralizing responses against the subtype B SF162EnvDV2 and subtype C TV2 strains.
  • TVl-based Env D ⁇ A and protein-based antigens are immunogenic and induce high titer antibody responses reactive with both subtype C and subtype B HIV- 1 Env antigens.
  • Example 12 Immunological Responses in Rhesus Macaques CeUular and humoral immune responses were evaluated in three groups of rhesus macaques (each group was made up of four animals) in an immunization study structured as shown in Table I.
  • the route of administration for the immunizing composition was electroporation in each case.
  • Antibody titers are shown in Table I for two weeks post-second immunization. Table I
  • Pre-immune sera were obtained at week 0 before the first immunization.
  • the first immunization was given at week 0.
  • the second immunization was given at week 4.
  • the first bleed was performed at 2 weeks post-second immunization (i.e., at week 6).
  • a third immunization wiU be given at week 8 and a fourth at week 16.
  • Aiiimals 2A, 3 A, 3B and 3D had been vaccinated previously (approximately 4 years or more) with gag plasmid D ⁇ A or gag VLP (subtype B).
  • Gag-specific IF ⁇ + CD8 + T-cells, Gag-specific IF ⁇ + CD4 + T-ceUs, Pol- specific IF ⁇ + CD8 + T-ceUs, and Pol-specific IF ⁇ + CD4 + T-ceUs in blood were determined for each animal described in Table I above, post second immunization. The results are presented in Tables J and K. It is possible that some of the pol-specific activity shown in Table K was directed against p2p7gag.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Virology (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Microbiology (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Mycology (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Biotechnology (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Communicable Diseases (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Plant Pathology (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Tropical Medicine & Parasitology (AREA)
  • AIDS & HIV (AREA)
  • Oncology (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
  • Peptides Or Proteins (AREA)

Abstract

The present invention relates to polynucleotides encoding immunogenic HIV polypeptides. Uses of the polynucleotides in applications including immunization, generation of packaging cell lines, and production of HIV polypeptides are also described. Polynucleotides encoding antigenic HIV polypeptides are described, as are uses of these polynucleotides and polypeptide products therefrom, including formulations of immunogenic compositions and uses thereof.

Description

POLYNUCLEOTIDES ENCODING ANTIGENIC HIV TYPE B POLYPEPTIDES, POLYPEPTIDES AND USES THEREOF
TECHNICAL FIELD Polynucleotides encoding antigenic HIV polypeptides (e.g., those shown in
Table C) are described, as are uses of these polynucleotides and polypeptide products including formulations of immunogenic compositions and uses thereof.
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION Acquired immune deficiency syndrome (ADDS) is recognized as one of the greatest health threats facing modern medicine. There is, as yet, no cure for this disease.
In 1983-1984, three groups independently identified the suspected etiological agent of AIDS. See, e.g., Barre-Sinoussi et al. (1983) Science 220:868-871; Montagnier et al., in Human T-Cell Leukemia Niruses (Gallo, Essex & Gross, eds., 1984); Nilmer et al. (1984) The Lancet 1:753; Popovic et al. (1984) Science 224:497-500; Levy et al. (1984) Science 225:840-842. These isolates were variously called lymphadenopathy-associated virus (LAN), human T-cell lymphotropic virus type III (HTLN-III), or AIDS-associated retrovirus (ARN). All of these isolates are strains of the same virus, and were later collectively named Human Immunodeficiency Nirus (HIN). With the isolation of a related AIDS-causing virus, the strains originally called HIN are now termed HIV-1 and the related virus is called HIN-2 See, e.g., Guyader et al. (1987) Nature 326:662-669; Brun-Vezinet et al. (1986) Science 233:343-346; Clavel et al. (1986) Nature 324:691-695. A great deal of information has been gathered about the HIN virus, however, to date an effective vaccine has not been identified. Several targets for vaccine development have been examined including the env and Gag gene products encoded by HIN. Gag gene products include, but are not limited to, Gag-polymerase and Gag- protease. Env gene products include, but are not limited to, monomeric gpl20 polypeptides, oligomeric gpl40 polypeptides and gpl60 polypeptides. Haas, et al., (Current Biology 6(3):315-324, 1996) suggested that selective codon usage by HIN-1 appeared to account for a substantial fraction of the inefficiency of viral protein synthesis. Andre, et al., (J. Virol. 72(2): 1497-1503, 1998) described an increased immune response elicited by DΝA vaccination employing a synthetic gpl20 sequence with modified codon usage. Schneider, et al., (J Virol. 71(7):4892- 4903, 1997) discuss inactivation of inhibitory (or instability) elements (INS) located within the coding sequences of the Gag and Gag-protease coding sequences.
The Gag proteins of HIN-1 are necessary for the assembly of virus-like particles. HIN-1 Gag proteins are involved in many stages of the life cycle of the virus including, assembly, virion maturation after particle release, and early post-entry steps in virus replication. The roles of HIN-1 Gag proteins are numerous and complex (Freed, E.O., Virology 251:1-15, 1998).
Wolf, et al., (PCT International Application, WO 96/30523, published 3 October 1996; European Patent Application, Publication No. 0 449 116 Al, published 2 October 1991) have described the use of altered pr55 Gag of HIN-1 to act as a non- infectious retro viral-like particulate carrier, in particular, for the presentation of immunologically important epitopes. Wang, et al., (Virology 200:524-534, 1994) describe a system to study assembly of HIN Gag-β-galactosidase fusion proteins into virions. They describe the construction of sequences encoding HIN Gag-β- galactosidase fusion proteins, the expression of such sequences in the presence of HIN Gag proteins, and assembly of these proteins into virus particles.
Shiver, et al., (PCT International Apphcation, WO 98/34640, published 13 August 1998) described altering HIV-1 (CAM1) Gag coding sequences to produce synthetic DΝA molecules encoding HIN Gag and modifications of HIV Gag. The codons of the synthetic molecules were codons preferred by a projected host cell.
Recently, use of HIV Env polypeptides in immunogenic compositions has been described, (see, U.S. Patent No. 5,846,546 to Hurwitz et al., issued December 8, 1998, describing immunogenic compositions comprising a mixture of at least four different recombinant virus that each express a different HIN env variant; and U.S. Patent No. 5,840,313 to Vahlne et al., issued November 24, 1998, describing peptides which correspond to epitopes ofthe HIV-1 gpl20 protein). In addition, U.S. Patent No. 5,876,731 to Siaet al, issued March 2, 1999 describes candidate vaccines against HIV comprising an amino acid sequence of a T-cell epitope of Gag linked directly to an amino acid sequence of a B-cell epitope of the V3 loop protein of an HIV-1 isolate containing the sequence GPGR.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
Described herein are novel HIV sequences, polypeptides encoded by these novel sequences, and synthetic expression cassettes generated from these and other HIV sequences. In one aspect, the present invention relates to improved HIV expression cassettes. In a second aspect, the present invention relates to generating an immune response in a subject using the expression cassettes of the present invention. In a further aspect, the present invention relates to generating an immune response in a subject using the expression cassettes of the present invention, as well as, polypeptides encoded by the expression cassettes ofthe present invention. In another aspect, the present invention relates to enhanced vaccine technologies for the induction of potent neutralizing antibodies and/or cellular immune responses against HIV in a subject.
In certain embodiments, the present invention relates to synthetic polynucleotides and/or expression cassettes encoding HIV polypeptides, including, but not limited to, Env, Gag, Pol, RT, Int, Prot, Vpr, Vpu, Vif, Nef, Tat, Rev and/or fragments or combinations thereof. In addition, the present invention also relates to improved expression of HIV polypeptides and production of virus-like particles. Synthetic expression cassettes encoding the HIV polypeptides (e.g., Gag-, pol-, protease (prot)-, reverse transcriptase, integrase, RNAseH, Tat, Rev, Nef, Vpr, Vpu, Vif and/or Env- containing polypeptides) are described, as are uses of the expression cassettes. Mutations in some of the genes are described that reduce or eliminate the activity of the gene product without adversely affecting the ability of the gene product to generate an immune response. Exemplary synthetic polynucleotides include, but are not limited to, GagComplPolmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:9), GagComplPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 10), GagComplPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 11), gagCpolInaTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 12), GagPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 13), GagPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 14), GagProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 15), GagProtInaRTmutTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 16), GagRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 17), GagTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 18), gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod (SEQ ID NO: 19), gpl40.modSF162.CwtLnat (SEQ ID NO:20), gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut7 (SEQ ID NO:21), gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut8 (SEQ ID NO:22), int.opt.mut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:23), int.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:24), nef.D125G.-myr.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:25), nef.D107G.-myrl8.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:26), nef.opt.D125G.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:27), nef.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:28), pl5RnaseH.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:29), p2Pol.opt.YMWM.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:30), p2PoUnaopt.YM.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:31), p2Polopt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:32), P2PolTatRevNef.opt.native_B (SEQ ID NO:33), p2PolTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO:34), pol.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:35), prot.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:36), protIna.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:37), protInaRT.YM.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:38), protInaRT.YMWM.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:39), ProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:40), protRT.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:41), ProtRT.TatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO:42), ProtRTTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ 3D NO:43), rev.exonl_2.M5-10.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:44), rev.exonl_2.opt.SFl 62 (SEQ ID NO:45), RT.opt.SF2 (mutant) (SEQ ID NO:46), RT.opt.SF2 (native) (SEQ ID NO:47), RTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:48), tat.exonl_2.opt.C22-37.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:49), tat.exonl_2.opt.C37.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:50), TatRevNef.opt.native.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:51), TatRevNef.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:52), TatRevNefGag B (SEQ ID NO:53), TatRevNefgagCpoUna B (SEQ ID NO:54), TatRevNefGagProtlnaRTmut B (SEQ ID NO:55), TatRevNefp2Pol.opt_B, (SEQ ID NO:56) TatRevNefprotRTopt B (SEQ ID NO:57), vif.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:58), vpr.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:59), and vpu.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:60).
Thus, one aspect of the present invention relates to expression cassettes and polynucleotides contained therein. The expression cassettes typically include an HIV- polypeptide encoding sequence inserted into an expression vector backbone. In one embodiment, an expression cassette comprises a polynucleotide sequence encoding one or more polypeptides, wherein the polynucleotide sequence comprises a sequence having between about 85% to 100% and any integer values therebetween, for example, at least about 85%, preferably about 90%, more preferably about 95%, and more preferably about 98% sequence identity to the sequences taught in the present specification.
The polynucleotides encoding the HIV polypeptides of the present invention may also include sequences encoding additional polypeptides. Such additional polynucleotides encoding polypeptides may include, for example, coding sequences for other viral proteins (e.g., hepatitis B or C or other HIV proteins, such as, polynucleotide sequences encoding an HIV Gag polypeptide, polynucleotide sequences encoding an HIV Env polypeptide and/or polynucleotides encoding one or more of vif, vpr, tat, rev, vpu and nef); cytokines or other transgenes. In one embodiment, the sequence encoding the HIV Pol polypeptide(s) can be modified by deletions of coding regions corresponding to reverse transcriptase and integrase. Such deletions in the polymerase polypeptide can also be made such that the polynucleotide sequence preserves T-helper cell and CTL epitopes. Other antigens of interest may be inserted into the polymerase as well. In another embodiment, an expression cassette comprises a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide, for example, GagComplPolmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:9), GagComplPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 10), GagComplPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 11), gagCpolInaTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 12), GagPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 13), GagPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ TD NO: 14), GagProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 15), GagProtInaRTmutTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 16), GagRTmut.SF2, (SEQ ID NO: 17) GagTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 18), gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod (SEQ TD NO: 19), gpl40.modSF162.CwtLnat (SEQ TD NO:20), gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut7 (SEQ TD NO:21), gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut8 (SEQ TD NO:22), int.opt.mut.SF2 (SEQ TD NO:23), int.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:24), nef.D125G.-myr.opt.SF162 (SEQ TD NO:25), nef.D107G.-myrl8.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:26), nef.opt.D125G.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:27), nef.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:28), pl5RnaseH.opt.SF2 (SEQ TD NO:29), p2Pol.opt.YMWM.SF2 (SEQ TD NO:30), p2PoKnaopt.YM.SF2, (SEQ ID NO:31) p2Polopt.SF2 (SEQ TD NO:32), p2PolTatRevNef.opt.native_B (SEQ ID NO:33), p2PolTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO:34), pol.opt.SF2 (SEQ TD NO:35), prot.opt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:36), protIna.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:37), protInaRT.YM.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:38), protInaRT.YMWM.opt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:39), ProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ TD NO:40), protRT.opt.SF2 (SEQ TD NO:41), ProtRT.TatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO:42), ProtRTTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO:43), rev.exonl_2.M5-10.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:44), rev.exonl_2.opt.SFl 62 (SEQ ID NO:45), RT.opt.SF2 (mutant) (SEQ ED NO:46), RT.opt.SF2 (native) (SEQ ED NO:47), RTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:48), tat.exonl_2.opt.C22-37.SF2 (SEQ TD NO:49), tat.exonl_2.opt.C37.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:50), TatRevNef.opt.native.SF162 (SEQ TD NO:51), TatRevNef.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:52), TatRevNefGag B (SEQ ED NO:53), TatRevNefgagCpoHna B (SEQ ID NO:54), TatRevNefGagProtlnaRTmut B (SEQ TD NO:55), TatRevNefp2Pol.opt_B (SEQ ID NO:56), TatRevNefprotRTopt B (SEQ ED NO:57), vif.opt.SF2 (SEQ TD NO:58), vpr.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:59), and vpu.opt.SF162 (SEQ TD NO:60), wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding the polypeptide comprises a sequence having between about 85% to 100% βxxd any integer values therebetween, for example, at least about 85%, preferably about 90%, more preferably about 95%, and most preferably about 98% sequence identity to the sequences taught in the present specification.
The native and synthetic polynucleotide sequences encoding the HIV polypeptides of the present invention typically have between about 85% to 100% and any integer values therebetween, for example, at least about 85%, preferably about 90%, more preferably about 95%, and more preferably about 98% sequence identity to the sequences taught herein. Further, in certain embodiments, the polynucleotide sequences encoding the HIV polypeptides of the invention will exhibit 100% sequence identity to the sequences taught herein.
The polynucleotides of the present invention can be produced by recombinant techniques, synthetic techniques, or combinations thereof.
The present invention further includes recombinant expression systems for use in selected host cells, wherein the recombinant expression systems employ one or more of the polynucleotides and expression cassettes of the present invention. In such systems, the polynucleotide sequences are operably linked to control elements compatible with expression in the selected host cell. Numerous expression control elements are known to those in the art, including, but not limited to, the following: transcription promoters, transcription enhancer elements, transcription termination signals, polyadenylation sequences, sequences for optimization of initiation of translation, and translation termination sequences. Exemplary transcription promoters include, but are not limited to those derived from CMV, CMV+intron A, SV40, RSV, HIV-Ltr, MMLV-ltr, and metallothionein.
In another aspect the invention includes cells comprising one or more of the expression cassettes ofthe present invention where the polynucleotide sequences are operably linked to control elements compatible with expression in the selected cell. In one embodiment such cells are mammalian cells. Exemplary mammalian cells include, but are not limited to, BHK, VERO, HT1080, 293, RD, COS-7, and CHO cells. Other cells, cell types, tissue types, etc., that may be useful in the practice of the present invention include, but are not limited to, those obtained from the following: insects (e.g., Trichoplusia ni (Tn5) and Sf9), bacteria, yeast, plants, antigen presenting cells (e.g., macrophage, monocytes, dendritic cells, B-cells, T-cells, stem cells, and progenitor cells thereof), primary cells, immortalized cells, tumor-derived cells.
In a further aspect, the present invention includes compositions for generating an immunological response, where the composition typically comprises at least one of the expression cassettes ofthe present invention and may, for example, contain combinations of expression cassettes such as one or more expression cassettes carrying a Pol-derived-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotide, one or more expression cassettes carrying a Gag-derived-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotide, one or more expression cassettes carrying accessory polypeptide-encoding polynucleotides (e.g., native or synthetic vpu, vpr, nef, vif, tat, rev), and/or one or more expression cassettes carrying an Env-derived-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotide. Such compositions may further contain an adjuvant or adjuvants. The compositions may also contain one or more HIV polypeptides. The HIV polypeptides may correspond to the polypeptides encoded by the expression cassette(s) in the composition, or may be different from those encoded by the expression cassettes. In compositions containing both expression cassettes (or polynucleotides of the present invention) and polypeptides, various expression cassettes of the present invention can be mixed and/or matched with various HIV polypeptides described herein. In another aspect the present invention includes methods of immunization of a subject. In the method any of the above described compositions are into the subject under conditions that are compatible with expression of the expression cassette(s) in the subject. In one embodiment, the expression cassettes (or polynucleotides o the present invention) can be introduced using a gene delivery vector. The gene delivery vector can, for example, be a non-viral vector or a viral vector. Exemplary viral vectors include, but are not limited to eucaryotic layered vector initiation systems, Sindbis-virus (or other alphavirus) derived vectors, retroviral vectors, and lentiviral vectors. Other exemplary vectors include, but are not limited to, pCMVKπώ, ρCMV6a, pCMV-link, and pCMVPLEdhfr. Compositions useful for generating an immunological response can also be delivered using a particulate carrier (e.g., PLG or CTAB-PLG microparticles). Further, such compositions can be coated on, for example, gold or tungsten particles and the coated particles delivered to the subject using, for example, a gene gun. The compositions can also be formulated as liposomes. In one embodiment of this method, the subject is a mammal and can, for example, be a human.
In a further aspect, the invention includes methods of generating an immune response in a subject. Any of the expression cassettes described herein can be expressed in a suitable cell to provide for the expression of the HIN polypeptides encoded by the polynucleotides of the present invention. The polyρeptide(s) are then isolated (e.g., substantially purified) and administered to the subject in an amount sufficient to elicit an immune response. In certain embodiments, the methods comprise administration of one or more of the expression cassettes or polynucleotides of the present invention, using any of the gene delivery techniques described herein. In other embodiments, the methods comprise co-administration of one or more ofthe expression cassettes or polynucleotides of the present invention and one or more polypeptides, wherein the polypeptides can be expressed from these polynucleotides or can be other HIN polypeptides. In other embodiments, the methods comprise co- administration of multiple expression cassettes or polynucleotides of the present invention. In still further embodiments, the methods comprise co-administration of multiple polypeptides, for example polypeptides expressed from the polynucleotides of the present invention and/or other HIV polypeptides.
The invention further includes methods of generating an immune response in a subject, where cells of a subject are transfected with any of the above-described expression cassettes or polynucleotides of the present invention, under conditions that permit the expression of a selected polynucleotide and production of a polypeptide of interest (e.g., encoded by any expression cassette of the present invention). By this method an immunological response to the polypeptide is elicited in the subject. Transfection of the cells may be performed ex vivo and the transfected cells are reintroduced into the subject. Alternately, or in addition, the cells may be transfected in vivo in the subject. The immune response may be humoral and/or cell-mediated (cellular). In a further embodiment, this method may also include administration of an HIV polypeptides before, concurrently with, and/or after introduction of the expression cassette into the subject. The polynucleotides of the present invention may be employed singly or in combination. The polynucleotides ofthe present invention, encoding HIV-derived polypeptides, may be expressed in a variety of ways, including, but not limited to the following: a polynucleotide encoding a single gene product (or portion thereof) expressed from a promoter; multiple polynucleotides encoding a more than one gene product (or portion thereof) (e.g., polycistronic coding sequences); multiple polynucleotides in-frame to produce a single polyprotein; and, multiple polynucleotides in-frame to produce a single polyprotein wherein the polyprotein has protein cleavage sites between one or more of the polypeptides comprising the polyprotein.
These and other embodiments of the present invention will readily occur to those of ordinary skill in the art in view of the disclosure herein.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE FIGURES
Figures IA to ID depict the nucleotide sequence of HIV Type C 8_5_TV1_C.ZA ( SEQ ED NO:l; referred to herein as TV1). Various regions are shown in Table A. Figures 2 A-C depicts an alignment of Env polypeptides from various HIV isolates (SF162, SEQ ID NO:2; TV1.8_2, SEQ TD NO:3; TV1.8_5, SEQ ID NO:4; TV2.12-5/1, SEQ ID NO:5; Consensus Sequence, SEQ TD NO:6). The regions between the arrows indicate regions (of TVl and TV2 clones, both HIV Type C isolates) in the beta and/or bridging sheet region(s) that can be deleted and/or truncated. The "*" denotes N-linked glycosylation sites (of TVl and TV2 clones), one or more of which can be modified (e.g., deleted and/or mutated).
Figure 3 presents a schematic diagram showing the relationships between the following forms of the HIV Env polypeptide: gpl60, gpl40, gpl20, and gp41. Figure 4 presents exemplary data concerning transactivation activity of Tat mutants on LTR-CAT plasmid expression in 293 cells.
Figure 5 presents exemplary data concerning export activity of Rev mutants monitored by CAT expression. '
Figure 6, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of GagComplPolmut.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:9).
Figure 7, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of GagComplPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO: 10).
Figure 8, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of GagComplPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 11). Figure 9, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of gagCpolInaTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 12).
Figure 10, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of GagPolmutAtt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO: 13).
Figure 11, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of GagPolmutIna.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 14).
Figure 12, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of GagProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO: 15).
Figure 13, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of GagProtInaRTmutTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ID NO: 16). Figure 14, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of GagRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID
NO: 17). Figure 15, presents the sequence of GagTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ED NO: 18). Figure 16, presents the sequence of gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod (SEQ ED NO: 19).
Figure 17, presents the sequence of gpl40.modSF162.CwtLnat (SEQ ED NO:20).
Figure 18, presents the sequence of gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut7 (SEQ ID NO:21).
Figure 19, presents the sequence of gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut8 (SEQ ED NO:22). Figure 20, presents the sequence of int.opt.mut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:23).
Figure 21, presents the sequence of int.opt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:24). Figure 22, presents the sequence of nef.D125G.-myr.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:25).
Figure 23, presents the sequence of nef.D107G.-myrl8.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:26).
Figure 24, presents the sequence of nef. oρt.D125G.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:27). Figure 25, presents the sequence of nef.opt.SF162 (SEQ TD NO:28). Figure 26, presents the sequence of pl5RnaseH.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:29). Figure 27, presents the sequence of p2Pol.opt.YMWM.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:30). Figure 28, presents the sequence of p2PoUnaopt.YM.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:31).
Figure 29, presents the sequence of ρ2Polopt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:32). Figure 30, presents the sequence of p2PolTatRevNef.opt.native_B (SEQ ED NO:33).
Figure 31, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of p2PolTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ED NO:34).
Figure 32, presents the sequence of pol.opt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:35). Figure 33, presents the sequence of prot.opt.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:36). Figure 34, presents the sequence of protIna.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:37). Figure 35, presents the sequence of ρrotInaRT.YM.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:38). Figure 36, presents the sequence of protInaRT.YMWM.opt.SF2 (SEQ HD
NO:39). Figure 37, presents the sequence of ProtInaRTmut.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:40).
Figure 38, presents the sequence of protRT.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:41).
Figure 39, presents the sequence of ProtRT.TatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ED NO:42). Figure 40, presents the sequence of ProtRTTatRevNef.opt_B (SEQ ED
NO:43).
Figure 41, presents the sequence of rev.exonl_2.M5-10.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:44).
Figure 42, presents the sequence of rev.exonl_2.opt.SFl 62 (SEQ ID NO:45). Figure 43, presents the sequence of RT.opt.SF2 (mutant) (SEQ ED NO:46).
Figure 44, presents the sequence of RT.opt.SF2 (native) (SEQ ED NO:47).
Figure 45, presents the sequence of RTmut.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:48).
Figure 46, presents the sequence of tat.exonl_2.opt.C22-37.SF2 (SEQ ED NO:49). Figure 47, presents the sequence of tat.exonl_2.opt.C37.SF2 (SEQ TD
NO:50).
Figure 48, presents the sequence of TatRevNef.opt.native.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:51).
Figure 49, presents the sequence of TatRevNef.opt.SF162 (SEQ ED NO:52). Figure 50, presents the sequence of TatRevNefGag B (SEQ ED NO:53).
Figure 51, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of TatRevNefgagCpoUna B (SEQ ID NO:54).
Figure 52, sheets 1 and 2, presents the sequence of TatRevNefGagProtlnaRTmut B (SEQ ID NO:55). Figure 53, presents the sequence of TatRevNefp2Pol.opt_B (SEQ ID NO:56).
Figure 54, presents the sequence of TatRevNefprotRTopt B (SEQ ED NO:57).
Figure 55, presents the sequence of vif.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:58).
Figure 56, presents the sequence of vpr.opt.SF2 (SEQ ID NO:59).
Figure 57, presents the sequence of vpu.opt.SF162 (SEQ ID NO:60). Figure 58, presents the sequence of gpl40modSF162.GM135-154-186-195
(SEQ ED NO:61). Figure 59, presents the sequence of gpl40modSF162.GM154 (SEQ TD NO:62).
Figure 60, presents the sequence of gρl40modSF162.GM154-186-195 (SEQ ID NO:63). Figure 61, presents the sequence of gpl40mut7.modSF162.GM154 (SEQ ID
NO:64).
Figure 62 depicts alignment of amino acid sequences of various Env glycosylation mutants (GM), including amino acid translation of gpl40modSF162 (SEQ ID NO:65); translation of gpl40.modSF162.GM154 (SEQ TD NO:66); translation of gpl40.modSF162.GM154-186-195 (SEQ ED NO:67); and gpl40.modSF162.GM135-154-186-195 (SEQ ED NO:68).
Figure 63 presents an overview of genome organization of HIV-1 and useful subgenomic fragments.
Figure 64 presents antibody titer data from immunized rabbits following immunization with HIV Envelope DNA constructs and protein.
Figure 65 presents a comparison of ELISA titers against subtype B and C Envelope proteins in rabbit sera collected after three DNA immunizations and a single protein boost.
Figure 66 presents data of neutralizing antibody responses against subtype B SF162 EnvdV2 strain in rabbits immunized with subtype C TVl Env in a DNA prime protein boost regimen.
Figure 67 presents data of neutralizing antibody responses against subtype C primary strains, TVl and TV2 in 5.25 reporter cell assay after a single protein boost.
Figure 68 presents data of neutralizing antibody responses against subtype C, TVl and Dul74, and subtype B, SF162 after a single protein boost (as measured by Duke PBMC assay).
DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION
The practice ofthe present invention will employ, unless otherwise indicated, conventional methods of chemistry, biochemistry, molecular biology, immunology and pharmacology, within the skill ofthe art. Such techniques are explained fully in the literature. See, e.g., Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18th Edition (Easton, Pennsylvania: Mack Publishing Company, 1990); Methods In Enzymology (S. Colowick and N. Kaplan, eds., Academic Press, Inc.); and Handbook of Experimental Immunology, Vols. I-IV (D.M. Weir and CC. Blackwell, eds., 1986, Blackwell Scientific Pubhcations); Sambrook, et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (2nd Edition, 1989); Short Protocols in Molecular Biology, 4th ed. (Ausubel et al. eds., 1999, John Wiley & Sons); Molecular Biology Techniques: An Intensive Laboratory Course, (Ream et al., eds., 1998, Academic Press); PCR (Introduction to Biotechniques Series), 2nd ed. (Newton & Graham eds., 1997, Springer Verlag). As used in this specification, the singular forms "a," "an" and "the" include plural references unless the content clearly dictates otherwise. Thus, for example, reference to "an antigen" includes a mixture of two or more such agents.
1. DEFINITIONS In describing the present invention, the following terms will be employed, and are intended to be defined as indicated below.
"Synthetic" sequences, as used herein, refers to HIV polypeptide-encødzng polynucleotides whose expression has been modified as described herein, for example, by codon substitution, altered activities, and/or inactivation of inhibitory sequences. "Wild-type" or "native" sequences, as used herein, refers to polypeptide encoding sequences that are essentially as they are found in nature, e.g., Gag, Pol, Vif, Vpr, Tat, Rev, Vpu, Env and/or Nef encoding sequences as found in HIV isolates, e.g., SF162, SF2, AF110965, AF110967, API 10968, AF110975, 8_5_TV1_C.ZA, 8_2_TV1_C.ZA or 12-5_1_TV2_C.ZA. The various regions of the HIV genome are shown in Table A, with numbering relative to 8_5_TV1_C.ZA (Figures 1 A- ID).
Thus, the term "Pol" refers to one or more of the following polypeptides: polymerase (p6Pol); protease (prot); reverse transcriptase (p66RT or RT); RNAseH (pl5RNAseH); and/or integrase (p31Int or Int). Identification of gene regions for any selected HIN isolate can be performed by one of ordinary skill in the art based on the teachings presented herein and the information known in the art, for example, by performing alignments relative to 8_5_TN1_C.ZA (Figures 1A-1D) or alignment to other known HIV isolates, for example, Subtype B isolates with gene regions (e.g., SF2, GenBank Accession number K02007; SF162, GenBank Accession Number M38428) and Subtype C isolates with gene regions (e.g., GenBank Accession Number AF110965 and GenBank Accession Number AF110975). As used herein, the term "virus-like particle" or "VLP" refers to a nonreplicating, viral shell, derived from any of several viruses discussed further below. VLPs are generally composed of one or more viral proteins, such as, but not limited to those proteins referred to as capsid, coat, shell, surface and/or envelope proteins, or particle-forming polypeptides derived from these proteins. VLPs can form spontaneously upon recombinant expression of the protein in an appropriate expression system. Methods for producing particular VLPs are known in the art and discussed more fully below. The presence of VLPs following recombinant expression of viral proteins can be detected using conventional techniques known in the art, such as by electron microscopy, X-ray crystallography, and the like. See, e.g., Baker et al., Biophys. J. (1991) 60: 1445-1456; Hagensee et al., J. Virol. (1994) 68:4503-4505.
For example, VLPs can be isolated by density gradient centrifugation and/or identified by characteristic density banding. Alternatively, cryoelectron microscopy can be performed on vitrified aqueous samples of the VLP preparation in question, and images recorded under appropriate exposure conditions. By "particle-forming polypeptide" derived from a particular viral protein is meant a full-length or near full-length viral protein, as well as a fragment thereof, or a viral protein with internal deletions, which has the ability to form VLPs under conditions that favor VLP formation. Accordingly, the polypeptide may comprise the full-length sequence, fragments, truncated and partial sequences, as well as analogs and precursor forms of the reference molecule. The term therefore intends deletions, additions and substitutions to the sequence, so long as the polypeptide retains the ability to form a VLP. Thus, the term includes natural variations of the specified polypeptide since variations in coat proteins often occur between viral isolates. The term also includes deletions, additions and substitutions that do not naturally occur in the reference protein, so long as the protein retains the ability to form a VLP. Preferred substitutions are those which are conservative in nature, i.e., those if it..» ϋ - 'Ljf >:::» tut ic; . E: __ .."& u"il"«::::L
substitutions that take place within a family of amino acids that are related in their side chains. Specifically, amino acids are generally divided into four families: (1) acidic ~ aspartate and glutamate; (2) basic ~ lysine, arginine, histidine; (3) non-polar ~ alanine, valine, leucine, isoleucine, proline, phenylalanine, methionine, tryptophan; and (4) uncharged polar — glycine, asparagine, glutamine, cystine, serine threonine, tyrosine. Phenylalanine, tryptophan, and tyrosine are sometimes classified as aromatic amino acids.
The term "HIV polypeptide" refers to any amino acid sequence that exhibits sequence homology to native HIV polypeptides (e.g., Gag, Env, Prot, Pol, RT, Int, vif, vpr, vpu, tat, rev, nef and/or combinations thereof) and/or which is functional. Non- limiting examples of functions that may be exhibited by HIV polypeptides include, use as immunogens (e.g., to generate a humoral and/or cellular immune response), use in diagnostics (e.g, bound by suitable antibodies for use in ELISAs or other immunoassays) and/or polypeptides which exhibit one or more biological activities associated with the wild type or synthetic HIV polypeptide. For example, as used herein, the term "Gag polypeptide" may refer to a polypeptide that is bound by one or more anti-Gag antibodies; elicits a humoral and/or cellular immune response; and/or exhibits the ability to form particles.
An "antigen" refers to a molecule containing one or more epitopes (either linear, conformational or both) that will stimulate a host's immune system to make a humoral and/or cellular antigen-specific response. The term is used interchangeably with the term "immunogen." Normally, a B-cell epitope will include at least about 5 amino acids but can be as small as 3-4 amino acids. A T-cell epitope, such as a CTL epitope, wiU include at least about 7-9 amino acids, and a helper T-cell epitope at least about 12-20 amino acids. Normally, an epitope will include between about 7 and 15 amino acids, such as, 9, 10, 12 or 15 amino acids. The term "antigen" denotes both subunit antigens, (Le., antigens which are separate and discrete from a whole organism with which the antigen is associated in nature), as well as, killed, attenuated or inactivated bacteria, viruses, fungi, parasites or other microbes. Antibodies such as anti-idiotype antibodies, or fragments thereof, and synthetic peptide mimotopes, which can mimic an antigen or antigenic determinant, are also captured under the definition of antigen as used herein. Similarly, an oligonucleotide or polynucleotide which expresses an antigen or antigenic determinant in vivo, such as in gene therapy and DNA immunization applications, is also included in the definition of antigen herein. For purposes of the present invention, antigens can be derived from any of several known viruses, bacteria, parasites and fungi, as described more fully below.
The term also intends any of the various tumor antigens. Furthermore, for purposes of the present invention, an "antigen" refers to a protein which includes modifications, such as deletions, additions and substitutions (generally conservative in nature), to the native sequence, so long as the protein maintains the ability to elicit an immunological response, as defined herein. These modifications may be dehberate, as through site- directed mutagenesis, or may be accidental, such as through mutations of hosts which produce the antigens.
An "immunological response" to an antigen or composition is the development in a subject of a humoral and/or a cellular immune response to an antigen present in the composition of interest. For purposes of the present invention, a "humoral immune response" refers to an immune response mediated by antibody molecules, while a "cellular immune response" is one mediated by T-lymphocytes and/or other white blood cells. One important aspect of cellular immunity involves an antigen-specific response by cytolytic T-cells ("CTL"s). CTLs have specificity for peptide antigens that are presented in association with proteins encoded by the major histocompatibihty complex (MHC) and expressed on the surfaces of cells. CTLs help induce and promote the destruction of intracellular microbes, or the lysis of cells infected with such microbes. Another aspect of cellular immunity involves an antigen-specific response by helper T-cells. Helper T-cells act to help stimulate the function, and focus the activity of, nonspecific effector cells against cells displaying peptide antigens in association with MHC molecules on their surface. A "cellular immune response" also refers to the production of cytokines, chemokines and other such molecules produced by activated T-cells and/or other white blood ceUs, including those derived from CD4+ and CD8+ T-cells. A composition or vaccine that elicits a cellular immune response may serve to sensitize a vertebrate subject by the presentation of antigen in association with MHC molecules at the cell surface. The cell-mediated immune response is directed at, or near, cells presenting antigen at their surface. In addition, antigen-specific T- lymphocytes can be generated to allow for the future protection of an immunized host. The ability of a particular antigen to stimulate a cell-mediated immunological response may be determined by a number of assays, such as by lymphoprohferation (lymphocyte activation) assays, CTL cytotoxic ceU assays, or by assaying for T- lymphocytes specific for the antigen in a sensitized subject. Such assays are well known in the art. See, e.g., Erickson et al, J. Immunol. (1993) 151:4189-4199; Doe et al., Eur. J. Immunol. (1994) 24:2369-2376. Recent methods of measuring cell- mediated immune response include measurement of intracellular cytokines or cytokine secretion by T-cell populations, or by measurement of epitope specific T-cells (e.g., by the tetramer technique) (reviewed by McMichael, A.J., and O'Callaghan, C.A., J. Exp. Med. 187(9)1367-1371, 1998; Mcheyzer-Wilhams, M.G., et al, Immunol. Rev. 150:5- 21, 1996; Lalvani, A., et al, J. Exp. Med. 186:859-865, 1997). Thus, an immunological response as used herein may be one which stimulates the production of CTLs, and/or the production or activation of helper T- cells. The antigen of interest may also elicit an antibody-mediated immune response. Hence, an immunological response may include one or more of the following effects: the production of antibodies by B-cells; and/or the activation of suppressor T-cells and/or γδ T-cells directed specifically to an antigen or antigens present in the composition or vaccine of interest. These responses may serve to neutralize infectivity, and/or mediate antibody-complement, or antibody dependent cell cytotoxicity (ADCC) to provide protection to an immunized host. Such responses can be determined using standard immunoassays and neutralization assays, well known in the art. An "immunogenic composition" is a composition that comprises an antigenic molecule where administration of the composition to a subject results in the development in the subject of a humoral and/or a cellular immune response to the antigenic molecule of interest. The immunogenic composition can be introduced directly into a recipient subject, such as by injection, inhalation, oral, intranasal and mucosal (e.g., intra-rectally or intra-vaginally) administration. By "subunit vaccine" is meant a vaccine composition which includes one or more selected antigens but not all antigens, derived from or homologous to, an antigen from a pathogen of interest such as from a virus, bacterium, parasite or fungus. Such a composition is substantially free of intact pathogen cells or pathogenic particles, or the lysate of such cells or particles. Thus, a "subunit vaccine" can be prepared from at least partially purified (preferably substantiaUy purified) immunogenic polypeptides from the pathogen, or analogs thereof. The method of obtaining an antigen included in the subunit vaccine can thus include standard purification techniques, recombinant production, or synthetic production. "Substantially purified" general refers to isolation of a substance (compound, polynucleotide, protein, polypeptide, polypeptide composition) such that the substance comprises the majority percent of the sample in which it resides. Typically in a sample a substantially purified component comprises 50%, preferably 80%-85%, more preferably 90-95% of the sample. Techniques for purifying polynucleotides and polypeptides of interest are well-known in the art and include, for example, ion- exchange chromatography, affinity chromatography and sedimentation according to density.
A "coding sequence" or a sequence which "encodes" a selected polypeptide, is a nucleic acid molecule which is transcribed (in the case of DNA) and translated (in the case of mRNA) into a polypeptide in vivo when placed under the control of appropriate regulatory sequences (or "control elements"). The boundaries of the coding sequence are determined by a start codon at the 5' (amino) terminus and a translation stop codon at the 3' (carboxy) terminus. A coding sequence can include, but is not limited to, cDNA from viral, procaryotic or eucaryotic mRNA, genomic DNA sequences from viral or procaryotic DNA, and even synthetic DNA sequences. A transcription termination sequence such as a stop codon may be located 3' to the coding sequence.
Typical "control elements", include, but are not limited to, transcription promoters, transcription enhancer elements, transcription termination signals, polyadenylation sequences (located 3' to the translation stop codon), sequences for optimization of initiation of translation (located 5' to the coding sequence), and translation termination sequences. For example, the sequences and/or vectors described herein may also include one or more additional sequences that may optimize translation and/or termination including, but not limited to, a Kozak sequence (e.g., GCCACC placed in front (5') of the ATG of the codon-optimized wild-type leader or any other suitable leader sequence (e.g., tpal, tpa2, wtLnat (native wild-type leader)) or a termination sequence (e.g., TAA or, preferably, TAAA placed after (3') the coding sequence.
A "polynucleotide coding sequence" or a sequence which "encodes" a selected polypeptide, is a nucleic acid molecule which is transcribed (in the case of DNA) and translated (in the case of mRNA) into a polypeptide in vivo when placed under the control of appropriate regulatory sequences (or "control elements"). The boundaries of the coding sequence are determined by a start codon, for example, at or near the 5' terminus and a translation stop codon, for example, at or near the 3' terminus. Exemplary coding sequences are the modified viral polypeptide-coding sequences of the present invention. The coding regions of the polynucleotide sequences of the present invention are identifiable by one of skill in the art and may, for example, be easily identified by performing translations of all three frames of the polynucleotide and identifying the frame corresponding to the encoded polypeptide, for example, a synthetic nef polynucleotide of the present invention encodes a nef-derived polypeptide. A transcription termination sequence may be located 3' to the coding sequence. Typical "control elements", include, but are not limited to, transcription regulators, such as promoters, transcription enhancer elements, transcription termination signals, and polyadenylation sequences; and translation regulators, such as sequences for optimization of initiation of translation, e.g., Shine-Dalgarno (ribosome binding site) sequences, Kozak sequences (i.e., sequences for the optimization of translation, located, for example, 5' to the coding sequence), leader sequences, translation initiation codon (e.g., ATG), and translation termination sequences. In certain embodiments, one or more translation regulation or initiation sequences (e.g., the leader sequence) are derived from wild-type translation initiation sequences, i.e., sequences that regulate translation of the coding region in their native state. Wild-type leader sequences that have been modified, using the methods described herein, also find use in the present invention. Promoters can include inducible promoters (where expression of a polynucleotide sequence operably linked to the promoter is induced by an analyte, cofactor, regulatory protein, etc.), repressible promoters (where expression of a polynucleotide sequence operably linked to the promoter is induced by an analyte, cofactor, regulatory protein, etc.), and constitutive promoters.
A "nucleic acid" molecule can include, but is not limited to, procaryotic sequences, eucaryotic mRNA, cDNA from eucaryotic mRNA, genomic DNA sequences from eucaryotic (e.g., mammalian) DNA, and even synthetic DNA sequences. The term also captures sequences that include any of the known base analogs of DNA and RN .
"Operably linked" refers to an arrangement of elements wherein the components so described are configured so as to perform their usual function. Thus, a given promoter operably linked to a coding sequence is capable of effecting the expression of the coding sequence when the proper enzymes are present. The promoter need not be contiguous with the coding sequence, so long as it functions to direct the expression thereof. Thus, for example, intervening untranslated yet transcribed sequences can be present between the promoter sequence and the coding sequence and the promoter sequence can still be considered "operably linked" to the coding sequence. "Recombinant" as used herein to describe a nucleic acid molecule means a polynucleotide of genomic, cDNA, semisynthetic, or synthetic origin which, by virtue of its origin or manipulation: (1) is not associated with all or a portion of the polynucleotide with which it is associated in nature; and/or (2) is linked to a polynucleotide other than that to which it is linked in nature. The term "recombinant" as used with respect to a protein or polypeptide means a polypeptide produced by expression of a recombinant polynucleotide. "Recombinant host cells," "host cells," "cells," "cell lines," "cell cultures," and other such terms denoting procaryotic microorganisms or eucaryotic cell lines cultured as unicellular entities, are used interchangeably, and refer to cells which can be, or have been, used as recipients for recombinant vectors or other transfer DNA, and include the progeny of the original cell which has been transfected. It is understood that the progeny of a single parental cell may not necessarily be completely identical in morphology or in genomic or total DNA complement to the original parent, due to accidental or dehberate mutation. Progeny of the parental cell which are sufficiently similar to the parent to be characterized by the relevant property, such as the presence of a nucleotide sequence encoding a desired peptide, are included in the progeny intended by this definition, and are covered by the above terms.
Techniques for determining amino acid sequence "similarity" are well known in the art. In general, "similarity" means the exact amino acid to amino acid comparison of two or more polypeptides at the appropriate place, where amino acids are identical or possess similar chemical and/or physical properties such as charge or hydrophobicity. A so-termed "percent similarity" then can be determined between the compared polypeptide sequences. Techniques for determining nucleic acid and amino acid sequence identity also are well known in the art and include determining the nucleotide sequence of the mRNA for that gene (usually via a cDNA intermediate) and determining the amino acid sequence encoded thereby, and comparing this to a second amino acid sequence. In general, "identity" refers to an exact nucleotide to nucleotide or amino acid to amino acid correspondence of two polynucleotides or polypeptide sequences, respectively.
Two or more polynucleotide sequences can be compared by determining their "percent identity." Two or more amino acid sequences likewise can be compared by determining their "percent identity." The percent identity of two sequences, whether nucleic acid or peptide sequences, is generally described as the number of exact matches between two aligned sequences divided by the length of the shorter sequence and multiplied by 100. An approximate alignment for nucleic acid sequences is provided by the local homology algorithm of Smith and Waterman, Advances in
Applied Mathematics 2:482-489 (1981). This algorithm can be extended to use with peptide sequences using the scoring matrix developed by Dayhoff, Atlas of Protein Sequences and Structure, M.O. Dayhoff ed., 5 suppl. 3:353-358, National Biomedical Research Foundation, Washington, D.C., USA, and normalized by Gribskov, Nucl. Acids Res. 14(6): 6745-6763 (1986). An implementation of this algorithm for nucleic acid and peptide sequences is provided by the Genetics Computer Group (Madison, WI) in their BestFit utility apphcation. The default parameters for this method are described in the Wisconsin Sequence Analysis Package Program Manual, Version 8 (1995) (available from Genetics Computer Group, Madison, WI). Other equally suitable programs for calculating the percent identity or similarity between sequences are generally known in the art.
For example, percent identity of a particular nucleotide sequence to a reference sequence can be determined using the homology algorithm of Smith and Waterman with a default scoring table and a gap penalty of six nucleotide positions. Another method of establishing percent identity in the context of the present invention is to use the MPSRCH package of programs copyrighted by the University of Edinburgh, developed by John F. Collins and Shane S. Sturrok, and distributed by IntelhGenetics, Inc. (Mountain View, CA). From this suite of packages, the Smith- Waterman algorithm can be employed where default parameters are used for the scoring table (for example, gap open penalty of 12, gap extension penalty of one, and a gap of six). From the data generated, the "Match" value reflects "sequence identity." Other suitable programs for calculating the percent identity or similarity between sequences are generally known in the art, such as the alignment program BLAST, which can also be used with default parameters. For example, BLASTN and BLASTP can be used with the following default parameters: genetic code = standard; filter = none; strand = both; cutoff = 60; expect = 10; Matrix = BLOSUM62; Descriptions = 50 sequences; sort by = HIGH SCORE; Databases = non-redundant, GenBank + EMBL + DDBJ + PDB + GenBank CDS translations + Swiss protein + Spupdate + PIR. Details of these programs can be found at the following internet address: http://www.ncbi.nlm.gov/cgi- bin BLAST. One of skill in the art can readily determine the proper search parameters to use for a given sequence, exemplary preferred Smith Waterman based parameters are presented above. For example, the search parameters may vary based on the size of the sequence in question. Thus, for the polynucleotide sequences ofthe present invention the length of the polynucleotide sequence disclosed herein is searched against a selected database and compared to sequences of essentially the same length to determine percent identity. For example, a representative embodiment ofthe present invention would include an isolated polynucleotide comprising X contiguous nucleotides, wherein (i) the X contiguous nucleotides have at least about a selected level of percent identity relative to Y contiguous nucleotides of one or more of the sequences described herein (e.g., in Table C) or fragment thereof, and (ii) for search purposes X equals Y, wherein Y is a selected reference polynucleotide of defined length (for example, a length of from 15 nucleotides up to the number of nucleotides present in a selected full-length sequence).
The sequences of the present invention can include fragments of the sequences, for example, from about 15 nucleotides up to the number of nucleotides present in the full-length sequences described herein (e.g., see the Figures), including all integer values falling within the above-described range. For example, fragments of the polynucleotide sequences of the present invention may be 30-60 nucleotides, 60-120 nucleotides, 120-240 nucleotides, 240-480 nucleotides, 480-1000 nucleotides, and all integer values therebetween. The synthetic expression cassettes (and purified polynucleotides) of the present invention include related polynucleotide sequences having about 80% to 100%, greater than 80-85%, preferably greater than 90-92%, more preferably greater than 95%, and most preferably greater than 98% up to 100% (including ah integer values falling within these described ranges) sequence identity to the synthetic expression cassette and/or polynucleotide sequences disclosed herein (for example, to the sequences of the present invention) when the sequences of the present invention are used as the query sequence against, for example, a database of sequences.
Two nucleic acid fragments are considered to "selectively hybridize" as described herein. The degree of sequence identity between two nucleic acid molecules affects the efficiency and strength of hybridization events between such molecules. A partially identical nucleic acid sequence will at least partially inhibit a completely identical sequence from hybridizing to a target molecule. Inhibition of hybridization of the completely identical sequence can be assessed using hybridization assays that are well known in the art (e.g., Southern blot, Northern blot, solution hybridization, or the like, see Sambrook, et al., supra or Ausubel et al., supra). Such assays can be conducted using varying degrees of selectivity, for example, using conditions varying from low to high stringency. If conditions of low stringency are employed, the absence of non-specific binding can be assessed using a secondary probe that lacks even a partial degree of sequence identity (for example, a probe having less than about 30% sequence identity with the target molecule), such that, in the absence of non- specific binding events, the secondary probe will not hybridize to the target.
When utilizing a hybridization-based detection system, a nucleic acid probe is chosen that is complementary to a target nucleic acid sequence, and then by selection of appropriate conditions the probe and the target sequence "selectively hybridize," or bind, to each other to form a hybrid molecule. A nucleic acid molecule that is capable of hybridizing selectively to a target sequence under "moderately stringent" typically hybridizes under conditions that allow detection of a target nucleic acid sequence of at least about 10-14 nucleotides in length having at least approximately 70% sequence identity with the sequence ofthe selected nucleic acid probe. Stringent hybridization conditions typically allow detection of target nucleic acid sequences of at least about 10-14 nucleotides in length having a sequence identity of greater than about 90-95% with the sequence of the selected nucleic acid probe. Hybridization conditions useful for probe/target hybridization where the probe and target have a specific degree of sequence identity, can be determined as is known in the art (see, for example, Nucleic Acid Hybridization: A Practical Approach, editors B.D. Hames and S.J. Higgins, (1985) Oxford; Washington, DC; IRL Press).
With respect to stringency conditions for hybridization, it is well known in the art that numerous equivalent conditions can be employed to establish a particular stringency by varying, for example, the foUowing factors: the length and nature of probe and target sequences, base composition of the various sequences, concentrations of salts and other hybridization solution components, the presence or absence of blocking agents in the hybridization solutions (e.g., formamide, dextran sulfate, and polyethylene glycol), hybridization reaction temperature and time parameters, as well as, varying wash conditions. The selection of a particular set of hybridization conditions is selected following standard methods in the art (see, for example, Sambrook, et al., supra or Ausubel et al., supra). A first polynucleotide is "derived from" second polynucleotide if it has the same or substantially the same basepair sequence as a region of the second polynucleotide, its cDNA, complements thereof, or if it displays sequence identity as described above. A first polypeptide is "derived from" a second polypeptide if it is (i) encoded by a first polynucleotide derived from a second polynucleotide, or (ii) displays sequence identity to the second polypeptides as described above.
Generally, a viral polypeptide is "derived from" a particular polypeptide of a virus (viral polypeptide) if it is (i) encoded by an open reading frame of a polynucleotide of that virus (viral polynucleotide), or (ii) displays sequence identity to polypeptides of that virus as described above.
"Encoded by" refers to a nucleic acid sequence which codes for a polypeptide sequence, wherein the polypeptide sequence or a portion thereof contains an amino acid sequence of at least 3 to 5 amino acids, more preferably at least 8 to 10 amino acids, and even more preferably at least 15 to 20 amino acids from a polypeptide encoded by the nucleic acid sequence. Also encompassed are polypeptide sequences which are immunologically identifiable with a polypeptide encoded by the sequence. Further, polyproteins can be constructed by fusing in-frame two or more polynucleotide sequences encoding polypeptide or peptide products. Further, polycistronic coding sequences may be produced by placing two or more polynucleotide sequences encoding polypeptide products adjacent each other, typically under the control of one promoter, wherein each polypeptide coding sequence may be modified to include sequences for internal ribosome binding sites.
"Purified polynucleotide" refers to a polynucleotide of interest or fragment thereof which is essentially free, e.g., contains less than about 50%, preferably less than about 70%, and more preferably less than about 90%, ofthe protein with which the polynucleotide is naturally associated. Techniques for purifying polynucleotides of interest are well-known in the art and include, for example, disruption ofthe cell containing the polynucleotide with a chaotropic agent and separation of the polynucleotide(s) and proteins by ion-exchange chromatography, affinity chromatography and sedimentation according to density. By "nucleic acid immunization" is meant the introduction of a nucleic acid molecule encoding one or more selected antigens into a host cell, for the in vivo expression of an antigen, antigens, an epitope, or epitopes. The nucleic acid molecule can be introduced directly into a recipient subject, such as by injection, inhalation, oral, intranasal and mucosal administration, or the like, or can be introduced ex vivo, into cells which have been removed from the host. In the latter case, the transformed cells are reintroduced into the subject where an immune response can be mounted against the antigen encoded by the nucleic acid molecule.
"Gene transfer" or "gene dehvery" refers to methods or systems for reliably inserting DNA of interest into a host ceU. Such methods can result in transient expression of non-integrated transferred DNA, extrachromosomal replication and expression of transferred replicons (e.g., episomes), or integration of transferred genetic material into the genomic DNA of host cells. Gene dehvery expression vectors include, but are not limited to, vectors derived from alphaviruses, pox viruses and vaccinia viruses. When used for immunization, such gene dehvery expression vectors may be referred to as vaccines or vaccine vectors.
"T lymphocytes" or "T cells" are non-antibody producing lymphocytes that constitute a part of the cell-mediated arm of the immune system. T cells arise from immature lymphocytes that migrate from the bone marrow to the thymus, where they undergo a maturation process under the direction of thymic hormones. Here, the mature lymphocytes rapidly divide increasing to very large numbers. The maturing T cells become immunocompetent based on their ability to recognize and bind a specific antigen. Activation of immunocompetent T cells is triggered when an antigen binds to the lymphocyte's surface receptors. The term "transfection" is used to refer to the uptake of foreign DNA by a cell.
A cell has been "transfected" when exogenous DNA has been introduced inside the cell membrane. A number of transfection techniques are generally known in the art. See, e.g., Graham et al. (1973) Virology, 52:456, Sambrook et al. (1989) Molecular Cloning, a laboratory manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratories, New York, Davis et al. (1986) Basic Methods in Molecular Biology, Elsevier, and Chu et al. (1981) Gene _3:197. Such techniques can be used to introduce one or more exogenous DNA moieties into suitable host cells. The term refers to both stable and transient uptake of the genetic material, and includes uptake of peptide- or antibody-linked DNAs.
A "vector" is capable of transferring gene sequences to target cells (e.g., viral vectors, non- viral vectors, particulate carriers, and liposomes). Typically, "vector construct," "expression vector," and "gene transfer vector," mean any nucleic acid construct capable of directing the expression of a gene of interest and which can transfer gene sequences to target cells. Thus, the term includes cloning and expression vehicles, as well as viral vectors.
Transfer of a "suicide gene" (e.g., a drug-susceptibility gene) to a target cell renders the cell sensitive to compounds or compositions that are relatively nontoxic to normal ceUs. Moolten, F.L. (1994) Cancer Gene Ther. 1:279-287. Examples of suicide genes are thymidine kinase of herpes simplex virus (HSV-tk), cytochrome P450 (Manome et al. (1996) Gene Therapy 3:513-520), human deoxycytidine kinase (Manome et al. (1996) Nature Medicine 2(5):567-573) and the bacterial enzyme cytosine deaminase (Dong et al. (1996) Human Gene Therapy 7:713-720). Cells which express these genes are rendered sensitive to the effects of the relatively nontoxic prodrugs ganciclovir (HSV-tk), cyclophosphamide (cytochrome P450 2B1), cytosine arabinoside (human deoxycytidine kinase) or 5-fluorocytosine (bacterial cytosine deaminase). Culver et al. (1992) Science 256:1550-1552, Huber et al. (1994) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 91:8302-8306.
A "selectable marker" or "reporter marker" refers to a nucleotide sequence included in a gene transfer vector that has no therapeutic activity, but rather is included to aUow for simpler preparation, manufacturing, characterization or testing of the gene transfer vector. A "specific binding agent" refers to a member of a specific binding pair of molecules wherein one of the molecules specifically binds to the second molecule through chemical and/or physical means. One example of a specific binding agent is an antibody directed against a selected antigen.
By "subject" is meant any member of the subphylum chordata, including, without limitation, humans and other primates, including non-human primates such as rhesus macaque, chimpanzees and other apes and monkey species; farm animals such as cattle, sheep, pigs, goats and horses; domestic mammals such as dogs and cats; laboratory animals including rodents such as mice, rats and guinea pigs; birds, including domestic, wild and game birds such as chickens, turkeys and other gallinaceous birds, ducks, geese, and the like. The term does not denote a particular age. Thus, both adult and newborn individuals are intended to be covered. The system described above is intended for use in any of the above vertebrate species, since the immune systems of all of these vertebrates operate similarly.
By "pharmaceutically acceptable" or "pharmacologically acceptable" is meant a material which is not biologically or otherwise undesirable, i.e., the material may be administered to an individual in a formulation or composition without causing any undesirable biological effects or interacting in a deleterious manner with any of the components of the composition in which it is contained.
By "physiological pH" or a "pH in the physiological range" is meant a pH in the range of approximately 7.0 to 8.0 inclusive, more typically in the range of approximately 7.2 to 7.6 inclusive.
As used herein, "treatment" refers to any of (i) the prevention of infection or reinfection, as in a traditional vaccine, (ii) the reduction or elimination of symptoms, and (iii) the substantial or complete elimination ofthe pathogen in question. Treatment may be effected prophylactically (prior to infection) or therapeutically (following infection).
By "co-administration" is meant administration of more than one composition or molecule. Thus, co-administration includes concurrent administration or sequentially administration (in any order), via the same or different routes of administration. Non-limiting examples of co-administration regimes include, co- administration of nucleic acid and polypeptide; co-administration of different nucleic acids (e.g., different expression cassettes as described herein and/or different gene dehvery vectors); and co-administration of different polypeptides (e.g., different HIV polypeptides and/or different adjuvants). The term also encompasses multiple administrations of one of the co-administered molecules or compositions (e.g., multiple administrations of one or more of the expression cassettes described herein foUowed by one or more administrations of a polypeptide-containing composition). In cases where the molecules or compositions are delivered sequentially, the time between each administration can be readily determined by one of skill in the art in view of the teachings herein.
"Lentiviral vector", and "recombinant lentiviral vector" refer to a nucleic acid construct which carries, and within certain embodiments, is capable of directing the expression of a nucleic acid molecule of interest. The lentiviral vector include at least one transcriptional promoter/enhancer or locus defining element(s), or other elements which control gene expression by other means such as alternate splicing, nuclear RNA export, post-translational modification of messenger, or post-transcriptional modification of protein. Such vector constructs must also include a packaging signal, long terminal repeats (LTRS) or portion thereof, and positive and negative strand primer binding sites appropriate to the retrovirus used (if these are not already present in the retroviral vector). OptionaUy, the recombinant lentiviral vector may also include a signal which directs polyadenylation, selectable markers such as Neo, TK, hygromycin, phleomycin, histidinol, or DHFR, as well as one or more restriction sites and a translation termination sequence. By way of example, such vectors typically include a 5' LTR, a tRNA binding site, a packaging signal, an origin of second strand DNA synthesis, and a 3'LTR or a portion thereof
"Lentiviral vector particle" as utilized within the present invention refers to a lentivirus which carries at least one gene of interest. The retrovirus may also contain a selectable marker. The recombinant lentivirus is capable of reverse transcribing its genetic material (RNA) into DNA and incorporating this genetic material into a host cell's DNA upon infection. Lentiviral vector particles may have a lentiviral envelope, a non-lentiviral envelope (e.g., an ampho or VSV-G envelope), or a chimeric envelope. "Nucleic acid expression vector" or "Expression cassette" refers to an assembly which is capable of directing the expression of a sequence or gene of interest. The nucleic acid expression vector includes a promoter which is operably linked to the sequences or gene(s) of interest. Other control elements may be present as well. Expression cassettes described herein may be contained within a plasmid construct. In addition to the components of the expression cassette, the plasmid construct may also include a bacterial origin of replication, one or more selectable markers, a signal which allows the plasmid construct to exist as single-stranded DNA (e.g., a Ml 3 origin of replication), a multiple cloning site, and a "mammalian" origin of replication (e.g., a SV40 or adenovirus origin of replication).
"Packaging cell" refers to a cell which contains those elements necessary for production of infectious recombinant retrovirus which are lacking in a recombinant retroviral vector. Typically, such packaging cells contain one or more expression cassettes which are capable of expressing proteins which encode Gag, pol and env proteins.
"Producer cell" or "vector producing cell" refers to a cell which contains all elements necessary for production of recombinant retroviral vector particles.
2. MODES OF CARRYING OUT THE INVENTION
Before describing the present invention in detail, it is to be understood that this invention is not limited to particular formulations or process parameters as such may, of course, vary. It is also to be understood that the terminology used herein is for the purpose of describing particular embodiments of the invention only, and is not intended to be limiting.
Although a number of methods and materials similar or equivalent to those described herein can be used in the practice of the present invention, the preferred materials and methods are described herein.
2.1. THE HIV GENOME
The HIN genome and various polypeptide-encoding regions are shown in Table A. The nucleotide positions are given relative to 8_5_TN1_C.ZA (Figure 1; an HIN Type C isolate). However, it will be readily apparent to one of ordinary skill in the art in view of the teachings of the present disclosure how to determine corresponding regions in other HIN strains or variants (e.g., isolates HiN^, HINSF2, HIV-1SF162, HIV-1SF170, HINLAV, HINLAI, HIN, HIV-1CM235„ HTV-1US4, other HIV-1 strains from diverse subtypes(e.g., subtypes, A through G, and O), HIV-2 strains and diverse subtypes (e.g., HIN-2UC1 and HIN-2UC2), and simian immunodeficiency virus (SIN). (See, e.g., Virology, 3rd Edition (W.K. Joklik ed. 1988); Fundamental Virology, 2nd Edition (B.N. Fields and D.M. Knipe, eds. 1991); Virology, 3rd Edition (Fields, BN, DM Knipe, PM Howley, Editors, 1996, Lippincott-Raven, Philadelphia, PA; for a description of these and other related viruses), using for example, sequence comparison programs (e.g., BLAST and others described herein) or identification and ahgnment of structural features (e.g., a program such as the "ALB" program described herein that can identify the various regions).
Table A: Regions of the HIV Genome relative to 8_5_TV1_C.ZA
Region Position in nucleotide sequence
5'LTR 1-636
U3 1-457
R 458-553
U5 554-636
NFkB II 340-348
NFkB I 354-362
Spl in 379-388
Spi n 390-398
Spl l 400-410
TATA Box 429-433
TAR 474-499
Poly A signal 529-534
PBS 638-655
p7 binding region, packaging signal 685-791
Gag: 792-2285
P17 792-1178 p24 1179-1871
Cyclophilin A bdg. 1395-1505
MHR 1632-1694 p2 1872-1907
P7 1908-2072
Frameshift slip 2072-2078 pi 2073-2120 p6Gag 2121-2285
Zn-motif I 1950-1991 Zn-motifll 2013-2054
Pol: 2072-5086 ρ6Pol 2072-2245
Prot 2246-2542 p66RT 2543-4210 pl5RNaseH 3857-4210 ρ31Int 4211-5086
Vif: 5034-5612
Hydrophihc region 5292-5315
Vpr: 5552-5839
Oligomerization 5552-5677
Amphipathic a-helix 5597-5653
Tat: 5823-6038 and 8417-8509
Tat-1 exon 5823-6038
Tat-2 exon 8417-8509
N-terminal domain 5823-5885
Trans-activation domain 5886-5933
Transduction domain 5961-5993
Rev: 5962-6037 and 8416-8663
Rev-1 exon 5962-6037
Rev-2 exon 8416-8663 High- affinity bdg. site 8439-8486
Leu-rich effector domain 8562-8588
Vpu: 6060-6326
Transmembrane domain 6060-6161
Cytoplasmic domain 6162-6326
Env (gpl60): 6244-8853
Signal peptide 6244-6324 gρl20 6325-7794
NI 6628-6729
N2 6727-6852
N3 7150-7254
N4 7411-7506
N5 7663-7674
Cl 6325-6627
C2 6853-7149
C3 7255-7410
C4 7507-7662
C5 7675-7794
CD4 binding 7540-7566 gp41 7795-8853
Fusion peptide 7789-7842
Oligomerization domain 7924-7959
Ν-terminal heptad repeat 7921-8028
C-terminal heptad repeat 8173-8280
Immunodominant region 8023-8076
Νef: 8855-9478
Myristoylation 8858-8875
SH3 binding 9062-9091
Polypurine tract 9128-9154
SH3 binding 9296-9307
It will be readily apparent that one of skill in the art can readily align any sequence to that shown in Table A to determine relative locations of any particular HIN gene. For example, using one ofthe ahgnment programs described herein (e.g., BLAST), other HIN genomic sequences can be aligned with 8_5_TN1_C.ZA (Table A) and locations of genes determined. Polypeptide sequences can be similarly aligned. For example, Figures 2A-2C shows the ahgnment of Env polypeptide sequences from various strains, relative to SF-162. As described in detail in co-owned WO/39303, Env polypeptides (e.g., gpl20, gpl40 and gpl60) include a "bridging sheet" comprised of 4 anti-parallel b-strands (b-2, b-3, b-20 and b-21) that form a b-sheet. Extruding from one pair ofthe b-strands (b-2 and b-3) are two loops, NI and N2. The b-2 sheet occurs at approximately amino acid residue 113 (Cys) to amino acid residue 117 (Thr) while b-3 occurs at approximately amino acid residue 192 (Ser) to amino acid residue 194 (Ile), relative to SF-162. The "V1/N2 region" occurs at approximately amino acid positions 120 (Cys) to residue 189 (Cys), relative to SF-162. Extruding from the second pair of b-strands (b-20 and b-21) is a "small-loop" structure, also referred to herein as "the bridging sheet small loop." The locations of both the small loop and bridging sheet small loop can be determined relative to HXB-2 following the teachings herein and in WO/39303. Also shown by arrows in Figure 2A-C are approximate sites for deletions sequence from the beta sheet region. The denotes Ν-glycosylation sites that can be mutated following the teachings of the present specification.
2.2.0 SYNTHETIC EXPRESSION CASSETTES
One aspect of the present invention is the generation of HJN-1 coding sequences, and related sequences, for example having improved expression relative to the corresponding wild-type sequences.
2.2.1 MODIFICATION OF HIV-1 NUCLEIC Aero CODING SEQUENCES
First, the HIN-1 codon usage pattern was modified so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence was comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes. The HIV codon usage reflects a high content of the nucleotides A or T of the codon-triplet. The effect ofthe HIV-1 codon usage is a high AT content in the DΝA sequence that results in a decreased translation ability and instability of the mRΝA. In comparison, highly expressed human codons prefer the nucleotides G or C The HIV coding sequences were modified to be comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes.
Second, there are inhibitory (or instability) elements (INS) located within the coding sequences of, for example, the Gag coding sequences. The RRE is a secondary RNA structure that interacts with the HIV encoded Rev-protein to overcome the expression down-regulating effects of the INS. To overcome the post-transcriptional activating mechanisms of RRE and Rev, the instability elements can be inactivated by introducing multiple point mutations that do not alter the reading frame ofthe encoded proteins.
Third, for some genes the coding sequence has been altered such that the polynucleotide coding sequence encodes a gene product that is inactive or non- functional (e.g., inactivated polymerase, protease, tat, rev, nef, vif, vpr, and/or vpu gene products). Example 1 describes some exemplary mutations. Example 8 presents information concerning functional analysis of mutated Tat, Rev and Nef antigens.
The synthetic coding sequences are assembled by methods known in the art, for example by companies such as the Midland Certified Reagent Company (Midland, Texas).
Modification of the Gag polypeptide coding sequences results in unproved expression relative to the wild-type coding sequences in a number of mammalian cell lines (as well as other types of cell lines, including, but not limited to, insect cells). Some exemplary polynucleotide sequences encoding Gag-containing polypeptides are GagComplPolmut.SF2, GagComplPolmutAtt.SF2,
GagComplPolmutIna.SF2, gagCpoUnaTatRevNef.opt_B, GagPolmutAtt.SF2, GagPolmutIna.SF2, GagProtInaRTmut.SF2, GagProtInaRTmutTatRevNef.opt_B, GagRTmut.SF2, and GagTatRevNef.opt_B.
Similarly, the present invention also includes synthetic Env-encoding polynucleotides and modified Env proteins, for example, gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod, gρl40.modSF162.CwtLnat, gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut7, and gpl60.modSF162.delV2.mut8.
The codon usage pattern for Env was modified as described above for Gag so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence was comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes. Experiments performed in support of the present invention show that the synthetic Env sequences were capable of higher level of protein production relative to the native Env sequences.
Modification ofthe Env polypeptide coding sequences results in improved expression relative to the wild-type coding sequences in a number of mammalian cell lines (as well as other types of cell lines, including, but not limited to, insect cells). Similar Env polypeptide coding sequences can be obtained, modified and tested for improved expression from a variety of isolates, including those described above for Gag.
Further modifications of Env include, but are not limited to, generating polynucleotides that encode Env polypeptides having mutations and/or deletions therein. For instance, the hypervariable regions, VI and or V2, can be deleted as described herein. Additionally, other modifications, for example to the bridging sheet region and or to N-glycosylation sites within Env can also be performed following the teachings of the present specification, (see, Figure2A-C, as well as WO 00/39303, WO 00/39302, WO 00/39304, WO 02/04493). Various combinations of these modifications can be employed to generate synthetic expression cassettes as described herein.
The present invention also includes expression cassettes which include synthetic Pol sequences. As noted above, "Pol" includes, but is not limited to, the protein-encoding regions comprising polymerase, protease, reverse transcriptase and/or integrase-containing sequences (Wan et et al (1996) Biochem. J. 316:569-573; Kohl et al. (1988) PNAS USA 85:4686-4690; Krausslich et al. (1988) J. Virol. 62:4393-4397; Coffin, "Retroviridae and their RepHcation" in Virology, ppl437-1500 (Raven, New York, 1990); Patel et. al. (1995) Biochemistry 34:5351-5363). Thus, the synthetic expression cassettes exemplified herein include one or more of these regions and one or more changes to the resulting amino acid sequences. Some exemplary polynucleotide sequences encoding Pol-derived polypeptides are presented in Table C. The codon usage pattern for Pol was modified as described above for Gag and Env so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence was comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes. Constructs may be modified in various ways. For example, the expression constructs may include a sequence that encodes the first 6 amino acids ofthe integrase polypeptide. This 6 amino acid region is believed to provide a cleavage recognition site recognized by HIV protease (see, e.g., McCornack et al. (1997) FEBS Letts 414:84-88). Constructs may include a multiple cloning site (MCS) for insertion of one or more transgenes, typically at the 3' end of the construct. In addition, a cassette encoding a catalytic center epitope derived from the catalytic center in RT is typically included 3' of the sequence encoding 6 amino acids of integrase. This cassette encodes Ile 178 through Serine 191 of RT and may be added to keep this well conserved region as a possible CTL epitope. Further, the constructs contain an insertion mutations to preserve the reading frame, (see, e.g., Park et al. (1991) J. Virol. 65:5111). In certain embodiments, the catalytic center and/or primer grip region of RT are modified. The catalytic center and primer grip regions of RT are described, for example, in Patel et al. (1995) Biochem. 34:5351 and Palaniappan et al. (1997) J. Biol. Chem. 272(17): 11157. For example, wild type sequence encoding the amino acids YMDD at positions 183-185 of p66 RT, numbered relative to AF110975, may be replaced with sequence encoding the amino acids "AP". Further, the primer grip region (amino acids WMGY, residues 229-232 of p66RT, numbered relative to AFl 10975) may be replaced with sequence encoding the amino acids "PI."
For the Pol sequence, the changes in codon usage are typically restricted to the regions up to the -1 frameshift and starting again at the end ofthe Gag reading frame; however, regions within the frameshift translation region can be modified as well.
Finally, inhibitory (or instability) elements (INS) located within the coding sequences of the protease polypeptide coding sequence can be altered as well.
Experiments can be performed in support of the present invention to show that the synthetic Pol sequences were capable of higher level of protein production relative to the native Pol sequences. Modification of the Pol polypeptide coding sequences results in improved expression relative to the wild-type coding sequences in a number of mammalian cell lines (as well as other types of cell lines, including, but not limited to, insect ceUs). Similar Pol polypeptide coding sequences can be obtained, modified and tested for improved expression from a variety of isolates, including those described above for Gag and Env.
The present invention also includes expression cassettes which include synthetic sequences derived HIV genes other than Gag, Env and Pol, including but not limited to, regions witliin Gag, Env, Pol, as well as, GagComplPolmut.SF2, GagComρlPolmutAtt.SF2, GagComplPolmutIna.SF2, gagCpoUnaTatRevNef.opt_B, GagPolmutAtt.SF2, GagPolmutIna.SF2, GagProtInaRTmut.SF2,
GagProtInaRTmutTatRevNef.opt_B, GagRTmut.SF2, GagTatRevNef.opt_B, „ „ _
gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod, gpl40.modSF162.CwtLnat, gpl60.modSF162.delN2.mut7, gpl60.modSF162.delN2.mut8, int.opt.mut.SF2, int.opt.SF2, nef.D125G.-myr.opt.SF162, nef.D107G.-myrl8.opt.SF162, nef.opt.D125G.SF162, nef.opt.SF162, pl5RnaseH.opt.SF2, p2Pol.opt.YMWM.SF2, p2PoUnaoρt.YM.SF2, ρ2Polopt.SF2, ρ2PolTatRevΝef.opt.native_B, ρ2PolTatRevNef.opt_B, pol.opt.SF2, prot.opt.SF2, protIna.opt.SF2, protInaRT.YM.oρt.SF2, protInaRT.YMWM.oρt.SF2, ProtInaRTmut.SF2, protRT.opt.SF2, ProtRT.TatRevNef.opt_B, ProtRTTatRevNef.op t_B, rev.exonl_2.M5-10.opt.SF162, rev.exonl_2.opt.SF162, RT.opt.SF2 (mutant), RT.oρt.SF2 (native), RTmut.SF2, tat.exonl_2.opt.C22-37.SF2, tat.exonl_2.opt.C37.SF2, TatRevNef.opt.native.SF162, TatRevNef.oρt.SF162, TatRevNefGag B, TatRevNefgagCpoUna B, TatRevNefGagProtlnaRTmut B, TatRevNefp2Pol.opt_B, TatRevNefprotRTopt B, vif.opt.SF2, vpr.opt.SF2, and vpu.opt.SF162. Sequences obtained from other strains can be manipulated in similar fashion foUowing the teachings of the present specification. As noted above, the codon usage pattern is modified as described above for Gag, Env and Pol so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence is comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes. TypicaUy these synthetic sequences are capable of higher level of protein production relative to the native sequences and that modification of the wild-type polypeptide coding sequences results in improved expression relative to the wild-type coding sequences in a number of mammalian cell lines (as well as other types of cell lines, including, but not limited to, insect cells). Furthermore, the nucleic acid sequence can also be modified to introduce mutations into one or more regions of the gene, for instance to alter the function of the gene product (e.g., render the gene product non-functional) and/or to eliminate site modifications (e.g., the myristoylation site in Nef).
Synthetic expression cassettes, derived from HIV Type B coding sequences, exemplified herein include, but are not limited to, those comprising one or more of the foUowing synthetic polynucleotides: GagComplPolmut.SF2, GagComρlPolmutAtt.SF2, GagCompPolmutIna.SF2, gagCpoUnaTatRevNef. oρt_B, GagPolmutAtt.SF2, GagPolmutIna.SF2, GagProtInaRTmut.SF2, GagProtInaRTmutTatRevNef.opt_B, GagRTmut.SF2, GagTatRevNef.opt_B, gpl40.modSF162.CwtLmod, gpl40.modSF162.CwtLnat, gpl60.modSF162.delN2.mut7, gpl60.modSF162.delN2.mut8, int.opt.mut.SF2, int.opt.SF2, nef.D125G.-myr.opt.SF162, nef.D107G.-myrl8.opt.SFl 62, nef.opt.D125G.SF162, nef.opt.SF162, pl5RnaseH.opt.SF2, p2Pol.opt.YMWM.SF2, p2PoHnaoρt.YM.SF2, p2Polopt.SF2, p2PolTatRevΝef.opt.native_B, p2PolTatRevNef.opt_B, pol.opt.SF2, prot.opt.SF2, protIna.opt.SF2, ρrotInaRT.YM.opt.SF2, protInaRT.YMWM.opt.SF2, ProtInaRTmut.SF2, protRT.opt.SF2, ProtRT.TatRevNef.opt_B, ProtRTTatRevNef.oρt_B, rev.exonl_2.M5- 10.opt.SF162, rev.exonl_2.opt.SF162, RT.opt.SF2 (mutant), RT.opt.SF2 (native), RTmut.SF2, tat.exonl_2.oρt.C22-37.SF2, tat.exonl_2.oρt.C37.SF2, TatRevNef.opt.native.SF162, TatRevNef.opt.SF162, TatRevNefGag B, TatRevNefgagCpoUna B, TatRevNefGagProtlnaRTmut B, TatRevNefp2Pol.opt_B, TatRevNefprotRTopt B, vif.opt.SF2, vpr.opt.SF2, and vpu.opt.SF162.
Gag-complete refers to in-frame polyproteins comprising, e.g., Gag and pol, wherein the p6 portion of Gag is present.
Additional sequences that may be employed in some aspects of the present invention have been described in WO 00/39302, WO 00/39303, WO 00/39304, and WO 02/04493.
2.2.2 FURTHER MODIFICATION OF SEQUENCES INCLUDING HIV NUCLEIC ACID CODING SEQUENCES
The HIV polypeptide-encoding expression cassettes described herein may also contain one or more further sequences encoding, for example, one or more transgenes. Further sequences (e.g., transgenes) useful in the practice of the present invention mclude, but are not Umited to, further sequences are those encoding further viral epitopes/antigens {including but not limited to, HCV antigens (e.g., El, E2; Houghton, M.., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,714,596, issued February 3, 1998; Houghton, M.., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,712,088, issued January 27, 1998; Houghton, M.., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,683,864, issued November 4, 1997; Weiner, A.J., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,728,520, issued March 17, 1998; Weiner, A.J., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,766,845, issued June 16, 1998; Weiner, A.J., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,670,152, issued September 23, 1997), HIV antigens (e.g., derived from one or more HIV isolate); and sequences encoding tumor antigens/epitopes. Further sequences may also be derived from non- viral sources, for instance, sequences encoding cytokines such interleukin-2 (IL-2), stem ceU factor (SCF), interleukin 3 (JX-3), interleukin 6 (IL-6), interleukin 12 (IL-12), G-CSF, granulocyte macrophage-colony stimulating factor (GM-CSF), interleukin-1 alpha (IL-II), interleukin- 11 (EL-ll), ME?- II, tumor necrosis factor (TNF), leukemia inhibitory factor (LE?), c-kit hgand, thrombopoietin (TPO) and flt3 hgand, commercially available from several vendors such as, for example, Genzyme (Framingham, MA), Genentech (South San Francisco, CA), Amgen (Thousand Oaks, CA), R&D Systems and Immunex (Seattle, WA). Additional sequences are described below. Also, variations on the orientation of the Gag and other coding sequences, relative to each other, are described below. HIV polypeptide coding sequences can be obtained from other HIV isolates, see, e.g., Myers et al. Los Alamos Database, Los Alamos National Laboratory, Los Alamos, New Mexico (1992); Myers et al., Human Retroviruses and Aids, 1997, Los Alamos, New Mexico: Los Alamos National Laboratory. Synthetic expression cassettes can be generated using such coding sequences as starting material by foUowing the teachings of the present specification.
Further, the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention include related polypeptide sequences having greater than 85%, preferably greater than 90%, more preferably greater than 95%, and most preferably greater than 98% sequence identity to the polypeptides encoded by the synthetic expression cassette sequences disclosed herein.
Exemplary expression cassettes and modifications are set forth in Example 1.
2.2.3 EXPRESSION OF SYNTHETIC SEQUENCES ENCODING HIV-1 POLYPEPTIDES AND RELATED POLYPEPTIDES Synthetic HIV-encoding sequences (expression cassettes) of the present invention can be cloned into a number of different expression vectors to evaluate levels of expression and, in the case of Gag-containing constructs, production of VLPs. The synthetic DNA fragments for HIV polypeptides can be cloned into eucaryotic expression vectors, including, a transient expression vector, CMV-promoter-based mammalian vectors, and a shuttle vector for use in baculovirus expression systems. Corresponding whd-type sequences can also be cloned into the same vectors. These vectors can then be transfected into a several different ceU types, including a variety of mammalian ceU lines (293, RD, COS-7, and CHO, ceU lines avaUable, for example, from the A.T.C.C). The ceU lines are then cultured under appropriate conditions and the levels of any appropriate polypeptide product can be evaluated in supematants. (see, Table A). For example, p24 can be used to evaluate Gag expression; gpl60, gpl40 or gpl20 can be used to evaluate Env expression; p6pol can be used to evaluate Pol expression; prot can be used to evaluate protease; pl5 for RNAseH; p31 for Integrase; and other appropriate polypeptides for Vif, Vpr, Tat, Rev, Vpu and Nef. Further, modified polypeptides can also be used, for example, other Env polypeptides include, but are not limited to, for example, native gpl60, oligomeric gρl40, monomeric gpl20 as weU as modified and/or synthetic sequences of these polypeptides. The results of these assays demonstrate that expression of synthetic HIV polypeptide-encoding sequences are significantly higher than corresponding wild-type sequences. Further, Western Blot analysis can be used to show that ceUs containing the synthetic expression cassette produce the expected protein at higher per-ceU concentrations than ceUs containing the native expression cassette. The HIV proteins can be seen in both ceU lysates and supematants. The levels of production are significantly higher in ceU supematants for ceUs transfected with the synthetic expression cassettes ofthe present invention.
Fractionation of the supematants from mammalian ceUs transfected with the synthetic expression cassette can be used to show that the cassettes provide superior production of HIV proteins and, in the case of Gag, VLPs, relative to the wUd-type sequences. Efficient expression of these HIV-containing polypeptides in mammalian ceU lines provides the foUowing benefits: the polypeptides are free of baculovirus contaminants; production by estabhshed methods approved by the FDA; increased purity; greater yields (relative to native coding sequences); and a novel method of producing the Sub HIV-containing polypeptides in CHO ceUs which is not feasible in the absence of the increased expression obtained using the constructs of the present invention. Exemplary Mammahan ceU lines include, but are not limited to, BHK, VERO, HT1080, 293, 293T, RD, COS-7, CHO, Jurkat, HUT, SUPT, C8166, MOLT4/clone8, MT-2, MT-4, H9, PM1, CEM, and CEMX174 (such ceU lines are available, for example, from the A.T.C.C).
A synthetic Gag expression cassette of the present invention will also exhibit high levels of expression and VLP production when transfected into insect ceUs. Synthetic expression cassettes described herein also demonstrate high levels of expression in insect ceUs. Further, in addition to a higher total protein yield, the final product from the synthetic polypeptides consistently contains lower amounts of contaminating baculovirus proteins than the final product from the native sequences. Further, synthetic expression cassettes ofthe present invention can also be introduced into yeast vectors which, in turn, can be transformed into and efficiently expressed by yeast ceUs (Saccharomyces cerevisea; using vectors as described in Rosenberg, S. and Tekamp-Olson, P., U.S. Patent No. RE35,749, issued, March 17, 1998). In addition to the mammahan and insect vectors, the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can be incorporated into a variety of expression vectors using selected expression control elements. Appropriate vectors and control elements for any given ceU an be selected by one having ordinary skiU in the art in view of the teachings of the present specification and information known in the art about expression vectors.
For example, a synthetic expression cassette can be inserted into a vector which includes control elements operably linked to the desired coding sequence, which aUow for the expression of the gene in a selected ceU-type. For example, typical promoters for mammahan ceU expression include the S V40 early promoter, a CMV promoter such as the CMN immediate early promoter (a CMV promoter can include intron A), RSV, HIV-Ltr, the mouse mammary tumor virus LTR promoter (MMLN- ltr), the adenovirus major late promoter (Ad MLP), and the herpes simplex virus promoter, among others. Other nonviral promoters, such as a promoter derived from the murine metaUothionein gene, wiU also find use for mammahan expression. TypicaUy, transcription termination and polyadenylation sequences wiU also be present, located 3' to the translation stop codon. Preferably, a sequence for optimization of initiation of translation, located 5' to the coding sequence, is also present. Examples of transcription terminator/polyadenylation signals include those derived from SN40, as described in Sambrook, et al., supra, as weU as a bovine growth hormone terminator sequence. Introns, containing splice donor and acceptor sites, may also be designed into the constructs for use with the present invention (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986).
Enhancer elements may also be used herein to increase expression levels of the mammahan constructs. Examples include the SN40 early gene enhancer, as described in Dijkema et al., EMBO J. (1985) 4:761, the enhancer/promoter derived from the long terminal repeat (LTR) of the Rous Sarcoma Nirus, as described in Gorman et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1982b) 79:6777 and elements derived from human CMN, as described in Boshart et al., Cell (1985) 41:521, such as elements included in the CMN intron A sequence (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986).
The desired synthetic polypeptide encoding sequences can be cloned into any number of commerciaUy avahable vectors to generate expression of the polypeptide in an appropriate host system. These systems include, but are not limited to, the foUowing: baculovirus expression {ReiUy, P.R., et al, BACULOVIRUS EXPRESSION VECTORS: A LABORATORY MANUAL (1992); Beames, et al., Biotechniques _1:378 (1991); Pharmingen; Clontech, Palo Alto, CA)}, vaccinia expression {Earl, P. L., et al. , "Expression of proteins in mammahan ceUs using vaccinia" In Current Protocols in Molecular Biology (F. M. Ausubel, et al. Eds.), Greene Publishing Associates & WUey Interscience, New York (1991); Moss, B., et al, U.S. Patent Number 5,135,855, issued 4 August 1992}, expression in bacteria {Ausubel, F.M., et ah, CURRENT PROTOCOLS IN MOLECULAR BIOLOGY. John Whey and Sons, Inc., Media PA; Clontech}, expression in yeast {Rosenberg, S. and Tekamp-Olson, P., U.S. Patent No. RE35,749, issued, March 17, 1998; Shuster, J.R., U.S. Patent No. 5,629,203, issued May 13, 1997; GeUissen, G, et al, Antonie Van Leeuwenhoek, 62(l-2):79-93 (1992); Romanos, M.A., et al, Yeast 8(6) :423-488 (1992); Goeddel, D.V., Methods in Enzymology 185 (1990); Guthrie, C, and G.R. Fink, Methods in Enzymology 19 (1991)}, expression in mammahan cells {Clontech; Gibco-BRL, Ground Island, NY; e.g., Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) ceU lines (Haynes, J., et al, Nuc. Acid. Res. 11:687-706 (1983); 1983, Lau, Y.F., et al, Mol. Cell Biol. 4:1469-1475 (1984); Kaufman, R. J., "Selection and coamplification of heterologous genes in mammahan ceUs," in Methods in Enzymology, vol. 185, pp537-566. Academic Press, Inc., San Diego CA (1991)}, and expression in plant ceUs {plant cloning vectors, Clontech Laboratories, Inc., Palo Alto, CA, and Pharmacia LKB Biotechnology, Inc.,
Pistcataway, NJ; Hood, E., et al, I. Bacteriol. 168:1291-1301 (1986); Nagel, R., et al, FEMS Microbiol Lett. 67:325 (1990); An, et al, "Binary Vectors", and others in Plant Molecular Biology Manual A3: 1-19 (1988); Miki, B.L.A., et al, pp.249-265, and others in Plant DNA Infectious Agents (Hohn, T., et al, eds.) Springer- Verlag, Wien, Austria, (1987); Plant Molecular Biology: Essential Techniques, P.G. Jones and J.M. Sutton, New York, J. Wiley, 1997; Miglani, Gurbachan Dictionary of Plant Genetics and Molecular Biology, New York, Food Products Press, 1998; Henry, R. J., Practical Applications of Plant Molecular Biology, New York, Chapman & HaU, 1997}. Also included in the invention is an expression vector, containing coding sequences and expression control elements which aUow expression of the coding regions in a suitable host. The control elements generaUy include a promoter, translation initiation codon, and translation and transcription termination sequences, and an insertion site for introducing the insert into the vector. Translational control elements have been reviewed by M. Kozak (e.g., Kozak, M., Mamm. Genome
7(8):563-574, 1996; Kozak, M., Biochimie 76(9):815-821, 1994; Kozak, M., J Cell Biol 108(2):229-241, 1989; Kozak, M., and Shatkin, A.J., Methods Enzymol 60:360-375, 1979).
Expression in yeast systems has the advantage of commercial production. Recombinant protein production by vaccinia and CHO ceU line have the advantage of being mammahan expression systems. Further, vaccinia virus expression has several advantages including the foUowing: (i) its wide host range; (ii) faithful post- transcriptional modification, processing, folding, transport, secretion, and assembly of recombinant proteins; (iii) high level expression of relatively soluble recombinant proteins; and (iv) a large capacity to accommodate foreign DNA. The recombinantly expressed polypeptides from synthetic HIV polypeptide- encoding expression cassettes are typicaUy isolated from lysed ceUs or culture media. Purification can be carried out by methods known in the art including salt fractionation, ion exchange chromatography, gel filtration, size-exclusion chromatography, size-fractionation, and affinity chromatography. Immunoaffinity chromatography can be employed using antibodies generated based on, for example, HIN antigens.
Advantages of expressing the proteins of the present invention using mammahan ceUs include, but are not limited to, the foUowing: weU-estabhshed protocols for scale-up production; the ability to produce VLPs; ceU lines are suitable to meet good manufacturing process (GMP) standards; culture conditions for mammahan ceUs are known in the art.
Synthetic HIV 1 polynucleotides are described herein, see, for example, the figures. Various forms of the different embodiments of the invention, described herein, may be combined. Exemplary expression assays are set forth in Example 2. Exemplary conditions for Western Blot analysis are presented in Example 3.
2.3.0 PRODUCTION OF VIRUS-LIKE PARTICLES AND USE OF THE
CONSTRUCTS OF THE PRESENT INVENTION TO CREATE PACKAGING CELL LINES.
The group-specific antigens (Gag) of human immunodeficiency virus type-1 (HIV-1) setf-assemble into noninfectious virus-like particles (VLP) that are released from various eucaryotic cells by budding (reviewed by Freed, E.O., Virology 251:1-15, 1998). The Gag-containing synthetic expression cassettes ofthe present invention provide for the production of HIV-Gag virus-like particles (VLPs) using a variety of different ceU types, including, but not limited to, mammahan ceUs. Viral particles can be used as a matrix for the proper presentation of an antigen entrapped or associated therewith to the immune system of the host.
2.3.1 VLP PRODUCTION USING THE SYNTHETIC EXPRESSION CASSETTES OF THE PRESENT INVENTION
The Gag-containing synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention may provide superior production of both Gag proteins and VLPs, relative to native Gag coding sequences. Further, electron microscopic evaluation of VLP production can be used to show that free and budding immature virus particles of the expected size are produced by ceUs containing the synthetic expression cassettes.
Using the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention, rather than native Gag coding sequences, for the production of virus-like particles provide several advantages. First, VLPs can be produced in enhanced quantity making isolation and purification of the VLPs easier. Second, VLPs can be produced in a variety of ceU types using the synthetic expression cassettes, in particular, mammahan ceU lines can be used for VLP production, for example, CHO ceUs. Production using CHO ceUs provides (i) VLP formation; (ii) correct myristoylation and budding; (hi) absence of non-MacmiUian ceU contaminants (e.g., insect viruses and/or ceUs); and (iv) ease of purification. The synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention are also useful for enhanced expression in ceU-types other than mammahan ceU lines. For example, infection of insect ceUs with baculovirus vectors encoding the synthetic expression cassettes results in higher levels of total Gag protein yield and higher levels of VLP production (relative to wUd-coding sequences). Further, the final product from insect ceUs infected with the baculo virus-Gag synthetic expression cassettes consistently contains lower amounts of contaminating insect proteins than the final product when wUd-coding sequences are used.
VLPs can spontaneously form when the particle-forming polypeptide of interest is recombinantly expressed in an appropriate host ceU. Thus, the VLPs produced using the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention are conveniently prepared using recombinant techniques. As discussed below, the Gag polypeptide encoding synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can include other polypeptide coding sequences of interest (for example, HIV protease, HIV polymerase, Env; synthetic Env). Expression of such synthetic expression cassettes yields VLPs comprising the Gag polypeptide, as weU as, the polypeptide of interest.
Once coding sequences for the desired particle-forming polypeptides have been isolated or synthesized, they can be cloned into any suitable vector or replicon for expression. Numerous cloning vectors are known to those of sk l in the art, and the selection of an appropriate cloning vector is a matter of choice. See, generaUy, Sambrook et al, supra. The vector is then used to transform an appropriate host ceU. Suitable recombinant expression systems include, but are not limited to, bacterial, mammahan, baculo virus/insect, vaccinia, Semliki Forest virus (SFV), Alphaviruses (such as, Sindbis, Venezuelan Equine Encephahtis (VEE)), mammahan, yeast and Xenopus expression systems, weU known in the art. Particularly preferred expression systems are mammahan ceU lines, vaccinia, Sindbis, eucaryotic layered vector initiation systems (e.g., US Patent No. 6,015,686, US Patent No. 5, 814,482, US Patent No. 6,015,694, US Patent No. 5,789,245, EP 1029068A2, WO 9918226A2/A3, EP 00907746A2, WO 9738087 A2), insect and yeast systems.
The synthetic DNA fragments for the expression cassettes of the present invention, e.g., Pol, Gag, Env, Tat, Rev, Nef, Vif, Vpr, and/or Vpu, may be cloned into the foUowing eucaryotic expression vectors: pCMVKm2, for transient expression assays and DNA immunization studies, the pCMNKnώ vector is derived from pCMV6a (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986) and comprises a kanamycin selectable marker, a ColEl origin of rephcation, a CMV promoter enhancer and Intron A, foUowed by an insertion site for the synthetic sequences described below foUowed by a polyadenylation signal derived from bovine growth hormone ~ the pCMVKm2 vector differs from the pCMV-link vector only in that a polylinker site is inserted into pCMVKπώ to generate pCMV-link; pESΝ2dhfr and pCMVPLEdhfr, for expression in Chinese Hamster Ovary (CHO) ceUs; and, pAcC13, a shuttle vector for use in the Baculovirus expression system (pAcC13, is derived from pAcC12 which is described by Munemitsu S., et al., Mol Cell Biol. 10(ll):5977-5982, 1990). Briefly, construction of pCMNPLEdhfr was as foUows. To construct a DHFR cassette, the EMCN IRES (internal ribosome entry site) leader was PCR-amplified from pCite-4a+ (Νovagen, Inc., MUwaukee, WI) and inserted into pET-23d (Νovagen, Inc., MUwaukee, WI) as Xba-Nco fragment to give pET-EMCV. The dhfr gene was PCR-amplified from pESΝ2dhfr to give a product with a Gly-Gly-Gly-Ser spacer in place of the translation stop codon and inserted as an Nco-Bamϊil fragment to give pET-E-DHFR. Next, the attenuated neo gene was PCR amplified from a pSN2Neo (Clontech, Palo Alto, CA) derivative and inserted into the unique BamϊTl site of pET-E-DHFR to give pET-E-DHFR/Neo(m2). FinaUy the bovine growth hormone terminator from pCDNA3 (Invitrogen, Inc., Carlsbad, CA) was inserted downstream of the neo gene to give pET-E- DHFR/Neo(m2)BGHt. The EMCV-dhfr/neo selectable marker cassette fragment was prepared by cleavage of pET-E-DHFR/Neo(m2)BGHt.
In one vector construct the CMN enhancer/promoter plus Intron A was transferred from pCMV6a (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986) as a HzVιdIII-Sα/1 fragment into pUC19 (New England Biolabs, Inc., Beverly, MA). The vector backbone of pUC19 was deleted from the Ndel to the Sapl sites. The above described DΗFR cassette was added to the construct such that the EMCN IRES foUowed the CMN promoter. The vector also contained an ampr gene and an SN40 origin of rephcation.
A number of mammahan ceU lines are known in the art and include immortalized ceU lines avaUable from the American Type Culture CoUection (AT. CC), such as, but not limited to, Chinese hamster ovary (CΗO) ceUs, ΗeLa ceUs, baby hamster kidney (BΗK) ceUs, monkey kidney ceUs (COS), as weU as others. SimUarly, bacterial hosts such as E. coli, Bacillus subtilis, and Streptococcus spp. , wUl find use with the present expression constructs. Yeast hosts useful in the present invention include inter alia, Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Candida albicans, Candida maltosa, Hansenula polymorpha, Kluyveromyces fragilis, Kluyveromyces lactis, Pichia guillerimondii, Pichia pastoris, Schizosaccharomyces pombe and Yarrowia lipolytica. Insect ceUs for use with baculovirus expression vectors include, inter alia, Aedes aegypti, Autographa californica, Bombyx mori, Drosophila melanogaster, Spodoptera frugiperda, and Trichoplusia ni. See, e.g., Summers and Smith, Texas Agricultural Experiment Station Bulletin No. 555 (1987).
Viral vectors can be used for the production of particles in eucaryotic ceUs, such as those derived from the pox famUy of viruses, including vaccinia virus and avian poxvirus. AdditionaUy, a vaccinia based infection/transfection system, as described in Tomei et al., J. Virol. (1993) 67:4017-4026 and Selby et al., J. Gen. Virol. (1993) 74: 1103 -1113, wiU also find use with the present invention. In this system, ceUs are first infected in vitro with a vaccinia vims recombinant that encodes the bacteriophage T7 RNA polymerase. This polymerase displays exquisite specificity in that it only transcribes templates bearing T7 promoters. FoUowing infection, ceUs are transfected with the DNA of interest, driven by a T7 promoter. The polymerase expressed in the cytoplasm from the vaccinia virus recombinant transcribes the transfected DNA into RNA which is then translated into protein by the host translational machinery. Alternately, T7 can be added as a purified protein or enzyme as in the "Progenitor" system (Studier and Moffatt, . Mol. Biol. (1986) _89: 113-130). The method provides for high level, transient, cytoplasmic production of large quantities of RNA and its translation product(s).
Depending on the expression system and host selected, the VLPS are produced by growing host ceUs transformed by an expression vector under conditions whereby the particle-forming polypeptide is expressed and VLPs can be formed. The selection of the appropriate growth conditions is within the skUl of the art. If the VLPs are formed intraceUularly, the cells are then disrupted, using chemical, physical or mechanical means, which lyse the ceUs yet keep the VLPs substantiaUy intact. Such methods are known to those of skUl in the art and are described in, e.g., Protein Purification Applications: A Practical Approach, (E.L.V. Harris and S. Angal, Eds., 1990).
The particles are then isolated (or substantiaUy purified) using methods that preserve the integrity thereof, such as, by gradient centrifugation, e.g., cesium chloride (CsCl) sucrose gradients, pelleting and the like (see, e.g., Kirnbauer et al. /. Virol. (1993) 67:6929-6936), as weU as standard purification techniques including, e.g., ion exchange and gel filtration chromatography. VLPs produced by ceUs containing the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can be used to ehcit an immune response when administered to a subject. One advantage of the present invention is that VLPs can be produced by mammahan ceUs carrying the synthetic expression cassettes at levels previously not possible. As discussed above, the VLPs can comprise a variety of antigens in addition to the Gag polypeptide (e.g., Gag-protease, Gag-polymerase, Env, synthetic Env, etc.). Purified VLPs, produced using the synthetic expression cassettes ofthe present invention, can be administered to a vertebrate subject, usuaUy in the form of vaccine compositions. Combination vaccines may also be used, where such vaccines contain, for example, an adjuvant subunit protein (e.g., Env). Administration can take place using the VLPs formulated alone or formulated with other antigens. Further, the VLPs can be administered prior to, concurrent with, or subsequent to, dehvery of the synthetic expression cassettes for DNA immunization (see below) and/or dehvery of other vaccines. Also, the site of VLP administration may be the same or different as other vaccine compositions that are being administered. Gene dehvery can be accomphshed by a number of methods including, but are not limited to, immunization with DNA, alphavirus vectors, pox virus vectors, and vaccinia virus vectors.
VLP immune-stimulating (or vaccine) compositions can include various excipients, adjuvants, carriers, auxiliary substances, modulating agents, and the like. The immune stimulating compositions will include an amount of the VLP/antigen sufficient to mount an immunological response. An appropriate effective amount can be determined by one of skiU in the art. Such an amount wiU faU in a relatively broad range that can be determined through routine trials and will generaUy be an amount on the order of about 0.1 μg to about 1000 μg, more preferably about 1 μg to about 300 μg, of VLP/antigen.
A carrier is optionaUy present which is a molecule that does not itseU induce the production of antibodies harmful to the individual receiving the composition. Suitable carriers are typically large, slowly metabolized macromolecules such as proteins, polysaccharides, polylactic acids, polyglycoUic acids, polymeric amino acids, amino acid copolymers, hpid aggregates (such as oU droplets or hposomes), and inactive virus particles. Examples of particulate carriers include those derived from polymethyl methacrylate polymers, as weU as microparticles derived from poly(lactides) and poly(lactide-co-glycohdes), known as PLG. See, e.g., Jeffery et al., Pharm. Res. (1993) 10:362-368; McGee JP, et al., J Microencapsul 14(2): 197-210, 1997; O'Hagan DT, et al., Vaccine 11(2): 149-54, 1993. Such carriers are weU known to those of ordinary skiU in the art. AdditionaUy, these carriers may function as immunostimulating agents ("adjuvants"). Furthermore, the antigen may be conjugated to a bacterial toxoid, such as toxoid from diphtheria, tetanus, cholera, etc., as weU as toxins derived from E. coli.
Adjuvants may also be used to enhance the effectiveness ofthe compositions. Such adjuvants include, but are not limited to: (1) aluminum salts (alum), such as aluminum hydroxide, aluminum phosphate, aluminum suffate, etc.; (2) oU-in- water emulsion formulations (with or without other specific immunostimulating agents such as muramyl peptides (see below) or bacterial ceU waU components), such as for example (a) MF59 (International Pubhcation No. WO 90/14837), containing 5% Squalene, 0.5% Tween 80, and 0.5% Span 85 (optionaUy containing various amounts of MTP-PΕ (see below), although not required) formulated into submicron particles using a microfluidizer such as Model HOY microfluidizer (Microfluidics, Newton, MA), (b) SAF, containing 10% Squalane, 0.4% Tween 80, 5% pluronic-blocked polymer L121, and thr-MDP (see below) either microfluidized into a submicron emulsion or vortexed to generate a larger particle size emulsion, and (c) Ribi™ adjuvant system (RAS), (Ribi Immunochem, HamUton, MT) containing 2% Squalene, 0.2% Tween 80, and one or more bacterial ceU waU components from the group consisting of monophosphoryhpid A (MPL), trehalose dimycolate (TDM), and ceU waU skeleton (CWS), preferably MPL + CWS (Detox™); (3) saponin adjuvants, such as Stimulon™ (Cambridge Bioscience, Worcester, MA) may be used or particle generated therefrom such as ISCOMs (immunostimulating complexes); (4) Complete Freunds Adjuvant (CFA) and Incomplete Freunds Adjuvant (ΕFA); (5) cytokines, such as interleukins (IL-1, B0-2, etc.), macrophage colony stimulating factor (M-CSF), tumor necrosis factor (TNF), etc.; (6) ohgonucleotides or polymeric molecules encoding immunostimulatory CpG motifs (Davis, H.L., et al., J. Immunology 160:870- 876, 1998; Sato, Y. et al., Science 273:352-354, 1996) or complexes of antigens/ohgonucleotides {Polymeric molecules include double and single stranded RNA and DNA, and backbone modifications thereof, for example, methylphosphonate linkages; or (7) detoxified mutants of a bacterial ADP-ribosylating toxin such as a cholera toxin (CT), a pertussis toxin (PT), or an E. coli heat-labUe toxin (LT), particularly LT-K63 (where lysine is substituted for the wUd-type amino acid at position 63) LT-R72 (where arginine is substituted for the wUd-type amino acid at position 72), CT-S109 (where serine is substituted for the wUd-type amino acid at position 109), and PT-K9/G129 (where lysine is substituted for the wUd-type amino acid at position 9 and glycine substituted at position 129) (see, e.g., International Pubhcation Nos. W093/13202 and W092/19265); and (8) other substances that act as immunostimulating agents to enhance the effectiveness of the composition. Further, such polymeric molecules include alternative polymer backbone structures such as, but not limited to, polyvinyl backbones (Pitha, Biochem Biophys Acta, 204:39. 1970a; Pitha, Biopolymers, 9:965, 1970b), and morpholino backbones (Summerton, J., et al, U.S. Patent No. 5,142,047, issued 08/25/92; Summerton, J., et al, U.S. Patent No.
5, 185,444 issued 02/09/93). A variety of other charged and uncharged polynucleotide analogs have been reported. Numerous backbone modifications are known in the art, including, but not limited to, uncharged linkages (e.g., methyl phosphonates, phosphotriesters, phosphoamidates, and carbamates) and charged linkages (e.g., phosphorothioates and phosphorodithioates).}; and (7) other substances that act as immunostimulating agents to enhance the effectiveness of the VLP immune-stimulating (or vaccine) composition. Alum, CpG ohgonucleo tides, and MF59 are preferred.
Muramyl peptides include, but are not limited to, N-acetyl-muramyl-L- threonyl-D-isoglutamine (thr-MDP) , N-acteyl-normuramyl-L-alanyl-D-isogluatme (nor-MDP) , N-acetyιmuramyl-L-alanyl-D-isogluatmmyl-L-alanme-2-(r-2'-dipalmitoyl- ->n-glycero-3-huydroxyphosphoryloxy)-ethylamine (MTP-PΕ), etc.
Dosage treatment with the VLP composition may be a single dose schedule or a multiple dose schedule. A multiple dose schedule is one in which a primary course of vaccination may be with 1-10 separate doses, foUowed by other doses given at subsequent time intervals, chosen to maintain and/or reinforce the immune response, for example at 1-4 months for a second dose, and if needed, a subsequent dose(s) after several months. The dosage regimen wiU also, at least in part, be determined by the need of the subject and be dependent on the judgment of the practitioner.
If prevention of disease is desired, the antigen carrying VLPs are generaUy administered prior to primary infection with the pathogen of interest. If treatment is desired, e.g., the reduction of symptoms or recurrences, the VLP compositions are generaUy administered subsequent to primary infection.
2.3.2 USING THE SYNTHETIC EXPRESSION CASSETTES OF THE PRESENT INVENTION TO CREATE PACKAGING CELL LINES A number of viral based systems have been developed for use as gene transfer vectors for mammahan host ceUs. For example, retroviruses (in particular, lentiviral vectors) provide a convenient platform for gene dehvery systems. A coding sequence of interest (for example, a sequence useful for gene therapy applications) can be inserted into a gene dehvery vector and packaged in retroviral particles using techniques known in the art. Recombinant virus can then be isolated and dehvered to ceUs ofthe subject either in vivo or ex vivo. A number of retroviral systems have been described, including, for example, the foUowing: (U.S. Patent No. 5,219,740; Miller et al. (1989) BioTechniques 7:980; MiUer, A.D. (1990) Human Gene Therapy 1:5; Scarpa et al. (1991) Virology _80:849; Burns et al. (1993) Proc. Natl Acad. Sci. USA 90:8033; Boris-Lawrie et al. (1993) Cur. Opin. Genet. Develop. 3:102; GB 2200651; EP 0415731; EP 0345242; WO 89/02468; WO 89/05349; WO 89/09271; WO 90/02806; WO 90/07936; WO 90/07936; WO 94/03622; WO 93/25698; WO 93/25234; WO 93/11230; WO 93/10218; WO 91/02805; in U.S. 5,219,740; U.S. 4,405,712; U.S. 4,861,719; U.S. 4,980,289 and U.S. 4,777,127; in U.S. Serial No. 07/800,921; and in VUe (1993) Cancer Res 53:3860-3864; VUe (1993) Cancer Res 53:962-967; Ram (1993) Cancer Res 53:83-88; Takamiya (1992) J Neurosci Res 33:493-503; Baba (1993) INeurosurg 79:729-735; Mann (1983) Cell 33:153; Cane (1984) Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 8_;6349; and MiUer (1990) Human Gene Therapy 1. In other embodiments, gene transfer vectors can be constructed to encode a cytokine or other immunomodulatory molecule. For example, nucleic acid sequences encoding native IL-2 and gamma-interferon can be obtained as described in US Patent Nos. 4,738,927 and 5,326,859, respectively, whUe useful muteins of these proteins can be obtained as described in U.S. Patent No. 4,853,332. Nucleic acid sequences encoding the short and long forms of mCSF can be obtained as described in US Patent Nos. 4,847,201 and 4,879,227, respectively. In particular aspects ofthe invention, retroviral vectors expressing cytokine or immunomodulatory genes can be produced as described herein (for example, employing the packaging ceU lines of the present invention) and in International Apphcation No. PCT US 94/02951, entitled "Compositions and Methods for Cancer Immunotherapy."
Examples of suitable immunomodulatory molecules for use herein include the foUowing: EL-1 and IL-2 (Karupiah et al. (1990) J. Immunology 144:290-298, Weber et al. (1987) J. Exp. Med. 166:1716-1733, Gansbacher et al. (1990) J. Exp. Med. 172:1217-1224, and U.S. Patent No. 4,738,927); IL-3 and IL-4 (Tepper et al. (1989) Cell 57:503-512, Golumbek et al. (1991) Science 254:713-716, and U.S. Patent No. 5,017,691); EL-5 and EL-6 (Brakenhof et al. (1987) J. Immunol. 139:4116-4121, and International Pubhcation No. WO 90/06370); IL-7 (U.S. Patent No. 4,965,195); IL-8, IL-9, IL-10, IL-11, TL-12, and IL-13 (Cytokine Bulletin, Summer 1994); IL-14 and IL-15; alpha interferon (Finter et al. (1991) Drugs 42:749-765, U.S. Patent Nos. 4,892,743 and 4,966,843, International Pubhcation No. WO 85/02862, Nagata et al. (1980) Nature 284:316-320, FamiUetti et al. (1981) Methods in Enz. 78:387-394, Twu et al. (1989) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 86:2046-2050, and Faktor et al. (1990) Oncogene 5:867-872); beta-interferon (Seif et al. (1991) J. Virol. 65:664-671); gamma-interferons (Radford et al. (1991) The American Society of Hepatology 20082015, Watanabe et al. (1989) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 86:9456-9460, Gansbacher et al. (1990) Cancer Research 50:7820-7825, Maio et al. (1989) Can. Immunol Immunother. 30:34-42, and U.S. Patent Nos. 4,762,791 and 4,727,138); G- CSF (U.S. Patent Nos. 4,999,291 and 4,810,643); GM-CSF (International Pubhcation No. WO 85/04188).
Immunomodulatory factors may also be agonists, antagonists, or hgands for these molecules. For example, soluble forms of receptors can often behave as antagonists for these types of factors, as can mutated forms of the factors themselves. Nucleic acid molecules that encode the above-described substances, as weU as other nucleic acid molecules that are advantageous for use within the present invention, may be readUy obtained from a variety of sources, including, for example, depositories such as the American Type Culture CoUection, or from commercial sources such as British Bio-Technology Limited (Cowley, Oxford England).
Representative examples include BBG 12 (containing the GM-CSF gene coding for the mature protein of 127 amino acids), BBG 6 (which contains sequences encoding gamma interferon), A.T.C.C Deposit No. 39656 (which contains sequences encoding TNF), A.T.C.C. Deposit No. 20663 (which contains sequences encoding alpha- interferon), A.T.C.C Deposit Nos. 31902, 31902 and 39517 (which contain sequences encoding beta-interferon), A.T.C.C. Deposit No. 67024 (which contains a sequence which encodes Interleukin- lb), A.T.C.C Deposit Nos. 39405, 39452, 39516, 39626 and 39673 (which contain sequences encoding Interleukin-2), A.T.C.C Deposit Nos. 59399, 59398, and 67326 (which contain sequences encoding Interleukin-3), A.T.C.C Deposit No. 57592 (which contains sequences encoding Interleukin-4), A.T.C.C
Deposit Nos. 59394 and 59395 (which contain sequences encoding Interleukin-5), and A.T.C.C Deposit No. 67153 (which contains sequences encoding Interleukin-6).
Plasmids containing cytokine genes or immunomodulatory genes (International Pubhcation Nos. WO 94/02951 and WO 96/21015) can be digested with appropriate restriction enzymes, and DNA fragments containing the particular gene of interest can be inserted into a gene transfer vector using standard molecular biology techniques. (See, e.g., Sambrook et al., supra., or Ausubel et al. (eds) Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, Greene Pubhshing and WUey-Interscience).
Polynucleotide sequences coding for the above-described molecules can be obtained using recombinant methods, such as by screening cDNA and genomic libraries from ceUs expressing the gene, or by deriving the gene from a vector known to include the same. For example, plasmids which contain sequences that encode altered ceUular products may be obtained from a depository such as the A.T.C.C, or from commercial sources. Plasmids containing the nucleotide sequences of interest can be digested with appropriate restriction enzymes, and DNA fragments containing the nucleotide sequences can be inserted into a gene transfer vector using standard molecular biology techniques.
Alternatively, cDNA sequences for use with the present invention may be obtained from cells which express or contain the sequences, using standard techniques, such as phenol extraction and PCR of cDNA or genomic DNA. See, e.g., Sambrook et al., supra, for a description of techniques used to obtain and isolate DNA. Briefly, mRNA from a ceU which expresses the gene of interest can be reverse transcribed with reverse transcriptase using oligo-dT or random primers. The single stranded cDNA may then be amplified by PCR (see U.S. Patent Nos. 4,683,202, 4,683,195 and 4,800,159, see also PCR Technology: Principles and Applications for DNA
Amplification, Erlich (ed.), Stockton Press, 1989)) using oligonucleotide primers complementary to sequences on either side of desired sequences.
The nucleotide sequence of interest can also be produced syntheticaUy, rather than cloned, using a DNA synthesizer (e.g., an Applied Biosystems Model 392 DNA Synthesizer, available from ABI, Foster City, CaUfornia). The nucleotide sequence can be designed with the appropriate codons for the expression product desired. The complete sequence is assembled from overlapping oligonucleotides prepared by standard methods and assembled into a complete coding sequence. See, e.g., Edge (1981) Nature 292:756; Nambair et al. (1984) Science 223:1299; Jay et al. (1984) J. Biol. Chem. 259:6311.
The synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can be employed in the construction of packaging ceU lines for use with retroviral vectors.
One type of retrovirus, the murine leukemia virus, or "MLV", has been widely utilized for gene therapy applications (see generaUy Mann et al. (Cell 33:153, 1993), Cane and MuUigan (Proc, Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 81:6349, 1984), and MiUer et al., Human Gene Therapy 1:5-14,1990.
Lentiviral vectors typicaUy, comprise a 5' lentiviral LTR, a tRNA binding site, a packaging signal, a promoter operably linked to one or more genes of interest, an origin of second strand DNA synthesis and a 3' lentiviral LTR, wherein the lentiviral vector contains a nuclear transport element. The nuclear transport element may be located either upstream (5') or downstream (3') of a coding sequence of interest (for example, a synthetic Gag or Env expression cassette ofthe present invention). Within certain embodiments, the nuclear transport element is not RRE. Within one embodiment the packaging signal is an extended packaging signal. Within other embodiments the promoter is a tissue specific promoter, or, alternatively, a promoter such as CMN. Within other embodiments, the lentiviral vector further comprises an internal ribosome entry site.
A wide variety of lentiviruses may be utilized within the context of the present invention, including for example, lentiviruses selected from the group consisting of HIN, HIV-1, HIV-2, HV and SIV. Within yet another aspect of the invention, host ceUs (e.g., packaging ceU lines) are provided which contain any of the expression cassettes described herein. For example, within one aspect packaging ceU line are provided comprising an expression cassette that comprises a sequence encoding synthetic Gag-polymerase, and a nuclear transport element, wherein the promoter is operably linked to the sequence encoding Gag-polymerase. Packaging cell lines may further comprise a promoter and a sequence encoding tat, rev, or an envelope, wherein the promoter is operably linked to the sequence encoding tat, rev, Env or sequences encoding modified versions of these proteins. The packaging ceU line may further comprise a sequence encoding any one or more of other HIV gene encoding sequences. In one embodiment, the expression cassette (carrying, for example, the synthetic Gag-polymerase) is stably integrated. The packaging ceU line, upon introduction of a lentiviral vector, typicaUy produces particles. The promoter regulating expression ofthe synthetic expression cassette may be inducible. TypicaUy, the packaging ceU line, upon introduction of a lentiviral vector, produces particles that are essentiaUy free of replication competent virus.
Packaging ceU hnes are provided comprising an expression cassette which directs the expression of a synthetic Gag-polymerase gene or comprising an expression cassette which directs the expression of a synthetic Env genes described herein. (See, also, Andre, S., et al, Journal of Virology 72(2): 1497-1503, 1998; Haas, J., et al, Current Biology 6(3):315-324, 1996) for a description of other modified Env sequences). A lentiviral vector is introduced into the packaging ceU line to produce a vector producing ceU line.
As noted above, lentiviral vectors can be designed to carry or express a selected gene(s) or sequences of interest. Lentiviral vectors may be readily constructed from a wide variety of lentiviruses (see RNA Tumor Viruses, Second Edition, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1985). Representative examples of lentiviruses included HIV, HIV-1, HIV-2, FIN and SIN. Such lentiviruses may either be obtained from patient isolates, or, more preferably, from depositories or coUections such as the American Type Culture CoUection, or isolated from known sources using avaUable techniques.
Portions of the lentiviral gene dehvery vectors (or vehicles) may be derived from different viruses. For example, in a given recombinant lentiviral vector, LTRs may be derived from an HIN, a packaging signal from SIN, and an origin of second strand synthesis from HrN-2. Lentiviral vector constructs may comprise a 5' lentiviral LTR, a tRΝA binding site, a packaging signal, one or more heterologous sequences, an origin of second strand DΝA synthesis and a 3' LTR, wherein said lentiviral vector contains a nuclear transport element that is not RRE.
Briefly, Long Terminal Repeats ("LTRs") are subdivided into three elements, designated U5, R and U3. These elements contain a variety of signals which are responsible for the biological activity of a retrovirus, including for example, promoter and enhancer elements which are located within U3. LTRs may be readUy identified in the pro virus (integrated DΝA form) due to their precise duphcation at either end of the genome. As utilized herein, a 5' LTR should be understood to include a 5' promoter element and sufficient LTR sequence to aUow reverse transcription and integration of the DΝA form of the vector. The 3' LTR should be understood to include a polyadenylation signal, and sufficient LTR sequence to aUow reverse transcription and integration of the DΝA form of the vector.
The tRΝA binding site and origin of second strand DΝA synthesis are also important for a retrovirus to be biologicaUy active, and may be readUy identified by one of skiU in the art. For example, retroviral tRΝA binds to a tRΝA binding site by Watson-Crick base pairing, and is carried with the retrovirus genome into a viral particle. The tRNA is then utilized as a primer for DNA synthesis by reverse transcriptase. The tRNA binding site may be readUy identified based upon its location just downstream from the 5'LTR. Similarly, the origin of second strand DNA synthesis is, as its name implies, important for the second strand DNA synthesis of a retrovirus. This region, which is also referred to as the poly-purine tract, is located just upstream of the 3'LTR.
In addition to a 5' and 3' LTR, tRNA binding site, and origin of second strand DNA synthesis, recombinant retroviral vector constructs may also comprise a packaging signal, as weU as one or more genes or coding sequences of interest. In addition, the lentiviral vectors have a nuclear transport element which, in preferred embodiments is not RRE. Representative examples of suitable nuclear transport elements include the element in Rous sarcoma vims (Ogert, et al, J ViroL 70, 3834- 3843, 1996), the element in Rous sarcoma virus (Liu & Mertz, Genes & Dev., 9, 1766- 1789, 1995) and the element in the genome of simian retrovirus type I (Zolotukhin, et al., J Virol. 68, 7944-7952, 1994). Other potential elements include the elements in the histone gene (Kedes, Annu. Rev. Biochem. 48, 837-870, 1970), the α-interferon gene (Nagata et al., Nature 287, 401-408, 1980), the β-adrenergic receptor gene (Koilka, et al., Nature 329, 75-79, 1987), and the c-Jun gene (Hattorie, et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 85, 9148-9152, 1988). Recombinant lentiviral vector constructs typicaUy lack both Gag-polymerase and Env coding sequences. Recombinant lentiviral vector typicaUy contain less than 20, preferably 15, more preferably 10, and most preferably 8 consecutive nucleotides found in Gag-polymerase and Env genes. One advantage ofthe present invention is that the synthetic Gag-polymerase expression cassettes, which can be used to construct packaging ceU lines for the recombinant retroviral vector constructs, have httle homology to wUd-type Gag-polymerase sequences and thus considerably reduce or eliminate the possibihty of homologous recombination between the synthetic and wUd-type sequences.
Lentiviral vectors may also include tissue-specific promoters to drive expression of one or more genes or sequences of interest. Lentiviral vector constructs may be generated such that more than one gene of interest is expressed. This may be accomphshed through the use of di- or oligo- cistronic cassettes (e.g., where the coding regions are separated by 80 nucleotides or less, see generally Levin et al., Gene 108:167-174, 1991), or through the use of Internal Ribosome Entry Sites ("IRES").
Packaging ceU lines suitable for use with the above described recombinant retroviral vector constructs may be readUy prepared given the disclosure provided herein. Briefly, the parent ceU line from which the packaging ceU line is derived can be selected from a variety of mammahan ceU lines, including for example, 293, RD, COS- 7, CHO, BHK, NERO, HT1080, and myeloma ceUs.
After selection of a suitable host ceU for the generation of a packaging ceU line, one or more expression cassettes are introduced into the ceU line in order to complement or supply in trans components of the vector which have been deleted. Representative examples of suitable synthetic HIN polynucleotide sequences have been described herein for use in expression cassettes ofthe present invention. As described above, the native and/or synthetic coding sequences may also be utilized in these expression cassettes.
Utilizing the above-described expression cassettes, a wide variety of packaging ceU lines can be generated. For example, within one aspect packaging cell line are provided comprising an expression cassette that comprises a sequence encoding synthetic Gag-polymerase, and a nuclear transport element, wherein the promoter is operably linked to the sequence encoding Gag-polymerase. Within other aspects, packaging ceU lines are provided comprising a promoter and a sequence encoding tat, rev, Env, or other HIN antigens or epitopes derived therefrom, wherein the promoter is operably linked to the sequence encoding tat, rev, Env, or the HIN antigen or epitope. Within further embodiments, the packaging ceU hne may comprise a sequence encoding any one or more of tat, rev, nef, vif, vpu or vpr. For example, the packaging ceU line may contain only tat, rev, nef, vif, vpu, or vpr alone, tat rev and nef, nef and vif, nef and vpu, nef and vpr, vif and vpu, vif and vpr, vpu and vpr, nef vif and vpu, nef vif and vpr, nef vpu and vpr, vif vpu and vpr, aU four of nef, vif, vpu, and vpr, etc. In one embodiment, the expression cassette is stably integrated. Within another embodiment, the packaging ceU line, upon introduction of a lentiviral vector, produces particles. Within further embodiments the promoter is inducible. Within certain preferred embodiments of the invention, the packaging ceU hne, upon introduction of a lentiviral vector, produces particles that are free of replication competent virus.
The synthetic cassettes containing modified coding sequences are transfected into a selected ceU line. Transfected ceUs are selected that (i) carry, typicaUy, integrated, stable copies of the HIN coding sequences, and (ii) are expressing acceptable levels of these polypeptides (expression can be evaluated by methods known in the prior art in view of the teachings of the present disclosure). The ability of the ceU line to produce VLPs may also be verified.
A sequence of interest is constructed into a suitable viral vector as discussed above. This defective virus is then transfected into the packaging ceU hne. The packaging ceU line provides the viral functions necessary for producing virus-like particles into which the defective viral genome, containing the sequence of interest, are packaged. These VLPs are then isolated and can be used, for example, in gene dehvery or gene therapy.
Further, such packaging ceU lines can also be used to produce VLPs alone, which can, for example, be used as adjuvants for administration with other antigens or in vaccine compositions. Also, co-expression of a selected sequence of interest encoding a polypeptide (for example, an antigen) in the packaging ceU line can also result in the entrapment and/or association of the selected polypeptide in/with the VLPs. Various forms of the different embodiments of the present invention (e.g., synthetic constructs) may be combined.
2.4.0 DΝA IMMUNIZATION AND GENE DELIVERY
A variety of HTV polypeptide antigens, particularly HIV antigens, can be used in the practice of the present invention. HIV antigens can be included in DNA immunization constructs containing, for example, a synthetic Env expression cassettes, a synthetic Gag expression cassette, a synthetic pol-derived polypeptide expression cassette, a synthetic expression cassette comprising sequences encoding one or more accessory or regulatory genes (e.g., tat, rev, nef, vif, vpu, vpr), and/or a synthetic Gag expression cassette fused in-frame to a coding sequence for the polypeptide antigen (synthetic or wUd-type), where expression of the construct results in NLPs presenting the antigen of interest.
HIN antigens of particular interest to be used in the practice of the present invention include pol, tat, rev, nef, vif, vpu, vpr, and other HIN-1 (also known as HTLN-III, LAN, ARN, etc.) antigens or epitopes derived therefrom, including, but not limited to, antigens such as gρl20, gp41, gpl60 (both native and modified); Gag; and pol from a variety of isolates including, but not limited to, HINπj,, HINSF2, HIN-1SF162, HIN-1SF170, HINLAV, HINLAI, HIN, HIN-1CM235„ HIV-1US4, other HIV-1 strains from diverse subtypes(e.g., subtypes, A through G, and O), HIV-2 strains and diverse subtypes (e.g., HIV-2UC1 and HIN-2UC2). See, e.g., Myers, et al., Los Alamos Database, Los Alamos National Laboratory, Los Alamos, New Mexico; Myers, et al., Human Retroviruses and Aids, 1990, Los Alamos, New Mexico: Los Alamos National Laboratory. These antigens may be synthetic (as described herein) or wUd-type.
To evaluate efficacy, DNA immunization using synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention can be performed, for example, as foUows. Mice are immunized with a tat/rev/nef synthetic expression cassette. Other mice are immunized with a tat/rev/nef wUd type expression cassette. Mouse immunizations with plasmid- DNAs typicaUy show that the synthetic expression cassettes provide a clear improvement of immunogenicity relative to the native expression cassettes. Also, a second boost immunization wiU induce a secondary immune response, for example, after approximately two weeks. Further, the results of CTL assays typicaUy show increased potency of synthetic expression cassettes for induction of cytotoxic T- lymphocyte (CTL) responses by DNA immunization.
Exemplary primate studies directed at the evaluation of neutralizing antibodies and ceUular immune responses against HIV are described below. It is readUy apparent that the subject invention can be used to mount an immune response to a wide variety of antigens and hence to treat or prevent infection, particularly HIV infection.
2.4.1 DELIVERY OF THE SYNTHETIC EXPRESSION CASSETTES OF THE
PRESENT INVENTION
Polynucleotide sequences coding for the above-described molecules can be obtained using recombinant methods, such as by screening cDNA and genomic libraries from ceUs expressing the gene, or by deriving the gene from a vector known to include the same. Furthermore, the desired gene can be isolated directly from ceUs and tissues containing the same, using standard techniques, such as phenol extraction and PCR of cDNA or genomic DNA. See, e.g., Sambrook et al., supra, for a description of techniques used to obtain and isolate DNA. The gene of interest can also be produced syntheticaUy, rather than cloned. The nucleotide sequence can be designed with the appropriate codons for the particular amino acid sequence desired. In general, one wiU select preferred codons for the intended host in which the sequence wiU be expressed. The complete sequence is assembled from overlapping oligonucleotides prepared by standard methods and assembled into a complete coding sequence. See, e.g., Edge, Nature (1981) 292:756; Nambair et al., Science (1984) 223:1299; Jay et al., J. Biol. Chem. (1984) 259:6311; Stemmer, W.P.C, (1995) Gene 164:49-53.
Next, the gene sequence encoding the desired antigen can be inserted into a vector containing a synthetic expression cassette of the present invention. In one embodiment, polynucleotides encoding selected antigens are separately cloned into expression vectors (e.g., Env-coding polynucleotide in a first vector, Gag-coding polynucleotide in a second vector, Pol-derived polypeptide-coding polynucleotide in a third vector, tat-, rev-, nef-, vif-, vpu-, vpr-coding polynucleotides in further vectors, etc.). In certain embodiments, the antigen is inserted into or adjacent a synthetic Gag coding sequence such that when the combined sequence is expressed it results in the production of VLPs comprising the Gag polypeptide and the antigen of interest, e.g., Env (native or modified) or other antigen(s) (native or modified) derived from HIV. Insertions can be made within the coding sequence or at either end of the coding sequence (5', amino terminus of the expressed Gag polypeptide; or 3', carboxy terminus ofthe expressed Gag polypeptide) (Wagner, R., et al, Arch Virol 127:117- 137, 1992; Wagner, R., et al., Virology 200:162-175, 1994; Wu, X., et al., J. Virol. 69(6):3389-3398, 1995; Wang, C-T., et al., Virology 200:524-534, 1994; Chazal, N., et al., Virology 68(1): 111-122, 1994; Griffiths, J.C, et al., J. Virol. 67(6):3191-3198, 1993; Reicin, A.S., et al., J. Virol. 69(2): 642-650, 1995).
Up to 50% of the coding sequences of p55Gag can be deleted without affecting the assembly to virus-like particles and expression efficiency (Borsetti, A., et al, J. Virol. 72(11):9313-9317, 1998; Gamier, L., et al., J Virol 72(6):4667-4677, 1998; Zhang, Y., et al., / Virol 72(3): 1782-1789, 1998; Wang, C, et al., / Virol 72(10): 7950-7959, 1998). In one embodiment ofthe present invention, immunogenicity of the high level expressing synthetic Gag expression cassettes can be increased by the insertion of different structural or non-structural HIV antigens, multi- epitope cassettes, or cytokine sequences into deleted regions of Gag sequence. Such deletions may be generated foUowing the teachings of the present invention and information available to one of ordinary skiU in the art. One possible advantage of this approach, relative to using fuU-length sequences fused to heterologous polypeptides, can be higher expression/secretion efficiency of the expression product. When sequences are added to the amino terminal end of Gag, the polynucleotide can contain coding sequences at the 5' end that encode a signal for addition of a myristic moiety to the Gag-containing polypeptide (e.g., sequences that encode Met-Gly).
The ability of Gag-containing polypeptide constructs to form VLPs can be empiricaUy determined foUowing the teachings of the present specification.
The synthetic expression cassettes can also include control elements operably linked to the coding sequence, which aUow for the expression of the gene in vivo in the subject species. For example, typical promoters for mammahan ceU expression include the S V40 early promoter, a CMV promoter such as the CMV immediate early promoter, the mouse mammary tumor vims LTR promoter, the adenovirus major late promoter (Ad MLP), and the herpes simplex virus promoter, among others. Other nonviral promoters, such as a promoter derived from the murine metaUothionein gene, wiU also find use for mammahan expression. TypicaUy, transcription termination and polyadenylation sequences wiU also be present, located 3' to the translation stop codon. Preferably, a sequence for optimization of initiation of translation, located 5' to the coding sequence, is also present. Examples of transcription terminator/polyadenylation signals include those derived from S V40, as described in Sambrook et al., supra, as weU as a bovine growth hormone terminator sequence.
Enhancer elements may also be used herein to increase expression levels of the mammahan constmcts. Examples include the SV40 early gene enhancer, as described in Dijkema et al., EMBO J. (1985) 4:761, the enhancer/promoter derived from the long terminal repeat (LTR) of the Rous Sarcoma Virus, as described in Gorman et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1982b) 79:6777 and elements derived from human CMV, as described in Boshart et al., Cell (1985) 41:521, such as elements included in the CMV intron A sequence. Furthermore, plasmids can be constructed which include a chimeric antigen- coding gene sequences, encoding, e.g., multiple antigens/epitopes of interest, for example derived from more than one viral isolate.
TypicaUy the antigen coding sequences precede or foUow the synthetic coding sequence and the chimeric transcription unit wiU have a single open reading frame encoding both the antigen of interest and the synthetic coding sequences.
Alternatively, multi-cistronic cassettes (e.g., bi-cistronic cassettes) can be constructed aUowing expression of multiple antigens from a single mRNA using the EMCV IRES, or the like (Example 7).
In one embodiment of the present invention, a nucleic acid immunizing composition may comprise, for example, the foUowing: a first expression vector comprising a Gag expression cassette, a second vector comprising an Env expression cassette, and a third expression vector comprising a Pol expression cassette, or one or more coding region of Pol (e.g., Prot, RT, RNase, Int), wherein further antigen coding sequences may be associated with the Pol expression, such antigens may be obtained, for example, from accessory genes (e.g., vpr, vpu, vif), regulatory genes (e.g., nef, tat, rev), or portions of the Pol sequences (e.g., Prot, RT, RNase, Int)). In another embodiment, a nucleic acid immunizing composition may comprise, for example, an expression cassette comprising any of the synthetic polynucleotide sequences of the present invention. In another embodiment, a nucleic acid immunizing composition may comprise, for example, an expression cassette comprising coding sequences for a number of HIV genes (or sequences derived from such genes) wherein the coding sequences are in-frame and under the control of a single promoter, for example, Gag- Env constructs, Tat-Rev-Nef constmcts, P2Pol-tat-rev-nef constmcts, etc. The synthetic coding sequences of the present invention may be combined in any number of combinations depending on the coding sequence products (i.e., HIV polypeptides) to which, for example, an immunological response is desired to be raised. In yet another embodiment, synthetic coding sequences for multiple HIV-derived polypeptides may be constracted into a polycistronic message under the control of a single promoter wherein IRES are placed adjacent the coding sequence for each encoded polypeptide. Once complete, the constmcts are used for nucleic acid immunization using standard gene dehvery protocols. Methods for gene dehvery are known in the art.
See, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 5,399,346, 5,580,859, 5,589,466. Genes can be dehvered either directly to the vertebrate subject or, alternatively, dehvered ex vivo, to ceUs derived from the subject and the ceUs reimplanted in the subject.
A number of viral based systems have been developed for gene transfer into mammahan ceUs. For example, retro viruses provide a convenient platform for gene dehvery systems. Selected sequences can be inserted into a vector and packaged in retroviral particles using techniques known in the art. The recombinant virus can then be isolated and dehvered to ceUs of the subject either in vivo or ex vivo. A number of retroviral systems have been described (U.S. Patent No. 5,219,740; MiUer and Rosman, BioTechniques (1989) 7:980-990; MiUer, A.D., Human Gene Therapy
(1990) 1:5-14; Scarpa et al., Virology (1991) 180:849-852; Burns et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1993) 90:8033-8037; and Boris-Lawrie and Temin, Cur. Opin. Genet. Develop. (1993) 3:102-109.
A number of adenovirus vectors have also been described. Unlike retroviruses which integrate into the host genome, adenoviruses persist extrachromosomaUy thus minimizing the risks associated with insertional mutagenesis (Haj-Ahmad and Graham, /. Virol (1986) 57:267-274; Bett et al., J. Virol. (1993) 67:5911-5921; Mittereder et al., Human Gene Therapy (1994) 5:717-729; Seth et al., J. Virol (1994) 68:933-940; Barr et al., Gene Therapy (1994) f.51-58; Berkner, K.L. BioTechniques (1988) 6:616- 629; and Rich et al., Human Gene Therapy (1993) 4:461-476). AdditionaUy, various adeno-associated virus (AAV) vector systems have been developed for gene dehvery. AAV vectors can be readUy constracted using techniques weU known in the art. See, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 5,173,414 and 5,139,941; International Pubhcation Nos. WO 92/01070 (pubhshed 23 January 1992) and WO 93/03769 (pubhshed 4 March 1993); Lebkowski et al., Molec. Cell. Biol. (1988) 8:3988-3996; Vincent et al., Vaccines 90 (1990) (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory
Press); Carter, BJ. Current Opinion in Biotechnology (1992) 3:533-539; Muzyczka, N. Current Topics in Microbiol. and Immunol. (1992) 158:97-129; Kotin, R.M. Human Gene Therapy (1994) 5:793-801; Shelling and Smith, Gene Therapy (1994) 1:165-169; and Zhou et al., J. Exp. Med. (1994) 179:1867-1875. Another vector system useful for delivering the polynucleotides of the present invention is the entericaUy administered recombinant poxvirus vaccines described by SmaU, Jr., P.A., et al. (U.S. Patent No. 5,676,950, issued October 14, 1997).
Additional viral vectors which wUl find use for delivering the nucleic acid molecules encoding the antigens of interest include those derived from the pox famUy of viruses, including vaccinia vims and avian poxvirus. By way of example, vaccinia virus recombinants expressing the genes can be constracted as foUows. The DNA encoding the particular synthetic HIV polypeptide coding sequence is first inserted into an appropriate vector so that it is adjacent to a vaccinia promoter and flanking vaccinia DNA sequences, such as the sequence encoding thymidine kinase (TK). This vector is then used to transfect ceUs which are simultaneously infected with vaccinia.
Homologous recombination serves to insert the vaccinia promoter plus the gene encoding the coding sequences of interest into the viral genome. The resulting TK" recombinant can be selected by culturing the ceUs in the presence of 5- bromodeoxyuridine and picking viral plaques resistant thereto. Alternatively, avipoxviruses, such as the fowlpox and canarypox viruses, can also be used to dehver the genes. Recombinant avipox viruses, expressing immunogens from mammahan pathogens, are known to confer protective immunity when administered to non-avian species. The use of an avipox vector is particularly desirable in human and other mammahan species since members of the avipox genus can only productively rephcate in susceptible avian species and therefore are not infective in mammahan ceUs. Methods for producing recombinant avipoxviruses are known in the art and employ genetic recombination, as described above with respect to the production of vaccinia viruses. See, e.g., WO 91/12882; WO 89/03429; and WO 92/03545.
Molecular conjugate vectors, such as the adenovirus chimeric vectors described in Michael et al., J. Biol. Chem. (1993) 268:6866-6869 and Wagner et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1992) 89:6099-6103, can also be used for gene dehvery.
Members ofthe Alphavirus genus, such as, but not limited to, vectors derived from the Sindbis, Semliki Forest, and Venezuelan Equine Encephahtis viruses, wiU also find use as viral vectors for delivering the polynucleotides ofthe present invention (for example, a synthetic Gag-polypeptide encoding expression cassette). For a description of Sindbis-virus derived vectors useful for the practice of the instant methods, see, Dubensky et al., J. Virol. (1996) 70:508-519; and International Pubhcation Nos. WO 95/07995 and WO 96/17072; as weU as, Dubensky, Jr., T.W., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,843,723, issued December 1, 1998, and Dubensky, Jr., T.W., U.S. Patent No. 5,789,245, issued August 4, 1998. Preferred expression systems include, but are not mited to, eucaryotic layered vector initiation systems (e.g., US Patent No. 6,015,686, US Patent No. 5, 814,482, US Patent No. 6,015,694, US Patent No. 5,789,245, EP 1029068A2, WO 9918226A2/A3, EP 00907746A2, WO 9738087 A2).
A vaccinia based infection/transfection system can be conveniently used to provide for inducible, transient expression of the coding sequences of interest in a host ceU. In this system, ceUs are first infected in vitro with a vaccinia vims recombinant that encodes the bacteriophage T7 RNA polymerase. This polymerase displays exquisite specificity in that it only transcribes templates bearing T7 promoters. FoUowing infection, ceUs are transfected with the polynucleotide of interest, driven by a T7 promoter. The polymerase expressed in the cytoplasm from the vaccinia virus recombinant transcribes the transfected DNA into RNA which is then translated into protein by the host translational machinery. The method provides for high level, transient, cytoplasmic production of large quantities of RNA and its translation products. See, e.g., Elroy-Stein and Moss, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1990) 87:6743-6747; Fuerst et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1986) 83:8122-8126. As an alternative approach to infection with vaccinia or avipox vims recombinants, or to the dehvery of genes using other viral vectors, an amplification system can be used that wiU lead to high level expression foUowing introduction into host cells. SpecificaUy, a T7 RNA polymerase promoter preceding the coding region for T7 RNA polymerase can be engineered. Translation of RNA derived from this template wiU generate T7 RNA polymerase which in turn wiU transcribe more template. Concomitantly, there wiU be a cDNA whose expression is under the control of the T7 promoter. Thus, some ofthe T7 RNA polymerase generated from translation of the amplification template RNA wiU lead to transcription of the desired gene. Because some T7 RNA polymerase is required to initiate the amplification, T7 RNA polymerase can be introduced into ceUs along with the template(s) to prime the transcription reaction. The polymerase can be introduced as a protein or on a plasmid encoding the RNA polymerase. For a further discussion of T7 systems and their use for transforming ceUs, see, e.g., International Pubhcation No. WO 94/26911; Studier and Moffatt, J. Mol Biol. (1986) 189:113-130; Deng and Wolff, Gene (1994) 143 : 245-249 ; Gao et al. , Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. ( 1994) 200: 1201 - 1206; Gao and Huang, Nuc. Acids Res. (1993) 21:2867-2872; Chen et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1994) 22:2114-2120; and U.S. Patent No. 5,135,855.
Dehvery ofthe expression cassettes ofthe present invention can also be accomphshed using eucaryotic expression vectors comprising CMN-derived elements, such vectors include, but are not limited to, the following: pCMNRm2, pCMN-link pCMVPLEdhfr, and ρCMV6a (aU described above).
Synthetic expression cassettes of interest can also be dehvered without a viral vector. For example, the synthetic expression cassette can be packaged in hposomes prior to dehvery to the subject or to ceUs derived therefrom. Lipid encapsulation is generaUy accomphshed using hposomes which are able to stably bind or entrap and retain nucleic acid. The ratio of condensed DΝA to hpid preparation can vary but wUl generaUy be around 1:1 (mg DNA:micromoles hpid), or more of lipid. For a review of the use of hposomes as carriers for dehvery of nucleic acids, see, Hug and Sleight, Biochim. Biophys. Acta. (1991) 1097:1-17; Straubinger et al., in Methods of Enzymology (1983), Vol. 101, pp. 512-527. Liposomal preparations for use in the present. invention include cationic
(positively charged), anionic (negatively charged) and neutral preparations, with cationic hposomes particularly preferred. Cationic hposomes have been shown to mediate intraceUular dehvery of plasmid DNA (Feigner et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1987) 84:7413-7416); mRNA (Malone et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1989) 86:6077-6081); and purified transcription factors (Debs et al., J. Biol. Chem. (1990) 265:10189-10192), in functional form.
Cationic hposomes are readUy avaUable. For example, N[l-2,3- dioleyloxy)propyl]-N,N,N-triethylammonium (DOTMA) hposomes are avaUable under the trademark Lipofectin, from GIBCO BRL, Grand Island, NY. (See, also, Feigner et al, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1987) 84:7413-7416). Other commerciaUy avaUable hpids include (DDAB/DOPE) and DOTAP/DOPE (Boerhinger). Other cationic hposomes can be prepared from readily avaUable materials using techniques weU known in the art. See, e.g., Szoka et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1978) 75:4194- 4198; PCT Pubhcation No. WO 90/11092 for a description ofthe synthesis of DOTAP (l,2-bis(oleoyloxy)-3-(trimethylammonio)propane) hposomes.
SimUarly, anionic and neutral hposomes are readUy available, such as, from Avanti Polar Lipids (Birmingham, AL), or can be easUy prepared using readUy avaUable materials. Such materials include phosphatidyl choline, cholesterol, phosphatidyl ethanolamine, dioleoylphosphatidyl choline (DOPC), dioleoylphosphatidyl glycerol (DOPG), dioleoylphoshatidyl ethanolamine (DOPE), among others. These materials can also be mixed with the DOTMA and DOTAP starting materials in appropriate ratios. Methods for making hposomes using these materials are weU known in the art.
The hposomes can comprise multUammelar vesicles (MLVs), smaU unUameUar vesicles (SUVs), or large unUameUar vesicles (LUVs). The various hposome-nucleic acid complexes are prepared using methods known in the art. See, e.g., Straubinger et al., in METHODS OF IMMUNOLOGY (1983), Vol. 101, pp. 512-527; Szoka et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1978) 75:4194-4198; Papahadjopoulos et al., Biochim. Biophys. Ada (1975) 394:483; Wilson et al., Cell (1979) 17:77); Deamer and Bangham, Biochim. Biophys. Acta (1976) 443:629; Ostro et al, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. (1977) 76:836; Fraley et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1979)
76:3348); Enoch and Strittmatter, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1979) 76:145); Fraley et al., J. Biol. Chem. (1980) 255:10431; Szoka and Papahadjopoulos, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA (1978) 75:145; and Schaefer-Ridder et al., Science (1982) 215:166. The DNA and/or protein antigen(s) can also be dehvered in cochleate hpid compositions similar to those described by Papahadjopoulos et al., Biochem. Biophys. Acta. (1975) 394:483-491. See, also, U.S. Patent Nos. 4,663,161 and 4,871,488.
The synthetic expression cassette of interest may also be encapsulated, adsorbed to, or associated with, particulate carriers. Such carriers present multiple copies of a selected antigen to the immune system and promote trapping and retention of antigens in local lymph nodes. The particles can be phagocytosed by macrophages and can enhance antigen presentation through cytokine release. Examples of particulate carriers include those derived from polymethyl methacrylate polymers, as weU as microparticles derived from poly(lactides) and poly(lactide-co-glycohdes), known as PLG. See, e.g., Jeffery et al., Pharm. Res. (1993) 10:362-368; McGee JP, et al., J Microencapsul. 14(2)197-210, 1997; O'Hagan DT, et al., Vaccine 11(2): 149- 54, 1993. Suitable microparticles may also be manufactured in the presence of charged detergents, such as anionic or cationic detergents, to yield microparticles with a surface having a net negative or a net positive charge. For example, microparticles manufactured with anionic detergents, such as hexadecyltrimethylammonium bromide (CTAB), i.e. CTAB-PLG microparticles, adsorb negatively charged macromolecules, such as DNA. (see, e.g., Infl Apphcation Number PCT/US99/17308).
Furthermore, other particulate systems and polymers can be used for the in vivo or ex vivo dehvery of the gene of interest. For example, polymers such as polylysine, polyarginine, polyornithine, spermine, spermidine, as weU as conjugates of these molecules, are useful for transferring a nucleic acid of interest. Similarly, DEAE dextran-mediated transfection, calcium phosphate precipitation or precipitation using other insoluble inorganic salts, such as strontium phosphate, aluminum silicates including bentonite and kaolin, chromic oxide, magnesium sUicate, talc, and the like, wUl find use with the present methods. See, e.g., Feigner, P.L., Advanced Drug Delivery Reviews (1990) 5: 163-187, for a review of dehvery systems useful for gene transfer. Peptoids (Zuckerman, R.N., et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,831,005, issued November 3, 1998) may also be used for dehvery of a construct of the present invention.
AdditionaUy, biohstic dehvery systems employing particulate carriers such as gold and tungsten, are especiaUy useful for delivering synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention. The particles are coated with the synthetic expression cassette(s) to be dehvered and accelerated to high velocity, generaUy under a reduced atmosphere, using a gun powder discharge from a "gene gun." For a description of , such techniques, and apparatuses useful therefore, see, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 4,945,050; 5,036,006; 5,100,792; 5,179,022; 5,371,015; and 5,478,744. Also, needle- less injection systems can be used (Davis, H.L., et al, Vaccine 12:1503-1509, 1994; Bioject, Inc., Portland, OR).
Recombinant vectors carrying a synthetic expression cassette of the present invention are formulated into compositions for dehvery to the vertebrate subject. These compositions may either be prophylactic (to prevent infection) or therapeutic (to treat disease after infection). The compositions wiU comprise a "therapeuticaUy effective amount" of the gene of interest such that an amount of the antigen can be produced in vivo so that an immune response is generated in the individual to which it is administered. The exact amount necessary wiU vary depending on the subject being treated; the age and general condition of the subject to be treated; the capacity of the subject's immune system to synthesize antibodies; the degree of protection desired; the severity of the condition being treated; the particular antigen selected and its mode of administration, among other factors. An appropriate effective amount can be readUy determined by one of skUl in the art. Thus, a "therapeuticaUy effective amount" wiU faU in a relatively broad range that can be determined through routine trials. The compositions wiU generaUy include one or more "pharmaceutically acceptable excipients or vehicles" such as water, saline, glycerol, polyethyleneglycol, hyaluronic acid, ethanol, etc. AdditionaUy, auxiliary substances, such as wetting or emulsifying agents, pH buffering substances, and the like, may be present in such vehicles. Certain facilitators of nucleic acid uptake and/or expression can also be included in the compositions or coadministered, such as, but not limited to, bupivacaine, cardiotoxin and sucrose.
Once formulated, the compositions of the invention can be administered directly to the subject (e.g., as described above) or, alternatively, dehvered ex vivo, to ceUs derived from the subject, using methods such as those described above. For example, methods for the ex vivo dehvery and reimplantation of transformed ceUs into a subject are known in the art and can include, e.g., dextran-mediated transfection, calcium phosphate precipitation, polybrene mediated transfection, hpofectamine and LT-1 mediated transfection, protoplast fusion, electroporation, encapsulation of the polynucleotide(s) (with or without the corresponding antigen) in hposomes, and direct microinjection of the DNA into nuclei. Direct dehvery of synthetic expression cassette compositions in vivo wUl generaUy be accomphshed with or without viral vectors, as described above, by injection using either a conventional syringe or a gene gun, such as the AcceU® gene dehvery system (Powder Ject Technologies, Inc., Oxford, England). The constructs can be injected either subcutaneously, epidermaUy, intradermaUy, intramucosaUy such as nasaUy, rectaUy and vaginaUy, intraperitoneaUy, intravenously, oraUy or intramuscularly. Dehvery of DNA into ceUs of the epidermis is particularly preferred as this mode of administration provides access to skin-associated lymphoid ceUs and provides for a transient presence of DNA in the recipient. Other modes of administration include oral and pulmonary administration, suppositories, needle-less injection, transcutaneous and transdermal apphcations. Dosage treatment may be a single dose schedule or a multiple dose schedule. Administration of nucleic acids may also be combined with administration of peptides or other substances.
Exemplary immunogenicity studies are presented in Examples 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, and 12. l 2.4.2 Ex VIVO DELIVERY OF THE SYNTHETIC EXPRESSION CASSETTES OF
THE PRESENT INVENTION
In one embodiment, T ceUs, and related ceU types (including but not Umited to antigen presenting ceUs, such as, macrophage, monocytes, lymphoid cells, dendritic ceUs, B-ceUs, T-ceUs, stem cells, and progenitor ceUs thereof), can be used for ex vivo dehvery of the synthetic expression cassettes of the present invention. T ceUs can be isolated from peripheral blood lymphocytes (PBLs) by a variety of procedures known to those skiUed in the art. For example, T ceU populations can be "enriched" from a population of PBLs through the removal of accessory and B ceUs. In particular, T ceU enrichment can be accomphshed by the elimination of non-T ceUs using anti-MHC class II monoclonal antibodies. SimUarly, other antibodies can be used to deplete specific populations of non-T ceUs. For example, anti-Ig antibody molecules can be used to deplete B ceUs and anti-Mad antibody molecules can be used to deplete macrophages. T ceUs can be further fractionated into a number of different subpopulations by techniques known to those skUled in the art. Two major subpopulations can be isolated based on their differential expression of the ceU surface markers CD4 and CD8. For example, foUowing the enrichment of T ceUs as described above, CD4+ ceUs can be enriched using antibodies specific for CD4 (see Cohgan et al., supra). The antibodies may be coupled to a sohd support such as magnetic beads. Conversely,
CD8+ ceUs can be enriched through the use of antibodies specific for CD4 (to remove CD4+ ceUs), or can be isolated by the use of CD8 antibodies coupled to a sohd support. CD4 lymphocytes from HIN-1 infected patients can be expanded ex vivo, before or after transduction as described by Wilson et. al. (1995) /. Infect. Dis. 172:88.
FoUowing purification of T ceUs, a variety of methods of genetic modification known to those skUled in the art can be performed using non- viral or viral-based gene transfer vectors constracted as described herein. For example, one such approach involves transduction of the purified T ceU population with vector-containing supernatant of cultures derived from vector producing ceUs. A second approach involves co-cultivation of an irradiated monolayer of vector-producing ceUs with the purified T ceUs. A third approach involves a similar co-cultivation approach; however, the purified T ceUs are pre-stimulated with various cytokines and cultured 48 hours prior to the co-cultivation with the irradiated vector producing ceUs. Pre-stimulation prior to such transduction increases effective gene transfer (Nolta et al. (1992) Exp. Hematol. 20:1065). Stimulation of these cultures to proliferate also provides increased ceU populations for re-infusion into the patient. Subsequent to co- cultivation, T ceUs are coUected from the vector producing ceU monolayer, expanded, and frozen in hquid nitrogen.
Gene transfer vectors, containing one or more synthetic expression cassette of the present invention (associated with appropriate control elements for dehvery to the isolated T ceUs) can be assembled using known methods and foUowing the guidance of the present specification.
Selectable markers can also be used in the construction of gene transfer vectors. For example, a marker can be used which imparts to a mammahan ceU transduced with the gene transfer vector resistance to a cytotoxic agent. The cytotoxic agent can be, but is not limited to, neomycin, aminoglycoside, tetracycline, chloramphenicol, suhonamide, actinomycin, netropsin, distamycin A, anthracycline, or pyrazinamide. For example, neomycin phosphotransferase II imparts resistance to the neomycin analogue geneticin (G418). The T ceUs can also be maintained in a medium containing at least one type of growth factor prior to being selected. A variety of growth factors are known in the art which sustain the growth of a particular ceU type. Examples of such growth factors are cytokine mitogens such as rE -2, IL-10, EL-12, and E -15, which promote growth and activation of lymphocytes. Certain types of ceUs are stimulated by other growth factors such as hormones, including human chorionic gonadotropin (hCG) and human growth hormone. The selection of an appropriate growth factor for a particular ceU population is readUy accomphshed by one of skUl in the art.
For example, white blood ceUs such as differentiated progenitor and stem ceUs are stimulated by a variety of growth factors. More particularly, E -3, E -4, E -5, TJL- 6, E0-9, GM-CSF, M-CSF, and G-CSF, produced by activated TH and activated macrophages, stimulate myeloid stem ceUs, which then differentiate into pluripotent stem ceUs, granulocyte-monocyte progenitors, eosinophU progenitors, basopbil progenitors, megakaryocytes, and erythroid progenitors. Differentiation is modulated by growth factors such as GM-CSF, IL-3, TL-6, IL-11, and EPO.
Pluripotent stem ceUs then differentiate into lymphoid stem ceUs, bone marrow stromal ceUs, T ceU progenitors, B ceU progenitors, thymocytes, TH CeUs, Tc ceUs, and B ceUs. This differentiation is modulated by growth factors such as E -3, IL-4, IL-6, E -7, GM-CSF, M-CSF, G-CSF, IL-2, and IL-5.
Granulocyte-monocyte progenitors differentiate to monocytes, macrophages, and neutrophils. Such differentiation is modulated by the growth factors GM-CSF, M- CSF, and E -8. Eosinophil progenitors differentiate into eosinophUs. This process is modulated by GM-CSF and IL-5.
The differentiation of basopbil progenitors into mast ceUs and basophUs is modulated by GM-CSF, IL-4, and IL-9. Megakaryocytes produce platelets in response to GM-CSF, EPO, and IL-6. Erythroid progenitor ceUs differentiate into red blood ceUs in response to EPO.
Thus, during activation by the CD3-binding agent, T ceUs can also be contacted with a mitogen, for example a cytokine such as IL-2. In particularly preferred embodiments, the IL-2 is added to the population of T ceUs at a concentration of about 50 to 100 μg/ml. Activation with the CD3-binding agent can be carried out for 2 to 4 days.
Once suitably activated, the T ceUs are geneticaUy modified by contacting the same with a suitable gene transfer vector under conditions that aUow for transfection of the vectors into the T ceUs. Genetic modification is carried out when the ceU density of the T ceU population is between about 0.1 x 106 and 5 x 106, preferably between about 0.5 x 106 and 2 x 106. A number of suitable viral and nonviral-based gene transfer vectors have been described for use herein.
After transduction, transduced ceUs are selected away from non-transduced ceUs using known techniques. For example, if the gene transfer vector used in the transduction includes a selectable marker which confers resistance to a cytotoxic agent, the ceUs can be contacted with the appropriate cytotoxic agent, whereby non- transduced ceUs can be negatively selected away from the transduced ceUs. If the selectable marker is a ceU surface marker, the ceUs can be contacted with a binding agent specific for the particular ceU surface marker, whereby the transduced ceUs can be positively selected away from the population. The selection step can also entaU fluorescence-activated ceU sorting (FACS) techniques, such as where FACS is used to select ceUs from the population containing a particular surface marker, or the selection step can entaU the use of magneticaUy responsive particles as retrievable supports for target ceU capture and/or background removal.
More particularly, positive selection of the transduced ceUs can be performed using a FACS ceU sorter (e.g. a FACSNantage™ CeU Sorter, Becton Dickinson Immunocytometry Systems, San Jose, CA) to sort and coUect transduced ceUs expressing a selectable ceU surface marker. FoUowing transduction, the ceUs are stained with fluorescent-labeled antibody molecules directed against the particular ceU surface marker. The amount of bound antibody on each ceU can be measured by passing droplets containing the ceUs through the ceU sorter. By imparting an electromagnetic charge to droplets containing the stained ceUs, the transduced ceUs can be separated from other ceUs. The positively selected ceUs are then harvested in sterUe coUection vessels. These ceU sorting procedures are described in detaU, for example, in the FACSVantage™ Training Manual, with particular reference to sections 3-11 to 3-28 and 10-1 to 10-17. Positive selection ofthe transduced ceUs can also be performed using magnetic separation of ceUs based on expression or a particular ceU surface marker. In such separation techniques, ceUs to be positively selected are first contacted with specific binding agent (e.g., an antibody or reagent the interacts specificaUy with the ceU surface marker). The ceUs are then contacted with retrievable particles (e.g., magneticaUy responsive particles) which are coupled with a reagent that binds the specific binding agent (that has bound to the positive ceUs). The ceU-binding agent- particle complex can then be physicaUy separated from non-labeled ceUs, for example using a magnetic field. When using magneticaUy responsive particles, the labeled ceUs can be retained in a container using a magnetic filed while the negative ceUs are removed. These and simUar separation procedures are known to those of ordinary skiU in the art. Expression ofthe vector in the selected transduced ceUs can be assessed by a number of assays known to those skilled in the art. For example, Western blot or Northern analysis can be employed depending on the nature ofthe inserted nucleotide sequence of interest. Once expression has been estabhshed and the transformed T ceUs have been tested for the presence of the selected synthetic expression cassette, they are ready for infusion into a patient via the peripheral blood stream.
The invention includes a kit for genetic modification of an ex vivo population of primary mammahan ceUs. The kit typicaUy contains a gene transfer vector coding for at least one selectable marker and at least one synthetic expression cassette contained in one or more containers, anciUary reagents or hardware, and instructions for use of the kit.
2.4.3 FURTHER DELIVERY REGIMES
Any of the polynucleotides (e.g., expression cassettes) or polypeptides described herein (dehvered by any of the methods described above) can also be used in combination with other DNA dehvery systems and/or protein dehvery systems. Non- limiting examples include co-administration of these molecules, for example, in prime- boost methods where one or more molecules are dehvered in a "priming" step and, subsequently, one or more molecules are dehvered in a "boosting" step. In certain embodiments, the dehvery of one or more nucleic acid-containing compositions and is foUowed by dehvery of one or more nucleic acid-containing compositions and/or one or more polypeptide-containing compositions (e.g., polypeptides comprising HIV antigens). In other embodiments, multiple nucleic acid "primes" (of the same or different nucleic acid molecules) can be foUowed by multiple polypeptide "boosts" (of the same or different polypeptides). Other examples include multiple nucleic acid administrations and multiple polypeptide administrations.
In any method involving co-administration, the various compositions can be dehvered in any order. Thus, in embodiments including dehvery of multiple different compositions or molecules, the nucleic acids need not be aU dehvered before the polypeptides. For example, the priming step may include dehvery of one or more polypeptides and the boosting comprises dehvery of one or more nucleic acids and/or one more polypeptides. Multiple polypeptide administrations can be foUowed by multiple nucleic acid administrations or polypeptide and nucleic acid administrations can be performed in any order. In any ofthe embodiments described herein, the nucleic acid molecules can encode aU, some or none of the polypeptides. Thus, one or more or the nucleic acid molecules (e.g., expression cassettes) described herein and/or one or more ofthe polypeptides described herein can be co-administered in any order and via any administration routes. Therefore, any combination of polynucleotides and/or polypeptides described herein can be used to generate elicit an immune reaction.
3.0 IMPROVED HIV-1 GAG AND POL EXPRESSION CASSETTES
WhUe not desiring to be bound by any particular model, theory, or hypothesis, the foUowing information is presented to provide a more complete understanding of the present invention. The world health organization (WHO) estimated the number of people worldwide that are infected with HIV-1 to exceed 36.1 million. The development of a safe and effective HIV vaccine is therefore essential at this time. Recent studies have demonstrated the importance of CTL in controlling the HIV-1 rephcation in infected patients. Furthermore, CTL reactivity with multiple HIV antigens wll be necessary for the effective control of vims rephcation. Experiments performed in support of the present invention suggest that the inclusion of HIV-1 Gag and Pol, beside Env for the induction of neutralizing antibodies, into the vaccine is useful.
To increase the potency of HIV-1 vaccine candidates, codon modified Gag and Pol expression cassettes were designed, either for Gag alone or Gag plus Pol. To evaluate possible differences in expression and potency, the expression of these constructs was analyzed and immunogenicity studies carried out in mice.
Several expression cassettes encoding Gag and Pol were designed, including, but not limited to, the foUowing: GagProtease, GagPolΔintegrase with frameshift (gagFSpol), and GagPolΔintegrase in-frame (gagpol). Versions of GagPolΔintegrase in-frame were also designed with attenuated (Att) or non-functional Protease (Ina).
The nucleic acid sequences were codon modified to correspond to the codon usage of highly expressed human genes. Mice were immunized with titrated DNA doses and humoral and ceUular immune responses evaluated by ELISA and intraceUular cytokine staining (Example 10).
The immune responses in mice has been seen to be correlated with relative levels of expression in vitro. Vaccine studies in rhesus monkeys wUl further address immune responses and expression levels in vivo.
4.0 ENHANCED VACCINE TECHNOLOGIES FOR THE INDUCTION OF POTENT NEUTRALIZING ANTIBODIES AND CELLULAR IMMUNE RESPONSES AGAINST HIV.
WhUe not desiring to be bound by any particular model, theory, or hypothesis, the foUowing information is presented to provide a more complete understanding of the present invention.
Protection against HIV infection wiU likely require potent and broadly reactive pre-existing neutralizing antibodies in vaccinated individuals exposed to a virus chaUenge. Although ceUular immune responses are desirable to control viremia in those who get infected, protection against infection has not been demonstrated for vaccine approaches that rely exclusively on the induction of these responses. For this reason, experiments performed in support of the present invention use prime-boost approaches that employ novel V-deleted envelope antigens from primary HIV isolates (e.g., R5 subtype B (HIN-1SF162) and subtype C (HIN-1TVI) strains). These antigens were dehvered by enhanced DΝA [polyactide co-glycohde (PLG) microparticle formulations or electroporation] or alphavirus replicon particle-based vaccine approaches, foUowed by booster immunizations with Env proteins in MF59 adjuvant. Efficient in vivo expression of plasmid encoded genes by electrical permeabilization has been described (see, e.g., ZuccheUi et al. (2000) J. Virol. 7411598-11607; Banga et al. (1998) Trends Biotechnol. 10:408-412; HeUer et al. (1996) Febs Lett. 389:225- 228; Mathiesen et al. (1999) Gene Ther. 4:508-514; Mir et al. (1999) Proc. Nat'lAcad Sci. USA 8:4262-4267; Νishi et al. (1996) Cancer Res. 51050-1055). Both native and N-deleted monomeric (gpl20) and ohgomeric (o-gpl40) forms of protein from the SF162 strain were tested as boosters. AU protein preparations were highly purified and extensively characterized by biophysical and immunochemical methodologies. Results firom rabbit and primate immunogenicity studies indicated that, whereas neutralizing antibody responses could be consistently induced against the parental non- N2-deleted SF162 virus, the induction of responses against heterologous HIN strains improved with deletion of the N2 loop of the immunogens. Moreover, using these prime-boost vaccine regimens, potent HIN antigen-specific CD4 + and CD8+ T-ceU responses were also demonstrated.
Based on these findings, V2-deleted envelope DΝA and protein vaccines were chosen for advancement toward clinical evaluation. SimUar approaches for immunization may be employed using, for example, nucleic acid immunization employing the synthetic HIV polynucleotides of the present invention coupled with corresponding or heterologous HIV-derived polypeptide boosts.
One embodiment of this aspect of the present invention may be described generaUy as foUows. Antigens are selected for the vaccine composition(s). Env polypeptides are typicaUy employed in a first antigemc composition used to induce an immune response. Further, Gag polypeptides are typicaUy employed in a second antigenic composition used to induce an immune response. The second antigenic composition may include further HIV-derived polypeptide sequences, including, but not limited to, Pol, Tat, Rev, Νef, Vif, Vpr, and/or Vpu sequences. A DΝA prime vaccination is typicaUy performed with the first and second antigenic compositions.
Further DΝA vaccinations with one or more of the antigenic compositions may also be included at selected time intervals. The prime is typicaUy foUowed by at least one boost. The boost may, for example, include adjuvanted HIV-derived polypeptides (e.g., corresponding to those used for the DΝA vaccinations), coding sequences for HIV-derived polypeptides (e.g., corresponding to those used for the DΝA vaccinations) encoded by a viral vector, further DΝA vaccinations, and/or combinations of the foregoing. In one embodiment, a DΝA prime is administered with a first antigenic composition (e.g., a DΝA construct encoding an Envelope polypeptide) and second antigenic composition (e.g., a DΝA construct encoding a Gag polypeptide, a Pol polypeptide, a Tat polypeptide, a Νef polypeptide, and a Rev polypeptide). The DΝA construct for use in the prime may, for example, comprise a CMV promoter operably linked to the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide sequence. The DNA prime is foUowed by a boost, for example, an adjuvanted Envelope polypeptide boost and a viral vector boost (where the viral vector encodes, e.g., a Gag polypeptide, a Pol polypeptide, a Tat polypeptide, a Nef polypeptide, and a Rev polypeptide). Alternately (or in addition), the boost may be an adjuvanted Gag polypeptide, Pol polypeptide, Tat polypeptide, Nef polypeptide, and Rev polypeptide boost and a viral vector boost (where the viral vector encodes, e.g., an Envelope polypeptide). The boost may include aU polypeptide antigens which were encoded in the DNA prime; however, this is not required. Further, different polypeptide antigens may be used in the boost relative to the initial vaccination and visa versa. Further, the initial vaccination may be a viral vector rather than a DNA construct.
Some factors that may be considered in HIV envelope vaccine design are as foUows. Envelope-based vaccines have demonstrated protection against infection in non-human primate models. Passive antibody studies have demonstrated protection against HIV infection in the presence of neutralizing antibodies against the virus chaUenge stock. Vaccines that exclude Env generaUy confer less protective efficacy. Experiments performed in support of the present invention have demonstrated that monomeric gpl20 protein-derived from the SF2 lab strain provided neutralization of HIV-1 lab strains and protection against virus chaUenges in primate models. Primary gpl20 protein derived from Thai E field strains provided cross-subtype neutralization of lab strains. Primary sub-type B ohgomeric o-gpl40 protein provided partial neutralization of subtype B primary (field) isolates. Primary sub-type B o-gpl40ΔV2 DNA prime plus protein boost provided potent neutralization of diverse subtype B primary isolates and protection against virus chaUenge in primate models. Primary sub-type C o-gpl40 and o-gpl40ΔN2 likely provide similar results to those just described for sub-type B.
Vaccine strategies for induction of potent, broadly reactive, neutralizing antibodies may be assisted by construction of Envelope polypeptide structures that expose conserved neutralizing epitopes, for example, variable-region deletions and de- glycosylations, envelope protein-receptor complexes, rational design based on crystal structure (e.g., β-sheet deletions), and gp41-fusion domain based immunogens. Stable CHO ceU lines for envelope protein production have been developed using optimized envelope polypeptide coding sequences, including, but not limited to, the foUowing: gpl20, o-gpl40, gpl20ΔV2, o-gpl40ΔV2, gpl20ΔVlV2, o- gpl40ΔVlV2.
In addition, foUowing prime-boost regimes (such as those described above) appear to be beneficial to help reduce viral load in infected subjects, as weU as possibly slow or prevent progression of HIV-related disease (relative to untreated subjects).
Exemplary antigenic compositions and immunogenicity studies are presented in Examples 9, 10, 11, and 12.
EXPERIMENTAL
Below are examples of specific embodiments for carrying out the present invention. The examples are offered for Ulustrative purposes only, and are not intended to limit the scope of the present invention in any way. Efforts have been made to ensure accuracy with respect to numbers used (e.g., amounts, temperatures, etc.), but some experimental error and deviation should, of course, be aUowed for.
Example 1 Generation of Synthetic Expression Cassettes
A. Generating Synthetic Polynucleotides
The polynucleotide sequences of the present invention were manipulated to maximize expression of their gene products. The order of the foUowing steps may vary. First, the HIV-1 codon usage pattern was modified so that the resulting nucleic acid coding sequence was comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes. The HIV codon usage reflects a high content ofthe nucleotides A or T of the codon-triplet. The effect of the HIV-1 codon usage is a high AT content in the DNA sequence that results in a high AU content in the RNA and in a decreased translation abihty and instability of the mRNA. In comparison, highly expressed human codons prefer the nucleotides G or C. The wUd-type sequences were modified to be comparable to codon usage found in highly expressed human genes.
Second, for some genes non-functional variants were created. In the foUowing table (Table B) mutations affecting the activity of several HIV genes are disclosed.
Table B
Figure imgf000086_0001
Figure imgf000087_0001
Constructs comprising some of these mutations are described herein. Vif, vpr and vpu synthetic constmcts are described. Reducing or eliminating the function of the associated gene products can be accomphshed employing the teachings set forth in the above table, in view of the teachings of the present specification.
In one embodiment of the invention, the fuU length coding region of the Gag- polymerase sequence is included with the synthetic Gag sequences in order to increase the number of epitopes for virus-like particles expressed by the synthetic, optimized Gag expression cassette. Because synthetic HIV-1 Gag-polymerase expresses the potentiaUy deleterious functional enzymes reverse transcriptase (RT) and integrase (INT) (in addition to the structural proteins and protease), it is important to inactivate RT and INT functions. Several in-frame deletions in the RT and INT reading frame can be made to achieve catalytic nonfunctional enzymes with respect to their RT and INT activity. {Jay. A. Levy (Editor) (1995) The Retroviridae, Plenum Press, New York. ISBN 0-306-45033X. Pages 215-20; Grimison, B. and Laurence, J. (1995), Journal Of Acquired Immune Deficiency Syndromes and Human Retrovirology 9(l):58-68; Wakefield, J. K.,et al., (1992) Journal Of Virology 66(11):6806-6812; Esnouf, R.,et al., (1995) Nature Structural Biology 2(4):303-308; Maignan, S., et al., (1998) Journal Of Molecular Biology 282(2):359-368; Katz, R. A. and Skalka, A. M. (1994) Annual Review Of Biochemistry 73 (1994); Jacobo-Molina, A., et al., (1993) Proceedings Of the National Academy Of Sciences Ofthe United States Of America 90(13):632O-6324; Hickman, A. B., et al., (1994) Journal Of Biological Chemistry 269(46):29279-29287; Goldgur, Y., et al., (1998) Proceedings Of the National
Academy Of Sciences Ofthe United States Of America 95(16):9150-9154; Goette, M., et al., (1998) Journal Of Biological Chemistry 273(17): 10139-10146; Gorton, J. L., et al., (1998) Journal of Virology 72(6): 5046-5055; Engelman, A., et al., (1997) Journal Of Virology 71(5):3507-3514; Dyda, F., et al., Science 266(5193):1981-1986; Davies, J. F., et al., (1991) Science 252(5002):88-95; Bujacz, G., et al., (1996) Febs Letters 398(2-3)175-178; Beard, W. A., et al., (1996) Journal Of Biological Chemistry 271(21): 12213-12220; Kohlstaedt, L. A., et al., (1992) Science 256(5065): 1783-1790; Krug, M. S. and Berger, S. L. (1991) Biochemistry 30(44): 10614-10623; Mazumder, A., et al, (1996) Molecular Pharmacology 49(4):621-628; Palaniappan, C, et al., (1997) Journal Of Biological Chemistry
272(17)11157-11164; Rodgers, D. W., et al., (1995) Proceedings Ofthe National Academy Of Sciences Ofthe United States Of America 92(4): 1222- 1226; Sheng, N. and Dennis, D. (1993) Biochemistry 32(18) -.4938-4942; Spence, R. A., et al., (1995) Science 267(5200):988-993.}
Furthermore selected B- and/or T-ceU epitopes can be added to the Gag- polymerase constmcts within the deletions of the RT- and E T-coding sequence to replace and augment any epitopes deleted by the functional modifications of RT and INT. Alternately, selected B- and T-ceU epitopes (including CTL epitopes) from RT and INT can be included in a minimal VLP formed by expression of the synthetic Gag or synthetic GagProt cassette, described above. (For descriptions of known HIV B- and T-ceU epitopes see, HIV Molecular Immunology Database CTL Search Interface; Los Alamos Sequence Compendia, 1987-1997; Internet address: http://hiv- web.lanl.gov/immunology/index.html.)
In another aspect, the present invention comprises Env coding sequences that include, but are not limited to, polynucleotide sequences encoding the foUowing HIV- encoded polypeptides: gpl60, gpl40, and gpl20 (see, e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,792,459 for a description of the HIV-1SF2 ("SF2") Env polypeptide). The relationships between these polypeptides is shown schematicaUy in Figure 3 (in the figure: the polypeptides are indicated as lines, the amino and carboxy termini are indicated on the gpl60 line; the open circle represents the oligomerization domain; the open square represents a transmembrane spanning domain (TM); and "c" represents the location of a cleavage site, in gpl40.mut the "X" indicates that the cleavage site has been mutated such that it no longer functions as a cleavage site). The polypeptide gρl60 includes the coding sequences for gpl20 and gp41. The polypeptide gp41 is comprised of several domains including an oligomerization domain (OD) and a transmembrane spanning domain (TM). In the native envelope, the oligomerization domain is required for the non- covalent association of three gp41 polypeptides to form a trimeric structure: through non-covalent interactions with the gp41 trimer (and itself), the gpl20 polypeptides are also organized in a trimeric structure. A cleavage site (or cleavage sites) exists approximately between the polypeptide sequences for gpl20 and the polypeptide sequences corresponding to gρ41. This cleavage site(s) can be mutated to prevent cleavage at the site. The resulting gpl40 polypeptide corresponds to a truncated form of gpl60 where the transmembrane spanning domain of gp41 has been deleted. This gpl40 polypeptide can exist in both monomeric and ohgomeric (i.e. trimeric) forms by virtue of the presence of the oligomerization domain in the gp41 moiety. In the situation where the cleavage site has been mutated to prevent cleavage and the transmembrane portion of gp41 has been deleted the resulting polypeptide product is designated "mutated" gρl40 (e.g., gpl40.mut). As wiU be apparent to those in the field, the cleavage site can be mutated in a variety of ways. (See, also, WO 00/39302).
WUd-type HIV coding sequences (e.g., Gag, Env, Pol, tat, rev, nef, vpr, vpu, vif, etc.) can be selected from any known HIV isolate and these sequences manipulated to maximize expression of their gene products foUowing the teachings of the present invention. The wUd-type coding region maybe modified in one or more of the foUowing ways. In one embodiment, sequences encoding hypervariable regions of Env, particularly VI and/or V2 were deleted. In other embodiments, mutations were introduced into sequences, for example, encoding the cleavage site in Env to abrogate the enzymatic cleavage of ohgomeric gpl40 into gpl20 monomers. (See, e.g., Earl et al. (1990) PNAS USA 87:648-652; Earl et al. (1991) J. Virol. 65:31-41). In yet other embodiments, hypervariable region(s) were deleted, N-glycosylation sites were removed and/or cleavage sites mutated. As discussed above, different mutations may be introduced into the coding sequences of different genes (see, e.g., Table B). For example, Tat coding sequences were modified according to the teachings of the present specification, for example to affect the transactivation domain of the gene product (e.g., replacing a cystein residue at position 22 with a glycine, Caputo et al. (1996) Gene Therapy 3:235).
To create the synthetic coding sequences of the present invention the gene cassettes are designed to comprise the entire coding sequence of interest. Synthetic gene cassettes are constracted by ohgonucleotide synthesis and PCR amplification to generate gene fragments. Primers are chosen to provide convenient restriction sites for subcloning. The resulting fragments are then hgated to create the entire desired sequence which is then cloned into an appropriate vector. The final synthetic sequences are (i) screened by restriction endonuclease digestion and analysis,(ii) subjected to DNA sequencing in order to confirm that the desired sequence has been obtained and (hi) the identity and integrity of the expressed protein confirmed by SDS- PAGE and Western blotting. The synthetic coding sequences are assembled at Chiron Corp. (EmeryviUe, CA) or by the Midland Certified Reagent Company (Midland, Texas).
Percent identity to the synthetic sequences of the present invention can be determined, for example, using the Smith- Waterman search algorithm (Time Logic, Incline VUlage, NV), with the foUowing exemplary parameters: weight matrix = nuc4x4hb; gap opening penalty = 20, gap extension penalty = 5, reporting threshold = 1 ; ahgnment threshold = 20.
Various forms ofthe different embodiments of the present invention (e.g., constmcts) may be combined.
Exemplary embodiments ofthe synthetic polynucleotides of the present invention include, but are not limited to, the sequences presented in Table C.
Table C Type B Synthetic, Codon Optimized Polynucleotides
Figure imgf000091_0001
Figure imgf000092_0001
Figure imgf000093_0001
Figure imgf000094_0001
Figure imgf000095_0001
{In Table C, .mut or .mut7 or .mut 8 = envelope mutated in ceUular protease cleavage site between gpl20/gp41 (i.e., to prevent cleavage; e.g., better for purifying protein)}
B_ Creating Expression Cassettes Comprising the Synthetic Polynucleotides ofthe Present Invention.
The synthetic DNA fragments of the present invention are cloned into the foUowing expression vectors: pCMVKm2, for transient expression assays and DNA immunization studies, the pCMNKm2 vector was derived from pCMN6a (Chapman et al., Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986) and comprises a kanamycin selectable marker, a CoIEl origin of rephcation, a CMN promoter enhancer and Intron A, foUowed by an insertion site for the synthetic sequences described below foUowed by a polyadenylation signal derived from bovine growth hormone ~ the pCMVKπώ vector differs from the pCMV-link vector only in that a polylinker site was inserted into pCMNKπώ to generate pCMN-link; pESΝ2dhfr and pCMNPLEdhfr (also known as pCMNIII), for expression in Chinese Hamster Ovary (CHO) ceUs; and, pAcC13, a shuttle vector for use in the Baculovirus expression system (ρAcC13, was derived from pAcC12 which was described by Munemitsu S., et al., Mol Cell Biol. 10(11):5977-5982, 1990). See, also co-owned WO 00/39302, WO 00/39303, WO 00/39304, and WO 02/04493, for a description of these vectors. Briefly, construction of pCMVPLEdhfr (pCMNIfl) was as foUows. To construct a DHFR cassette, the EMCV IRES (internal ribosome entry site) leader was PCR-amplified from pCite-4a+ (Νovagen, Inc., MUwaukee, WI) and inserted into pET-23d (Νovagen, Inc., MUwaukee, WI) as an Xba-Nco fragment to give pET- EMCV. The dhfr gene was PCR-amplified from pESΝ2dhfr to give a product with a Gly-Gly-Gly-Ser spacer in place of the translation stop codon and inserted as an Nco- BamHl fragment to give pET-E-DHFR. Next, the attenuated neo gene was PCR amplified from a pS V2Neo (Clontech, Palo Alto, CA) derivative and inserted into the unique R Hl site of pET-E-DHFR to give pET-E-DHFR/Neo(m2). Then, the bovine growth hormone terminator from pCDNA3 (Invitrogen, Inc., Carlsbad, CA) was inserted downstream ofthe neo gene to give pET-E-DHFR/Neo(m2)BGHt. The EMCV-dhfr/neo selectable marker cassette fragment was prepared by cleavage of pET-E-DHFR/Neo(ra2)BGHt. The CMV enhancer/promoter plus Intron A was transferred frompCMVδa (Chapman et al, Nuc. Acids Res. (1991) 19:3979-3986) as a HindϊϊT-Sall fragment into pUC19 (New England Biolabs, Inc., Beverly, MA). The vector backbone of pUC19 was deleted from the Ndel to the Sapl sites. The above described DHFR cassette was added to the construct such that the EMCV IRES foUowed the CMV promoter to produce the final construct. The vector also contained an ampr gene and an S V40 origin of rephcation. Expression vectors of the present invention contain one or more of the synthetic coding sequences disclosed herein, e.g., shown in the Figures. When the expression cassette contains more than one coding sequence the coding sequences may aU be in-frame to generate one polyprotein; alternately, the more than one polypeptide coding sequences may comprise a polycistronic message where, for example, an IRES is placed 5' to each polypeptide coding sequence.
Example 2 Expression Assays for the Synthetic Coding Sequences The wUd-type sequences are cloned into expression vectors having the same features as the vectors into which the synthetic HIV-derived sequences were cloned. Expression efficiencies for various vectors carrying the wUd-type (any known isolated) and corresponding synthetic sequence(s) are evaluated as foUows. CeUs from several mammahan ceU lines (293, RD, COS-7, and CHO; aU obtained from the American Type Culture CoUection, 10801 University Boulevard, Manassas, VA 20110-2209) are transfected with 2 μg of DNA in transfection reagent LTl (PanVera Corporation, 545 Science Dr., Madison, WI). The ceUs are incubated for 5 hours in reduced serum medium (Opti-MEM, Gibco-BRL, Gaithersburg, MD). The medium is then replaced with normal medium as foUows: 293 ceUs, IMDM, 10% fetal calf semm, 2% glutamine (BioWhittaker, WalkersvUle, MD); RD and COS-7 ceUs, D-MEM, 10% fetal calf seram, 2% glutamine (Opti-MEM, Gibco-BRL, Gaithersburg, MD); and
CHO ceUs, Ham's F-12, 10% fetal calf serum, 2% glutamine (Opti-MEM, Gibco-BRL, Gaithersburg, MD). The ceUs are incubated for either 48 or 60 hours. Supematants are harvested and filtered through 0.45 μm syringe filters and, optionaUy, stored at - 20°C. Supematants are evaluated using the Coulter p24-assay (Coulter Corporation,
Hialeah, FL, US), using 96-weU plates coated with a suitable monoclonal antibody directed against an HIV antigen (e.g, a murine monoclonal directed again an HIV core antigen). The appropriate HIV antigen binds to the coated weUs and biotinylated antibodies against HIV recognize the bound antigen. Conjugated strepavidin- horseradish peroxidase reacts with the biotin. Color develops from the reaction of peroxidase with TMB substrate. The reaction is terminated by addition of 4N H2SO4. The intensity of the color is directly proportional to the amount of HIV antigen in a sample.
Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) ceUs are also transfected with plasmid DNA encoding the synthetic HIV polypeptides described herein (e.g., pESN2dhfr or pCMViπ vector backbone) using Mi us TransIT-LTl polyamine transfection reagent (Pan Vera) according to the manufacturers instructions and incubated for 96 hours. After 96 hours, media is changed to selective media (F12 special with 250 μg/ml G418) and ceUs are split 1:5 and incubated for an additional 48 hours. Media is changed every 5-7 days until colonies start forming at which time the colonies are picked, plated into 96 weU plates and screened by Capture ELISA. Positive clones are expanded in 24 weU plates and are screened several times for HIV protein production by Capture ELISA, as described above. After reaching confluency in 24 weU plates, positive clones are expanded to T25 flasks (Corning, Corning, NY). These are screened several times after confluency and positive clones are expanded to T75 flasks. Positive T75 clones are frozen in LN2 and the highest expressing clones are amplified with 0-5 μM methotrexate (MTX)at several concentrations and plated in 100mm culture dishes. Plates are screened for colony formation and aU positive closed are again expanded as described above. Clones are expanded an amplified and screened at each step capture ELISA. Positive clones are frozen at each methotrexate level. Highest producing clones are grown in perfusion bioreactors (3L, 100L) for expansion and adaptation to low serum suspension culture conditions for scale-up to larger bioreactors.
Data from experiments performed in support ofthe present invention show that the synthetic HIV expression cassettes provided dramatic increases in production of their protein products, relative to the native (wUd-type) sequences, when expressed in a variety of ceU lines and that stably transfected CHO ceU lines, which express the desired HIV polypeptide(s), may be produced. Production of HIV polypeptides using CHO ceUs provides (i) correct glycosylation patterns and protein conformation (as determined by binding to panel of MAbs); (ii) correct binding to CD4 receptor molecules; (hi) absence of non-mammahan ceU contaminants (e.g., insect viruses and/or ceUs); and (iv) ease of purification.
Example 3 Western Blot Analysis of Expression Western blot analysis of ceUs transfected with the HIV expression cassettes described herein are performed essentiaUy as described in co-owned WO 00/39302. Briefly, human 293 ceUs are transfected as described in Example 2 with pCMV6a- based vectors containing native or synthetic HIV expression cassettes. CeUs are cultivated for 60 hours post-transfection. Supematants are prepared as described. CeU lysates are prepared as foUows. The ceUs are washed once with phosphate- buffered saline, lysed with detergent [1% NP40 (Sigma Chemical Co., St. Louis, MO) in 0.1 M Tris-HCI, pH 7.5], and the lysate transferred into fresh tubes. SDS- polyacrylamide gels (pre-cast 8-16%; Novex, San Diego, CA) are loaded with 20 μl of supernatant or 12.5 μl of ceU lysate. A protein standard is also loaded (5 μl, broad size range standard; BioRad Laboratories, Hercules, CA). Electrophoresis is carried out and the proteins are transferred using a BioRad Transfer Chamber (BioRad
Laboratories, Hercules, CA) to ImmobUon P membranes (Millipore Corp., Bedford, MA) using the transfer buffer recommended by the manufacturer (Millipore), where the transfer is performed at 100 volts for 90 minutes. The membranes are exposed to HIV-1 -positive human patient serum and immunostained using o-phenylenediamine dihydrochloride (OPD; Sigma).
The results of the immunoblotting analysis are used to show that ceUs containing the synthetic HIV expression cassette produce the expected HIV- polypeptide(s) at higher per-ceU concentrations than ceUs containing the native expression cassette.
Example 4 In Vivo Immunogenicity of Synthetic HIN Expression Cassettes A. Immunization
To evaluate the immunogenicity of the synthetic HIN expression cassettes, a mouse study may be performed. The plasmid DΝA, e.g., pCMNKM2 carrying an expression cassette comprising a synthetic sequence of the present invention, is dUuted to the foUowing final concentrations in a total injection volume of 100 μl: 20 μg, 2 μg, 0.2 μg, and 0.02 μg. To overcome possible negative dilution effects of the dUuted DΝA, the total DΝA concentration in each sample is brought up to 20 μg using the vector (pCMVKM2) alone. As a control, plasmid DΝA comprising an expression cassette encoding the native, corresponding polypeptide is handled in the same manner. Twelve groups of four Balb/c mice (Charles River, Boston, MA) are intramuscularly immunized (50 μl per leg, intramuscular injection into the tϊbialis anterior) using varying dosages. R Humoral Immune Response
The humoral immune response is checked with a suitable anti-HIN antibody ELIS As (enzyme-linked immunosorbent assays) of the mice sera 0 and 4 weeks post immunization (groups 5-12) and, in addition, 6 and 8 weeks post immunization, respectively, 2 and 4 weeks post second immunization (groups 1-4).
The antibody titers of the sera are determined by anti-HIV antibody ELISA. Briefly, sera from immunized mice were screened for antibodies directed against an appropriate HIV protein (e.g., HIV p55 for Gag). ELISA microtiter plates are coated with 0.2 μg of HIV protein per weU overnight and washed four times; subsequently, blocking is done with PBS-0.2% Tween (Sigma) for 2 hours. After removal of the blocking solution, 100 μl of dUuted mouse semm is added. Sera are tested at 1/25 dUutions and by serial 3-fold dUutions, thereafter. Microtiter plates are washed four times and incubated with a secondary, peroxidase-coupled anti-mouse IgG antibody (Pierce, Rockford, IL). ELISA plates are washed and 100 μl of 3, 3', 5, 5'-tetramethyl benzidine (TMB; Pierce) was added per weU. The optical density of each weU is measured after 15 minutes. The titers reported are the reciprocal of the dUution of serum that gave a half-maximum optical density (O.D.).
The results of the mouse immunizations with plasmid-DΝAs are used to show that the synthetic expression cassettes provide improvement of immunogenicity relative to the native expression cassettes. Also, the second boost immunization induces a secondary immune response after two weeks (groups 1-3).
C CeUular Immune Response
The frequency of specific cytotoxic T-lymphocytes (CTL) is evaluated by a standard chromium release assay of peptide pulsed Balb/c mouse CD4 ceUs. HIV protein-expressing vaccinia virus infected CD-8 ceUs are used as a positive control (vv- protein). Briefly, spleen ceUs (Effector ceUs, E) are obtained from the BALB/c mice (immunized as described above). The ceUs are cultured, restimulated, and assayed for CTL activity against, e.g., Gag peptide-pulsed target ceUs as described (Doe, B., and Walker, CM., AIDS 10(7):793-794, 1996). Cytotoxic activity is measured in a standard 51Cr release assay. Target (T) ceUs are cultured with effector (E) ceUs at various E:T ratios for 4 hours and the average cpm from duphcate weUs is used to calculate percent specific 51Cr release.
Cytotoxic T-ceU (CTL) activity is measured in splenocytes recovered from the mice immunized with HIV DNA constructs described herein. Effector ceUs firom the DNA-immunized animals exhibit specific lysis of HIV peptide-pulsed S V-B ALB (MHC matched) targets ceUs indicative of a CTL response. Target ceUs that are peptide-pulsed and derived from an MHC-unmatched mouse strain (MC57) are not lysed. The results of the CTL assays are used to show increased potency of synthetic HIV expression cassettes for induction of cytotoxic T-lymphocyte (CTL) responses by DNA immunization.
Example 5 In Vivo Immunogenicity of Synthetic HIV Expression Cassettes A;. General Immunization Methods To evaluate the immunogenicity of the synthetic HIV expression cassettes, studies using guinea pigs, rabbits, mice, rhesus macaques and baboons are performed. The studies are typicaUy structured as foUows: DNA immunization alone (single or multiple); DNA immunization foUowed by protein immunization (boost); DNA immunization foUowed by Sindbis particle immunization; immunization by Sindbis particles alone.
B. Guinea Pigs
Experiments may be performed using guinea pigs as foUows. Groups comprising six guinea pigs each are immunized intramuscularly or mucosaUy at 0, 4, and 12 weeks with plasmid DNAs encoding expression cassettes comprising one or more the sequences described herein. The animals are subsequently boosted at approximately 18 weeks with a single dose (intramuscular, intradermaUy or mucosaUy) of the HIV protein encoded by the sequence(s) of the plasmid boost and/or other HIV proteins. Antibody titers (geometric mean titers) are measured at two weeks foUowing the third DNA immunization and at two weeks after the protein boost. These results are used to demonstrate the usefulness of the synthetic constructs to generate immune responses, as weU as, the advantage of providing a protein boost to enhance the immune response foUowing DNA immunization.
C. Rabbits Experiments may be performed using rabbits as foUows. Rabbits are immunized intramuscularly, mucosaUy, or intradermaUy (using a Bioject needless syringe) with plasmid DNAs encoding the HIV proteins described herein. The nucleic acid immunizations are foUowed by protein boosting after the initial immunization. TypicaUy, constructs comprising the synthetic HlV-polypeptide-encoding polynucleotides of the present invention are highly immunogenic and generate substantial antigen binding antibody responses after only 2 immunizations in rabbits.
D. Humoral Immune Response
In any immunized animal model, the humoral immune response is checked in seram specimens from the immunized animals with an anti-HIV antibody ELISAs (enzyme-linked immunosorbent assays) at various times post-immunization. The antibody titers of the sera are determined by anti-HIV antibody ELISA as described above. Briefly, sera from immunized animals are screened for antibodies directed against the HIV polypeptide/protein(s) encoded by the DNA and/or polypeptide used to immunize the animals. WeUs of ELISA microtiter plates are coated overnight with the selected HZY porypeptide/protein and washed four times; subsequently, blocking is done with PBS-0.2% Tween (Sigma) for 2 hours. After removal of the blocking solution, 100 μl of dUuted mouse serum is added. Sera are tested at 1/25 dUutions and by serial 3-fold dUutions, thereafter. Microtiter plates are washed four times and incubated with a secondary, peroxidase-coupled anti-mouse IgG antibody (Pierce, Rockford, L). ELISA plates are washed and 100 μl of 3, 3', 5, 5'-tetramethyl benzidine (TMB; Pierce) was added per weU. The optical density of each weU is measured after 15 minutes. Titers are typicaUy reported as the reciprocal of the dUution of serum that gave a hatf-maximum optical density (O.D.). CeUular immune response may also be evaluated. Example 6
DNA-immunization of Baboons and Rhesus Macaques Using Expression Cassettes
Comprising the Synthetic HIV Polynucleotides ofthe Present Invention
A. Baboons Four baboons are immunized 3 times (weeks 0, 4 and 8) bhateraUy, intramuscular into the quadriceps or mucosaUy using the gene dehvery vehicles described herein. The animals are bled two weeks after each immunization and an HTV antibody ELISA is performed with isolated plasma. The ELISA is performed essentiaUy as described above except the second antibody-conjugate is an anti-human IgG, g-chain specific, peroxidase conjugate (Sigma Chemical Co., St. Louis, MD 63178) used at a dilution of 1 :500. Fifty μg/ml yeast extract may be added to the dUutions of plasma samples and antibody conjugate to reduce non-specific background due to preexisting yeast antibodies in the baboons. Lymphoproliferative responses to are observed in baboons two weeks post-fourth immunization (at week 14), and enhanced substantiaUy post-boosting with HIV-polypeptide (at week 44 and 76). Such proliferation results are indicative of induction of T-helper ceU functions.
B. Rhesus Macaques
The improved potency of the synthetic, codon-modified H/V-polypeptide encoding polynucleotides of the present invention, when constracted into expression plasmids may be confirmed in rhesus macaques. TypicaUy, the macaques have detectable ΗIN-specific CTL after two or three 1 mg doses of modified HIV polynucleotide. In sum, these results demonstrate that the synthetic ΗIV DNA is immunogenic in non-human primates. Neutralizing antibodies may also detected.
Example 7 Co-Transfection of Monocistronic and Multicistronic Constructs The present invention includes co-transfection with multiple, monocistronic expression cassettes, as weU as, co-transfection with one or more multi-cistronic expression cassettes, or combinations thereof. Such constmcts, in a variety of combinations, may be transfected into 293T ceUs for transient transfection studies.
For example, a bicistronic construct may be made where the coding sequences for the different HIV polypeptides are under the control of a single CMV promoter and, between the two coding sequences, an IRES (internal ribosome entry site (EMCV IRES); Kozak, M., Critical Reviews in Biochemistry and Molecular Biology 27(45):385-402, 1992; WithereU, G.W., et al, Virology 214:660-663, 1995) sequence is introduced after the first HIV coding sequence and before the second HIV coding sequence. Supematants coUected from ceU culture are tested for the presence of the HIV proteins and indicate that appropriate proteins are expressed in the transfected ceUs (e.g., if an Env coding sequence was present the corresponding Env protein was detected; if a Gag coding sequence was present the corresponding Gag protein was detected, etc). The production of chimeric VLPs by these ceU hnes may be determined using electron microscopic analysis. (See, e.g., co-owned WO 00/39302).
Example 8 Accessory gene components for an HIV-1 vaccine: functional analysis of mutated Tat. Rev and Nef Type C antigens
The HIV-1 regulatory and accessory genes have received increased attention as components of HIV vaccines due to their role in viral pathogenesis, the high ratio of highly conserved CTL epitopes and their early expression in the viral life cycle. Because of various undesirable properties of these genes, questions regarding their safety and suitabUity as vaccine components have been raised. Experiments performed in support ofthe present invention have analyzed candidate HIV-1 subtype C tat, rev, and nef mutants for efficient expression and inactivation of potential deleterious functions. Other HIV subtype accessory genes may be evaluated simUarly.
Sequence-modified, mutant tat, rev, and e genes coding for consensus Tat, Rev and Nef proteins of South African HIV-1 subtype C were constructed using overlapping synthetic ohgonucleotides and PCR-based site-directed mutagenesis. Constructs of the wUd-type genes of the isolates closely resembling the respective consensus sequences were also made by PCR. In vitro expression of the constructs was analyzed by western blotting. The trans-activation activity ofthe Tat mutants and nuclear RNA export activity of the Rev mutants were studied after transfection of various ceU lines using reporter-gene-based functionality assays.
In vitro expression of aU constmcts was demonstrated by western blotting using antigen specific mouse semm generated by DNA vaccination of mice with Tat, Rev, or Nef-expression plasmids. Expression levels of the sequence-modified genes were significantly higher than the wUd-type genes. Subtype B and C Tat cDNA was mutated to get TatC22, TatC37, and
TatC22/37. Tat activity assays in three ceU hnes (RD, HeLa and 293). In the background of the subtype C consensus Tat, a single mutation at C22 was insufficient to inactivate LTR-dependent CAT expression. In contrast, this activity was significantly impaired in RD, 293 and HeLa ceUs using the single mutation, C37, or the double mutation, C22C37 (see Table B). Corresponding results were obtained for Tat mutants derived from subtype B strains.
Exemplary results are presented in Figure 4 for transactivation activity of Tat mutants on LTR-CAT plasmid in 293 ceUs. Three independent assays were performed for each construct (Figure 4, legend (1), (2), (3)). The subtype C constructs TatC22ProtRTTatRevNef and
ProtRTTatC22RevNef showed reduced Tat activity when compared to TatC22 alone, probably due to structural changes caused by the fusion protein.
For Rev constructs, to test for the loss of function, a CAT assay with a reporter plasmid including native or mutated Rev was used. As shown in Figure 5, compared to wUd-type Rev, the mRNA export function ofthe subtype C Rev with a double mutation, M5M10 (see Table B), was significantly lower. The background levels are shown in the "mock" data and the pDM128 reporter plasmid without Rev data. Two independent assays were performed for each constmct (Figure 5, legend
(1), (2)). Assays to measure Nef-specific functions may also be performed (Nef mutations are described in Table B). For example, FACs analysis is used to look for the presence of MHC 1 and CD4 on ceU surfaces. CeUs are assayed in the presence and absence of Nef expression (for controls), as weU as using the synthetic polynucleotides of the present invention that encode native nef protein and mutated nef protein. Down-regulation of MHC 1 and CD4 expression indicates that the nef gene product is not functional, i.e., if nef is non-functional there is no down regulation.
These data demonstrate the impaired functionality of tat and rev DNA i munogens that may form part of a multi-component HIV-1 subtype C vaccine. In contrast to previous pubhshed data by other groups, the C22 mutation did not sufficiently inactivate the transactivation function of Tat. The C37 mutation appeared to be required for inactivation of subtype C and subtype B Tat proteins.
Example 9 Evaluation of immunogenicity of various HIV polypeptide encoding plasmids As noted above, the immunogenicity of any of the polynucleotides or expression cassettes described herein is readUy evaluated. In the foUowing table (Table D) are exemplified procedures involving a comparison of the hnmunogenicity of subtype B and C envelope plasmids, both individuaUy and as a mixed-subtype vaccine, using electroporation, in rabbits. It wUl be apparent that such methods are equaUy apphcable to any other HIV polypeptide.
Table D
Figure imgf000106_0001
Figure imgf000107_0001
Figure imgf000108_0001
Figure imgf000109_0001
The MF59C adjuvant is a microfluidized emulsion containing 5% squalene, 0.5% tween 80, 0.5% span 85, in lOmM citrate pH 6, stored in lOmL ahquots at 4°C.
Immunogens are prepared as described in the foUowing table (Table E) for administration to animals in the various groups. Concentrations may vary from those described in the table, for example depending on the sequences and/or proteins being used.
Table E
Group Preparation
1-9 Immunization 1-3: pCMV and pSIN based plasmid DNA in Saline + Electroporation
Subtype B and C plasmids wiU be provided frozen at a concentration of l.Omg/ml in sterUe 0.9% saline. Store at -80°C until use. Thaw DNA at room temperature; the material should be clear or slightly opaque, with no particulate matter. Animals wiU be shaved prior to immunization, under sedation of lx dose IP (by animal weight) of Ketarnine-Xylazine (80mg/ml - 4mg/ml). Immunize each rabbit with 0.5ml DNA mixture per side (EVl/Quadriceps), 1.0ml per animal. FoUow the DNA injection with Electroporation using a 6-needle circular array with 1cm diameter, 1cm needle length. Electroporation pulses were given at 20V/mm, 50ms pulse length, 1 pulse/s.
Immunization 3: Protein Immunization
Proteins wiU be provided at 0. lmg/ml in citrate buffer. Store at -80°C untU use. Thaw at room temperature; material should be clear with no particulate matter. Add equal volume of MF59C adjuvant to thawed protein and mix well by inverting the tube. Immunize each rabbit with 0.5ml adjuvanted protein per side, IM/Glut for a total of 1.0ml per animal. Use material within 1 hour of the addition of adjuvant.
Immunization 1-3: Combined subtype B and C plasmid DNA in Saline
The immunogen wiU be provided at 2.0mg/ml total DNA (lmg/ml of each plasmid) in sterile 0.9% saline. Store at -80°C until use. Thaw DNA at room temperature; the material should be clear or slightly opaque, with no particulate matter. Animals wiU be shaved prior to immunization, under sedation of lx dose IP (by animal weight) of Ketarnine-Xylazine (80mg/ml - 4mg/ml). Immunize each rabbit with 0.5ml DNA mixture per side (IM/Quadriceps), 1.0ml per animal. FoUow the DNA injection with Electroporation using a 6-needle circular array with 1cm diameter, 1cm needle length. Electroporation pulses were given at 20V/mm, 50ms pulse length, 1 pulse/s. Group Preparation
10-11 Immunization 3: Protein Immunization
Proteins wUl be provided at 0. lmg/ml in citrate buffer. Store at -80°C until use. Thaw at room temperature; material should be clear with no particulate matter. Add equal volume of MF59C adjuvant to thawed protein and mix well by inverting the tube. Immunize each rabbit with 0.5ml adjuvanted protein per side, EVI/Glut for a total of 1.0ml per animal. Use material within 1 hour ofthe addition of adjuvant.
The immunization (Table F) and bleeding (Table G) schedules are as foUows:
Ό
u
Figure imgf000111_0001
Example 10 Mice Immunization Studies with Gag and Pol Constructs CeUular and Humoral immune responses were evaluated in mice (essentiaUy as described in Example 4) for the foUowing constructs: Gag, GagProtease(+FS) (GP1, protease codon optimized and inactivation of INS; GP2, protease only inactivation of INS), GagPolΔintegrase with frameshift (gagFSpol), and GagPolΔintegrase in-frame (GagPol) (see Figure 63). Versions of GagPolΔintegrase in-frame were also designed with attenuated (GagPolAtt) or non-functional Protease (GagPoUna).
In vitro expression data showed comparable expression of p55Gag and p66RT using Gag alone, GagProtease(+FS), GagFSpol and GagPoUna. Constructs with fuUy functional or attenuated protease (GagPol or GagPolAtt) were less efficient in expression of p55Gag and p66RT, possibly due to cytotoxic effects of protease.
DNA immunization of mice using Gag vs. GP1 and GP2 in pCMV vectors was performed intramuscularly in the tibiahs anterior. Mice were immunized at the start of the study (0 week) and 4 weeks later. Bleeds were performed at 0, 4, and 6 weeks. DNA doses used were as foUows: 20 μg, 2 μg, 0.2 μg, and 0.02 μg.
DNA immunization of mice using Gag vs. gagFSpol in pCMV vectors was performed intramuscularly in the tibiahs anterior. Mice were immunized at the start of the study (0 week) and chaUenged 4 weeks later with recombinant vaccinia virus encoding Gag (rNVgag). Bleeds were performed at 0 and 4 weeks. DΝA doses used were as foUows: 20 μg, 2 μg, 0.2 μg, and 0.02 μg.
DΝA immunization of mice using Gag vs. gagFSpol and gagpol in pCMN vectors was performed intramuscularly in the tibiahs anterior. Mice were immunized at the start of the study (0 week) and chaUenged 4 weeks later with recombinant vaccinia virus encoding Gag (rNNgag). Bleeds were performed at 0 and 4 weeks. DΝA doses used were as foUows: 2 μg, 0.2 μg, 0.02 μg, and 0.002 μg.
CeUular immune responses against Gag were comparable for aU tested variants, for example, Gag, GagProtease, gagFSpol and GagPoUna aU had comparable potencies. Humoral immune responses to Gag were also comparable with the exception of
GP2 and especiaUy GP1. Humoral immune responses were weaker in constructs comprising functional or attenuated proteases which may be due to less efficient secretion of p55Gag caused by overactive protease.
In vitro and in vivo experiments, performed in support ofthe present invention, suggest that the expression and immunogenicity of Gag was comparable with aU constructs. Exceptions were GagPol in-frame with fully functional or attenuated protease. This may be the result of cytotoxic effects of protease. The immune response in mice correlated with relative levels of expression in vitro.
Example 11 Protein Expression, Immunogenicity, and Generation of Neutralizing Antibodies Using
Type C Derived Envelope Polypeptides Envelope (Env) vaccines derived from the subtype C primary isolate, TVl, recovered from a South African individual, were tested in rabbits as foUows. Gene cassettes were designed to express the gpl20 (surface antigen), g l40 (surface antigen plus ectodomain of transmembrane protein, gp41), and fuU-length (gpl20 plus gp41) gpl60 forms of the HIV-1 envelope polyprotein with and without deletions of the variable loop regions, V2 and VI V2. AU of the genes were sequence-modified to enhance expression of the encoded Env glycoproteins in a Rev-independent fashion and they were subsequently cloned into pCMV-based plasmid vectors for DNA vaccine and protein production apphcations as described above. The sequences were codon optimized as described herein. Briefly, aU the modified envelope genes were cloned into the Chiron pCMVlink plasmid vector, preferably into EcoRI/XhoI sites.
A. Protein Expression FuU-length (gpl60), truncated gρl40 (Env ectodomain only) and gpl20 native versions of the TVl Env antigen were produced from the expression cassettes described herein. The gpl40 encoding sequences were transiently transfected into 293T ceUs. The expression levels of the gene products were evaluated by an in-house antigen capture ELISA. Envelope genes constructed from the native sequences of TV001c8.2, TV001c8.5 and TV002cl2.1 expressed the correct proteins in vitro, with gpl40TV001c8.2 exhibiting the highest level of expression. In addition, the Env protein expressed from the TVl -derived clone 8.2 was found to bind the CD4 receptor protein indicating that this feature of the expressed protein is maintained in a functional conformation. The receptor binding properties/ranctionality of the expressed TVl gpl60 protein result was also confirmed by a ceU-fusion assay. Total expression increased approximately 10-fold for synthetic gpl40 constructs compared with the native gpl40 gene cassettes. Both the modified gpl20 and gpl40 variants secreted high amounts of protein in the supernatant. In addition, the V2 and VI V2 deleted forms of gpl40 expressed approximately 2-fold more protein than the intact gρl40. OveraU, the expression levels of synthetic gpl40 gene variants increased 10 to 26-fold compared with the gpl40 gene with native sequences. In sum, each synthetic construct tested showed more than 10-fold increased levels of expression relative to those using the native coding sequences. Moreover, aU expressed proteins were of the expected molecular weights and were shown to bind CD4. Stable CHO ceU lines were derived and small-scale protein purification methods were used to produce smaU quantities of each of the undeleted and V-deleted ohgomeric forms (o-gpl40) of these proteins for vaccine studies.
B. Neutralization properties of TVOOl and TV002 viral isolates
The transient expression experiment showed that the envelope genes derived from the TVOOl and TV002 virus isolates expressed the desired protein products. Relative neutralization sensitivities of these two viral strains using sera from 18 infected South African individuals (subtypes B and C) were as foUows. At a 1:10 serum dUution, the TV2 strain was neutralized by 18 of 18 sera; at 1:50, 16 of 18; at 1:250, 15/18. In comparison, the TVl isolate was neutralized by 15 of 18 at 1:10; only 6 of 18 at 1:50; and none ofthe specimens at 1:250. In addition, the TVOOl patient serum showed neutralization activity against the TV002 isolate at aU dUutions tested. In contrast, the TV002 showed neutralization of TVOOl only at the 1:10 serum dUution. These results suggest that TVOOl isolate is capable of inducing a broader and more potent neutralizing antibody response in its infected host than TV002. C. Immunogenicity of the modified TVl Env DNA and protein antigens in rabbit studies
TVl Env DNA (comprising the synthetic expression cassettes) and protein vaccines were administrated as shown in the foUowing Table H.
Table H
Figure imgf000115_0001
Seven groups of 4 rabbits per group were immunized with the designated plasmid DNA and ohgomeric Env protein antigens. Three doses of DNA, lmg of DNA per animal per immunization, were administrated intramuscularly by needle injection foUowed by electroporation on weeks 0, 4, and 20 weeks. A single dose of 100 ug of Env protein in MF59 adjuvant also was given intramuscularly in a separate site at 20 weeks.
The DNA immunization used subtype C sequence-modified genes (TVl) — gpl60, gpl60dV2, gpl60dVlV2, gpl40, gpl40dV2 and gpl40dVlV2 - as weU as a subtype B SF162 sequence modified gpl40dV2. DNA immunizations were performed at 0, 4, and 20 weeks by needle injection by the intramuscular route using electroporation to facilitate transfection ofthe muscle ceUs and of resident antigen presenting ceUs.
A single Env protein booster (in MF59 adjuvant) was given at 20 weeks by intramuscular injection at a separate site. Antibody titers were evaluated by ELISA foUowing each successive immunization. Serum specimens were coUected at 0, 4, 6, 8, 12, 22, and 24 weeks. Serum antibody titers were measured on ELISA. 96-weU plates were coated with a protein in a concentration of lug/ml. Serum samples were diluted seriaUy 3-fold. Goat anti-rabbit peroxidase conjugate (1:20,000) was used for detection. TMB was used as the substrate, and the antibody titers were read at 0.6 OD at 450nm.
Neutralizing antibody responses against PBMC-grown R5 HIV-1 strains were monitored in the sera coUected from the immunized rabbits using two different assays in two different laboratories, the 5.25 reporter ceU-line based assay at Chiron and the PBMC-based assay of David Montefiori at Duke University. Results are shown in Figures 66, 67, and 68. The Chiron assay was conducted essentiaUy as foUows. Neutralizing antibody responses against the PBMC-grown subtype C TVOOl and TV002 strains were measured using an in-house reporter ceU line assay that uses the 5.25 ceU line. This ceU has CD4, CCR5, CXCR4 and BONZO receptor/co-receptors on its ceU membrane. The parental CEM ceU line was derived from a 4-year-old Caucasian female with acute lymphoblastic leukemia, which was fused with the human B ceU line 721.174, creating CEMxl74. LTR-GFP was transfected into the ceUs after the CCR5 gene (about 1.1 kb) was cloned into the BamH-I (5') and Sal-I (3') ofthe pBABE puro retroviral vector, and subsequently introduced into the CEMxl74. The green fluorescence protein (GFP) of the cells was detected by flow cytometer (FACScan). For the virus neutralization assay, 50 ul of titrated virus and 50 ul of diluted immune or pre-immune serum were incubated at room temperature for one hour. This mixture was added into wells with lOVml ceUs plated in a 24 weU plate, and incubated at 37°C for 5 to 7 days. The cells were then fixed with 2% of formaldehyde after washing with PBS. Fifteen thousand events (ceUs) were coUected for each sample on a Becton Dickinson FACScan using CeUquest software. The data presented were the mean of the triphcate weUs. The percent neutralization was calculated compared to the virus control using the foUowing equation: % virus Inhibition = (virus control- experimental)/( virus control -ceU control) x 100. Any virus inhibition observed in the pre-bleed has been subtracted for each individual animal. Values >50% are considered positive and are highlighted in gray.
In Figure 67, the "#" indicates that animals had high levels of virus inhibition in pre-bleed serum (>20% virus inhibition) that impacted the magnitude ofthe observed inhibition and in some cases, our ability to score the serum as a positive or negative for the presence of significant neutralizing antibody activity (< 50% inhibition). For the data presented in Figure 68, serum samples were coUected after a single protein boost (post-third) were screened in triphcate at a 1:8 dUution with virus (1:24 after addition of ceUs). Values shown are the % reduction in p24 synthesis relative to that in the corresponding pre-bleed control samples. Zero values indicate no or negative values were measured. NV, not vahd due to virus inhibition in pre- immune serum. Neutralization was considered positive when p24 was reduced by at least 80%; these samples are highlighted in dark gray. Sample with lighter gray shading showed at least a 50% reduction in ρ24 synthesis.
Figure 64 shows the ELISA data when plates were coated with the monomeric gpl20.TVl protein. This protein is homologous to the subtype C genes used for the immunization. AU immunization groups produced high antibody titers after the second DNA immunization. The groups immunized with gpl40 forms of DNA have relatively higher geometric mean antibody titers as compared to the groups using gpl60 forms after both first and second DNA immunizations. Both the gpl40.TVl and gpl40dVl V2.TV1 genes produced high antibody titers at about 104 at two weeks post second DNA; the gpl40dV2.TVl plasmid yielded the highest titers of antibodies (>104) at this time point and aU others.. The binding antibody titers to the gpl20.TVl protein were higher for the group immunized with the homologous gpl40dV2.TVl genes than that with the heterologous gpl40dV2.SF162 gene which showed titers of about 103. AU the groups, showed some decline in antibody titers by 8 weeks post the second DNA immunization. FoUowing the DNA plus protein booster at 20 weeks, aU groups reached titers above that previously observed after the second DNA immunization (0. 5 -1.0 log increases were observed). After the protein boost, aU animals receiving the o-gpl40dN2.TNl protein whether primed by the gpl40dV2.TVl or gpl60dV2.TVl DΝA, showed the highest Ab titers.
Binding antibody titers were also measured using ELISA plates coated with either ohgomeric subtype C o-gpl40dN2.TNl or subtype B o-gpl40dN2.SF162 proteins (Figure 65). For aU the TVl Env immunized groups, the antibody titers measured using the ohgomeric protein, o-gpl40dV2.TVl were higher than those measured using the monomeric (non-V2-deleted) protein, gpl20.TNl. In fact, for these groups, the titers observed with the heterologous subtype B o-gpl40dN2.SF162 ,. _ _ _ ^
protein were comparable to or greater than those measured with the subtype C TNI g l20. Nevertheless, aU groups immunized with subtype C immunogens showed higher titers binding to the subtype C o-gpl40dV2.TVl protein than to the subtype B protein g l40dN2.SF162. Conversely, the group immunized with the gpl40dN2.SF162 immunogen showed higher antibody titers with the ohgomeric subtype B protein relative its subtype C counterpart. OveraU, all three assays demonstrated that high antibody cross-reactive antibodies were generated by the subtype CTN1 -based DΝA and protein immunogens.
The results indicate that the subtype C TNI -derived Env DΝA and protein antigens are immunogenic inducing high titers of antibodies in immunized rabbits and substantial evidence of neutralizing antibodies against both subtype B and subtype C R5 virus strains. In particular, the gpl40dN2.TNl antigens have induced consistent neutralizing responses against the subtype B SF162EnvDV2 and subtype C TV2 strains. Thus, TVl-based Env DΝA and protein-based antigens are immunogenic and induce high titer antibody responses reactive with both subtype C and subtype B HIV- 1 Env antigens. Neutralizing antibody responses against the neutralization sensitive subtype B R5 HIN-lSF162Dv2 strain were observed in some groups after only two DΝA immunizations. FoUowing a single booster immunization with Env protein, the majority of rabbits in groups that received N2-deleted forms of the TNI Env showed neutralization activity against the closely related subtype C TN2 primary strain.
Example 12 Immunological Responses in Rhesus Macaques CeUular and humoral immune responses were evaluated in three groups of rhesus macaques (each group was made up of four animals) in an immunization study structured as shown in Table I. The route of administration for the immunizing composition was electroporation in each case. Antibody titers are shown in Table I for two weeks post-second immunization. Table I
Figure imgf000119_0001
Figure imgf000120_0001
* pCMVgag = pCMVKnώ.GagMod Type C Botswana pCMVenv = pCMVLink.gpl40env.dV2.TVl (Type C) pCMVpol = pCMVKm2.p2Pol.mut.Ina Type C Botswana pCMVgag-pol = pCMVKm2.gagCpol.mut.Ina Type C Botswana
Pre-immune sera were obtained at week 0 before the first immunization. The first immunization was given at week 0. The second immunization was given at week 4. The first bleed was performed at 2 weeks post-second immunization (i.e., at week 6). A third immunization wiU be given at week 8 and a fourth at week 16. Aiiimals 2A, 3 A, 3B and 3D had been vaccinated previously (approximately 4 years or more) with gag plasmid DΝA or gag VLP (subtype B).
Bulk CTL, 51Cr-release assays, and flow ceU cytometry methods were used to obtain the data in Tables J and K. Reagents used for detecting gag- and pol-specific T-ceUs were (i) synthetic, overlapping peptides spanning "gagCpol" antigen (n=377), typicaUy the peptides were pools of 15-mers with overlap by 11, the pools were as foUows, pool 1, n=l-82, pool 2, n=83-164, pool 3, n=165-271, pool 4, n=272-377, accordingly pools 1 and 2 are "gag"-specific, and pools 3 and 4 are "pol"-specific, and (ii) recombinant vaccinia virus (rVV), for example, rVVgag965, rNNp2Pol975 (contains p2p7gag975), and NNwrparent.
Gag-specific IFΝγ + CD8 + T-cells, Gag-specific IFΝγ + CD4 + T-ceUs, Pol- specific IFΝγ + CD8 + T-ceUs, and Pol-specific IFΝγ + CD4 + T-ceUs in blood were determined for each animal described in Table I above, post second immunization. The results are presented in Tables J and K. It is possible that some of the pol-specific activity shown in Table K was directed against p2p7gag.
Figure imgf000121_0001
? = might be positive on rWp2Pol.
Figure imgf000122_0001
generating specific ceUular and humoral responses against the selected HIV- polypeptide antigens. Although preferred embodiments of the subject invention have been described in some detaU, it is understood that obvious variations can be made without departing from the spirit and the scope of the invention as defined by the appended claims.

Claims

What is claimed is:
1. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Gag polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Gag polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 90% sequence identity to a sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NO:9; SEQ ID NO:10; SEQ ID NO:ll; SEQ ID NO:12; and SEQ ID NO:16.
2. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Gag polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Gag polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 98% sequence identity to a sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NO: 13; SEQ ID NO: 14; SEQ ID NO: 15; and SEQ ID NO:55.
3. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Gag polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Gag polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 95% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 17.
4. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Nef polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Nef polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 90% sequence identity to a sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NO: 25; SEQ ID NO:26; SEQ ID NO:27; SEQ ID NO:28; SEQ ID NO:33 and SEQ ID NO:34.
5. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Prot polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Prot polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 98% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO:39.
6. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Tat polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Tat polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 90% sequence identity to a sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NO:42; SEQ ID NO:43; SEQ ID NO:51; SEQ ID NO:52; SEQ ID NO:53; SEQ ID NO:54; SEQ ID NO:56; and SEQ ID NO:57.
7. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Rev polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Rev polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 90% sequence identity to SEQ ID NO:45 or SEQ ID NO:45.
8. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Vif polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Vif polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 90% sequence identity to at least 30 contiguous base pairs of SEQ ID NO:58.
9. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Vpr polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Vpr polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 90% sequence identity to at least 20 contiguous base pairs of SEQ ID NO:59.
10. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Vpu polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Vpu polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 90% sequence identity to at least 20 contiguous base pairs of SEQ ID NO:60.
11. A recombinant expression system for use in a selected host ceU, comprising, an expression cassette of any of claims 1 to 10 or 57, and wherein said polynucleotide sequence is operably linked to control elements compatible with expression in the selected host ceU.
12. The recombinant expression system of claim 11, wherein said control elements are selected from the group consisting of a transcription promoter, a transcription enhancer element, a transcription termination signal, polyadenylation sequences, sequences for optimization of initiation of translation, and translation termination sequences.
13. The recombinant expression system of claim 11, wherein said transcription promoter is selected from the group consisting of CMV, CMV+intron A, SV40, RSV, HIV-Ltr, MMLV-ltr, and metaUothionein.
14. A ceU comprising an expression cassette of any of claims 1 to 10 or 57, and wherein said polynucleotide sequence is operably linked to control elements compatible with expression in the selected ceU.
15. The ceU of claim 14, wherein the ceU is a mammahan ceU.
16. The ceU of claim 15, wherein the ceU is selected from the group consisting of BHK, VERO, HT1080, 293, RD, COS-7, and CHO ceUs.
17. The ceU of claim 16, wherein said ceU is a CHO ceU.
18. The ceU of claim 14, wherein the ceU is an insect ceU.
19. The ceU of claim 18, wherein the ceU is either Trichoplusia ni (Tn5) or Sf9 insect ceUs.
20. The ceU of claim 14, wherein the ceU is a bacterial ceU.
21. The ceU of claim 14, wherein the ceU is a yeast ceU.
22. The ceU of claim 14, wherein the cell is a plant ceU.
23. The ceU of claim 14, wherein the ceU is an antigen presenting ceU.
24. The ceU of claim 23, wherein the antigen presenting ceU is a lymphoid ceU selected from the group consisting of macrophages, monocytes, dendritic ceUs, B-ceUs, T-ceUs, stem ceUs, and progenitor ceUs thereof.
25. The ceU of claim 14, wherein the ceU is a primary ceU.
26. The ceU of claim 14, wherein the ceU is an immortalized ceU.
27. The ceU of claim 14, wherein the ceU is a tumor-derived ceU.
28. A method for producing a polypeptide including HIV Gag polypeptide sequences, said method comprising, incubating the ceUs of claim 14, under conditions for producing said polypeptide.
29. A gene dehvery vector for use in a mammahan subject, comprising a suitable gene dehvery vector for use in said subject, wherein the vector comprises an expression cassette of any of claims 1 to 10 or 57, and wherein said polynucleotide sequence is operably linked to control elements compatible with expression in the subject.
30. A method of DNA immunization of a subject, comprising, introducing a gene dehvery vector of claim 29 into said subject under conditions that are compatible with expression of said expression cassette in said subject.
31. The method of claim 30, wherein said gene dehvery vector is a nonviral vector.
32. The method of claim 30, wherein said vector is dehvered using a particulate carrier.
33. The method of claim 32, wherein said vector is coated on a gold or tungsten particle and said coated particle is dehvered to said subject using a gene gun.
34. The method of claim 30, wherein said vector is encapsulated in a hposome preparation.
35. The method of claim 30, wherein said vector is a viral vector.
36. The method of claim 35, wherein said viral vector is a retroviral vector.
37. The method of claim 35, wherein said viral vector is an alphaviral vector.
38. The method of claim 35, wherein said viral vector is a lentiviral vector.
39. The method of claim 30, wherein said subject is a mammal.
40. The method of claim 39, wherein said mammal is a human.
41. A method of generating an immune response in a subject, comprising transfecting ceUs of said subject a gene deUvery vector of claim 29, under conditions that permit the expression of said polynucleotide and production of said polypeptide, thereby eliciting an immunological response to said polypeptide.
42. The method of claim 41, wherein said vector is a nonviral vector.
43. The method of claim 41, wherein said vector is dehvered using a particulate carrier.
44. The method of claim 43, wherein said vector is coated on a gold or tungsten particle and said coated particle is dehvered to said vertebrate cell using a gene gun.
45. The method of claim 41, wherein said vector is encapsulated in a hposome preparation.
46. The method of claim 41, wherein said vector is a viral vector.
47. The method of claim 46, wherein said viral vector is a retroviral vector.
48. The method of claim 46, wherein said viral vector is an alphaviral vector.
49. The method of claim 46, wherein said viral vector is a lentiviral vector.
50. The method of claim 41, wherein said subject is a mammal.
51. The method of claim 50, wherein said mammal is a human.
52. The method of claim 41, wherein said transfecting is done ex vivo and said transfected ceUs are reintroduced into said subject.
53. The method of claim 41, wherein said transfecting is done in vivo in said subject.
54. The method of claim 41 , where said immune response is a humoral immune response.
55. The method of claim 41 , where said immune response is a ceUular immune response.
56. The method of claim 41, wherein the gene dehvery vector is administered intramuscularly, intramucosally, intranasaUy, subcutaneously, intradermaUy, transdermaUy, intravaginaUy, intrarectaUy, oraUy or intravenously.
57. An expression cassette, comprising a polynucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide including an HIV Env polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide sequence encoding said Env polypeptide comprises a sequence having at least 90% sequence identity to a sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NO:61, SEQ ID NO:62, SEQ ID NO:63, and SEQ ID NO:64.
PCT/US2002/021342 2001-08-31 2002-07-05 Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type b polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof WO2003020876A2 (en)

Priority Applications (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
JP2003525580A JP2005521380A (en) 2001-08-31 2002-07-05 Polynucleotide encoding antigenic type B HIV polypeptide, polypeptide and use thereof
EP02746891A EP1427806A4 (en) 2001-08-31 2002-07-05 Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type b polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
CA2458995A CA2458995C (en) 2001-08-31 2002-07-05 Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type b polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
AU2002316578A AU2002316578A1 (en) 2001-08-31 2002-07-05 Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type b polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US31686001P 2001-08-31 2001-08-31
US60/316,860 2001-08-31
US34972802P 2002-01-16 2002-01-16
US60/349,728 2002-01-16

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2003020876A2 true WO2003020876A2 (en) 2003-03-13
WO2003020876A3 WO2003020876A3 (en) 2004-01-08

Family

ID=26980632

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2002/021342 WO2003020876A2 (en) 2001-08-31 2002-07-05 Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type b polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof

Country Status (7)

Country Link
US (3) US20030194800A1 (en)
EP (1) EP1427806A4 (en)
JP (3) JP2005521380A (en)
AU (1) AU2002316578A1 (en)
CA (1) CA2458995C (en)
WO (1) WO2003020876A2 (en)
ZA (1) ZA200402513B (en)

Cited By (9)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2004047861A1 (en) * 2002-11-26 2004-06-10 Eurocine Ab Vaccines against viruses with cationic substances as adjuvants
WO2006050394A2 (en) * 2004-11-01 2006-05-11 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics Inc. Combination approaches for generating immune responses
US7622125B2 (en) 2004-05-05 2009-11-24 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics, Inc. Polycistronic HIV vector constructs
EP1339738B1 (en) * 2000-07-05 2010-08-25 Novartis Vaccines and Diagnostics, Inc. Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type c polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
US7811580B2 (en) 2002-05-07 2010-10-12 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostics, Inc. Chimeric HIV Env proteins comprising CD4 mini-proteins or CD4 mimetics that are capable of inducing neutralizing antibody responses against cryptic Env epitopes
EP2382988A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2011-11-02 Novartis AG Combined mucosal and parenteral immunization against HIV
US8168194B2 (en) 2005-02-03 2012-05-01 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostics, Inc. Fusion proteins comprising CD4 minimal modules and human immunodeficiency virus (HIV) Tat scaffold polypeptides that are capable of binding to the HIV envelope and exposing cryptic neutralization epitopes
US8206720B2 (en) 2004-06-08 2012-06-26 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostics, Inc Fusion proteins comprising CD4 minimal modules and invasin polypeptides that are capable of binding to the HIV envelope and exposing cryptic neutraliziation epitopes
US20120328655A1 (en) * 2011-04-08 2012-12-27 Immune Design Corp. Immunogenic compositions and methods of using the compositions for inducing humoral and cellular immune responses

Families Citing this family (7)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
AU2002322009A1 (en) * 2001-05-18 2002-12-03 Mayo Foundation For Medical Education And Research Chimeric antigen-specific t cell-activating polypeptides
US20060222656A1 (en) * 2005-04-01 2006-10-05 University Of Maryland, Baltimore MAGE-A3/HPV 16 peptide vaccines for head and neck cancer
CA2501476A1 (en) * 2002-10-07 2004-04-22 Chiron Corporation Hiv vaccine formulations
EP3795694A3 (en) 2012-10-02 2021-06-23 The General Hospital Corporation d/b/a Massachusetts General Hospital Methods relating to dna-sensing pathway related conditions
EP3103807B1 (en) * 2014-02-06 2021-08-25 Japan Science And Technology Agency Peptide/ beta-1,3-glucan complex and production method therefor, and pharmaceutical composition containing peptide/ beta-1,3-glucan complex
KR20220047277A (en) 2019-07-16 2022-04-15 길리애드 사이언시즈, 인코포레이티드 HIV Vaccines, and Methods of Making and Using the Same
EP4277652A1 (en) 2021-01-14 2023-11-22 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Hiv vaccines and methods of using

Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2000039302A2 (en) * 1998-12-31 2000-07-06 Chiron Corporation Improved expression of hiv polypeptides and production of virus-like particles
WO2000039304A2 (en) * 1998-12-31 2000-07-06 Chiron Corporation Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type c polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
WO2002004493A2 (en) * 2000-07-05 2002-01-17 Chiron Corporation Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type c polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof

Family Cites Families (91)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5364773A (en) * 1991-03-07 1994-11-15 Virogenetics Corporation Genetically engineered vaccine strain
US4652639A (en) * 1982-05-06 1987-03-24 Amgen Manufacture and expression of structural genes
US4518584A (en) * 1983-04-15 1985-05-21 Cetus Corporation Human recombinant interleukin-2 muteins
US6001977A (en) * 1984-08-22 1999-12-14 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Cloning and expression of HTLV-III DNA
US5032510A (en) * 1984-09-26 1991-07-16 Eli Lilly And Company Method for expression and secretion in bacillus
CA1341482C (en) * 1984-10-31 2005-05-10 Paul A. Luciw Process for preparing fragments of aids-associated retroviruses
JPS62501263A (en) 1984-11-29 1987-05-21 スクリツプス クリニツク アンド リサ−チ フアウンデ−シヨン Polypeptides and antibodies associated with deglycosylated viral glycoproteins
AU600658B2 (en) 1984-12-24 1990-08-23 Genentech Inc. Molecularly cloned acquired immunodeficiency syndrome polypeptides and their methods of use
DK171119B1 (en) 1985-04-19 1996-06-17 Hoffmann La Roche AIDS virus envelope protein, expression vector carrying the envelope protein, transformants transformed with the expression vector, method of producing the virus envelope protein, method of detecting AIDS antibodies, method of determining AIDS virus, vaccine against AIDS, antibodies against the virus envelope protein and use of it to prepare a vaccine and for testing
ATE108022T1 (en) 1985-10-24 1994-07-15 Southwest Found Biomed Res SYNTHETIC PEPTIDES AND THEIR USE IN DIAGNOSIS AND VACCINATION FOR AIDS AND ARC.
EP0242216A1 (en) 1986-04-16 1987-10-21 THE UNITED STATES OF AMERICA as represented by the Secretary United States Department of Commerce Non-cytopathic clone of Human T-Cell Lymphotropic Virus type III
JPH01500432A (en) 1986-07-21 1989-02-16 サウスウェスト・ファウンデーション・フォー・バイオメディカル・リサーチ Compositions and methods for immunizing against viral agents of AIDS and ARC
US4861707A (en) * 1987-02-02 1989-08-29 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Human immunodeficiency virus antigen
US5256767A (en) * 1987-06-10 1993-10-26 The Immune Response Corporation Retroviral antigens
ATE207535T1 (en) 1987-06-22 2001-11-15 Medeva Holdings Bv HEPATITIS B SURFACE ANTIGEN CONTAINING PEPTIDE
US5637677A (en) * 1987-07-16 1997-06-10 The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania Biologically active compounds and methods of constructing and using the same
US5128319A (en) * 1987-08-28 1992-07-07 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Prophylaxis and therapy of acquired immunodeficiency syndrome
AU2914889A (en) 1987-08-28 1989-04-17 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Prophylaxis and therapy of acquired immunodeficiency syndrome
EP0347435A4 (en) 1987-09-04 1991-11-21 Biogen, Inc. Dna sequences, recombinant dna molecules and processes for producing soluble t4 proteins
US5879907A (en) * 1987-09-14 1999-03-09 Skandigen Ab Artificial gene coding for authentic human serum albumin, use thereof and method
PT88641B (en) 1987-10-02 1993-04-30 Genentech Inc METHOD FOR PREPARING A VARIETY OF ADHESION
IL87902A0 (en) 1987-10-08 1989-03-31 Dana Farber Cancer Inst Inc Soluble human cd4 fragments and applications thereof
US5714596A (en) * 1987-11-18 1998-02-03 Chiron Corporation NANBV diagnostics: polynucleotides useful for screening for hepatitis C virus
US5712088A (en) * 1987-11-18 1998-01-27 Chiron Corporation Methods for detecting Hepatitis C virus using polynucleotides specific for same
US5683864A (en) * 1987-11-18 1997-11-04 Chiron Corporation Combinations of hepatitis C virus (HCV) antigens for use in immunoassays for anti-HCV antibodies
CA1340748C (en) 1988-07-13 1999-09-14 Stephen Oroszlan Synthetic hiv protease gene and method for its expression
WO1990002568A1 (en) * 1988-09-13 1990-03-22 Chiron Corporation Hiv-1 envelope muteins lacking hypervariable domains
AU640619B2 (en) 1988-10-03 1993-09-02 Repligen Corporation Hiv proteins and peptides useful in the diagnosis, prophylaxis or therapy of aids
CA2003383A1 (en) * 1988-11-23 1990-05-23 Sushil G. Devare Synthetic dna derived recombinant hiv antigens
US5082767A (en) * 1989-02-27 1992-01-21 Hatfield G Wesley Codon pair utilization
IL93682A (en) 1989-03-16 1996-06-18 Yeda Res & Dev Polycyclic compounds having antiviral activity their use in the manufacture of medicaments and pharmaceutical compositions containing them
WO1990011359A1 (en) 1989-03-20 1990-10-04 Whitehead Institute For Biomedical Research Intracellular method of inhibiting hiv in mammalian cells
US6214804B1 (en) * 1989-03-21 2001-04-10 Vical Incorporated Induction of a protective immune response in a mammal by injecting a DNA sequence
DE69034078T2 (en) 1989-03-21 2004-04-01 Vical, Inc., San Diego Expression of exogenous polynucleotide sequences in vertebrates
AU5421090A (en) 1989-04-05 1990-11-05 United States of America, as represented by the Secretary, U.S. Department of Commerce, The A clone of double-stranded rna virus and applications thereof
JP3034025B2 (en) 1989-06-01 2000-04-17 アプライド・バイオテクノロジー・インコーポレーテツド Self-assembled deficient non-self-replicating virions
US5130247A (en) * 1989-09-19 1992-07-14 Merck & Co., Inc. Expression of fusion protein of HIV envelope and HBsAG
ES2072346T3 (en) * 1989-10-23 1995-07-16 Hoffmann La Roche SYNTHETIC PEPTIDES ON THE HTLV-I COVER.
US5876724A (en) * 1990-03-19 1999-03-02 Institut Pasteur Induction of neutralizing antibody against viral infection by synergy between virus envelope glycoprotein and peptides corresponding to neutralization epitopes of the glycoprotein
ES2140380T5 (en) 1990-03-21 2005-03-16 Geneart Gmbh DNA SEQUENCES CODING MODIFIED RETROVIRIC GAG POLYPEPTIDES AND VACCINES CONTAINING OR ADDED THEMSELVES.
US5840313A (en) * 1990-09-27 1998-11-24 Syntello Vaccine Development Kb Peptides for use in vaccination and induction of neutralizing antibodies against human immunodeficiency virus
DK0564531T3 (en) * 1990-12-03 1998-09-28 Genentech Inc Enrichment procedure for variant proteins with altered binding properties
PT100090A (en) * 1991-02-04 1993-07-30 Univ Saskatchewan Method for targeting and release of drugs
WO1992015318A1 (en) * 1991-03-07 1992-09-17 Seragen, Inc. Use of cell surface receptor targeted molecules for the treatment of viral diseases
US5665569A (en) * 1991-08-22 1997-09-09 Nissin Shokuhin Kabushiki Kaisha HIV immunotherapeutics
DE69232859T2 (en) * 1991-09-13 2003-04-10 Chiron Corp. (N.D.Ges.D. Staates Delaware), Emeryville COMPOSITION OF SEVERAL IMMUNE REACTIVE HEPATITIS C VIRUS POLYPEPTIDES
US6025126A (en) * 1991-10-28 2000-02-15 Arch Development Corporation Methods and compositions for the detection of chromosomal aberrations
US6174666B1 (en) * 1992-03-27 2001-01-16 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Method of eliminating inhibitory/instability regions from mRNA
AU687736B2 (en) 1992-05-11 1998-03-05 Ribozyme Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method and reagent for inhibiting viral replication
US5663169A (en) * 1992-08-07 1997-09-02 Merck & Co., Inc. Benzoxazinones as inhibitors of HIV reverse transcriptase
DE4228458A1 (en) * 1992-08-27 1994-06-01 Beiersdorf Ag Multicistronic expression units and their use
FR2695563B1 (en) * 1992-09-11 1994-12-02 Pasteur Institut Microparticles carrying antigens and their use for the induction of humoral or cellular responses.
US6004763A (en) * 1992-09-11 1999-12-21 Institut Pasteur Antigen-carrying microparticles and their use in the induction of humoral or cellular responses
US5686078A (en) * 1992-09-14 1997-11-11 Connaught Laboratories, Inc. Primary and secondary immunization with different physio-chemical forms of antigen
CA2105629A1 (en) * 1992-09-14 1994-03-15 Robert S. Becker Potentiation of immunogenic response
US5304472A (en) * 1992-11-20 1994-04-19 Genentech, Inc. Method of controlling polypeptide production in bacterial cells
WO1994013804A1 (en) * 1992-12-04 1994-06-23 Medical Research Council Multivalent and multispecific binding proteins, their manufacture and use
JP3658690B2 (en) * 1993-01-16 2005-06-08 マンフレート シャヴァラー Methods for obtaining natural domains of viral membrane proteins, especially their use as vaccines against HIV
US5593972A (en) * 1993-01-26 1997-01-14 The Wistar Institute Genetic immunization
JP4108118B2 (en) 1993-03-26 2008-06-25 ジェン−プローブ・インコーポレイテッド Detection of human immunodeficiency virus type 1
US5419900A (en) * 1993-05-19 1995-05-30 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Of Health And Human Services Immunologic enhancement with intermittent interleukin-2 therapy
AU700371B2 (en) * 1993-06-07 1999-01-07 Genentech Inc. Hiv envelope polypeptides
EP0702693A1 (en) * 1993-06-09 1996-03-27 Connaught Laboratories Limited Tandem synthetic hiv-1 peptides
US5614413A (en) * 1993-07-01 1997-03-25 The Uab Research Foundation Encapsidated recombinant poliovirus nucleic acid and methods of making and using same
US5955342A (en) * 1994-08-15 1999-09-21 Connaught Laboratories Limited Non-infectious, replication-defective, self-assembling HIV-1 viral particles containing antigenic markers in the gag coding region
US6291157B1 (en) * 1998-02-23 2001-09-18 Connaught Laboratories Limited Antigenically-marked non-infectious retrovirus-like particles
US6080408A (en) * 1994-08-22 2000-06-27 Connaught Laboratories Limited Human immunodeficiency virus type 1 nucleic acids devoid of long terminal repeats capable of encoding for non-infectious, immunogenic, retrovirus-like particles
US5795737A (en) * 1994-09-19 1998-08-18 The General Hospital Corporation High level expression of proteins
US5786464C1 (en) * 1994-09-19 2012-04-24 Gen Hospital Corp Overexpression of mammalian and viral proteins
US5550280A (en) * 1994-11-30 1996-08-27 Uniroyal Chemical Ltd./ Uniroyal Chemical Ltee Hindered aromatic ester compounds useful as anti-viral agents
US5846456A (en) * 1996-01-17 1998-12-08 National Science Council Method of making gradient index optical element
CU22559A1 (en) * 1996-01-17 1999-05-03 Ct Ingenieria Genetica Biotech EXPRESSION SYSTEM OF HETEROLOGICAL ANTIGENS IN E. COLI AS FUSION PROTEINS
US5741492A (en) * 1996-01-23 1998-04-21 St. Jude Children's Research Hospital Preparation and use of viral vectors for mixed envelope protein vaccines against human immunodeficiency viruses
US6087486A (en) * 1996-01-29 2000-07-11 The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania Nucleotide sequences encoding vpr receptor protein
US6060587A (en) * 1996-01-29 2000-05-09 The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania Cellular receptor for HIV-1 VPR essential for G2/M phase transition of the cell cycle
US5951975A (en) * 1996-06-28 1999-09-14 University Of Pittsburgh Induction of CTLs specific for natural antigens by cross priming immunization
EP0942972B1 (en) * 1996-09-06 2002-12-04 The Regents Of The University Of California E25a PROTEIN, METHODS FOR PRODUCTION AND USE THEREOF
US6114148C1 (en) * 1996-09-20 2012-05-01 Gen Hospital Corp High level expression of proteins
US6139833A (en) * 1997-08-08 2000-10-31 Lexicon Genetics Incorporated Targeted gene discovery
US5858675A (en) * 1997-05-13 1999-01-12 Incyte Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Double-stranded RNA-binding protein
US6099847A (en) * 1997-05-15 2000-08-08 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Chimeric Gag pseudovirions
FR2768621B1 (en) * 1997-09-22 2000-04-07 Oreal USE OF AN EXTRACT OF AT LEAST ONE PLANT FROM THE ROSACEA FAMILY
US5932442A (en) * 1997-09-23 1999-08-03 Incyte Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Human regulatory molecules
US5932445A (en) * 1997-11-07 1999-08-03 Incyte Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Signal peptide-containing proteins
IT1297090B1 (en) * 1997-12-01 1999-08-03 Barbara Ensoli TAT OF HIV-1 OR ITS DERIVATIVES, ALONE OR IN COMBINATION, FOR VACCINAL, PROPHYLACTIC AND THERAPEUTIC PURPOSES, AGAINST AIDS, CANCERS AND
JP2002511257A (en) * 1998-04-14 2002-04-16 カイロン コーポレイション Non-cloning technology for expressing the gene of interest
US6090388A (en) * 1998-06-20 2000-07-18 United Biomedical Inc. Peptide composition for prevention and treatment of HIV infection and immune disorders
ES2299276T3 (en) * 1998-12-31 2008-05-16 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics, Inc. MODIFIED HIV ENV POLIPEPTIDES.
EP2278022A3 (en) * 1999-11-01 2011-05-18 Novartis Vaccines and Diagnostics, Inc. Expression vectors, transfection systems, and method of use thereof
WO2001045748A1 (en) * 1999-12-22 2001-06-28 Merck & Co., Inc. Polynucleotide vaccines expressing codon optimized hiv-1 pol and modified hiv-1 pol
US7622125B2 (en) * 2004-05-05 2009-11-24 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics, Inc. Polycistronic HIV vector constructs

Patent Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2000039302A2 (en) * 1998-12-31 2000-07-06 Chiron Corporation Improved expression of hiv polypeptides and production of virus-like particles
WO2000039304A2 (en) * 1998-12-31 2000-07-06 Chiron Corporation Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type c polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
WO2002004493A2 (en) * 2000-07-05 2002-01-17 Chiron Corporation Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type c polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof

Non-Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
See also references of EP1427806A2 *

Cited By (20)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
EP1339738B1 (en) * 2000-07-05 2010-08-25 Novartis Vaccines and Diagnostics, Inc. Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type c polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
US7811580B2 (en) 2002-05-07 2010-10-12 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostics, Inc. Chimeric HIV Env proteins comprising CD4 mini-proteins or CD4 mimetics that are capable of inducing neutralizing antibody responses against cryptic Env epitopes
US8470334B2 (en) 2002-05-07 2013-06-25 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostics, Inc Method of inducing an antiviral immune response against HIV-1 utilizing chimeric HIV Env proteins comprising CD4 mini-proteins or CD4 mimetics
US8226955B2 (en) 2002-05-07 2012-07-24 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostics, Inc Chimeric HIV Env proteins comprising CD4 mini-proteins or CD4 mimetics that are capable of inducing neutralizing antibody responses against cryptic Env epitopes
WO2004047861A1 (en) * 2002-11-26 2004-06-10 Eurocine Ab Vaccines against viruses with cationic substances as adjuvants
US8173137B2 (en) 2004-05-05 2012-05-08 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics, Inc. Polycistronic HIV vector constructs
US7622125B2 (en) 2004-05-05 2009-11-24 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics, Inc. Polycistronic HIV vector constructs
US8568734B2 (en) 2004-06-08 2013-10-29 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics Inc. Method for generating immune responses utilizing nucleic acids encoding fusion proteins comprising CD4 minimal modules and invasin polypeptides that are capable of binding to the HIV envelope and exposing cryptic neutralization epitopes
US8206720B2 (en) 2004-06-08 2012-06-26 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostics, Inc Fusion proteins comprising CD4 minimal modules and invasin polypeptides that are capable of binding to the HIV envelope and exposing cryptic neutraliziation epitopes
WO2006050394A3 (en) * 2004-11-01 2006-08-24 Chiron Corp Combination approaches for generating immune responses
EP2266602A2 (en) 2004-11-01 2010-12-29 Novartis Vaccines and Diagnostics, Inc. Combination approaches for generating immune responses
WO2006050394A2 (en) * 2004-11-01 2006-05-11 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics Inc. Combination approaches for generating immune responses
EP2266602A3 (en) * 2004-11-01 2011-08-10 Novartis Vaccines and Diagnostics, Inc. Combination approaches for generating immune responses
US8168194B2 (en) 2005-02-03 2012-05-01 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostics, Inc. Fusion proteins comprising CD4 minimal modules and human immunodeficiency virus (HIV) Tat scaffold polypeptides that are capable of binding to the HIV envelope and exposing cryptic neutralization epitopes
US8637044B2 (en) 2005-02-03 2014-01-28 Novartis Ag Method of generating an immune response in a subject using fusion proteins comprising CD4 minimal modules and HIV Tat scaffold polypeptides that are capable of binding to the HIV envelope and exposing cryptic neutralization epitopes
EP2382988A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2011-11-02 Novartis AG Combined mucosal and parenteral immunization against HIV
US20120328655A1 (en) * 2011-04-08 2012-12-27 Immune Design Corp. Immunogenic compositions and methods of using the compositions for inducing humoral and cellular immune responses
CN103596586A (en) * 2011-04-08 2014-02-19 免疫设计公司 Immunogenic compositions and methods of using the compositions for inducing humoral and cellular immune responses
US9044420B2 (en) * 2011-04-08 2015-06-02 Immune Design Corp. Immunogenic compositions and methods of using the compositions for inducing humoral and cellular immune responses
EP2694099B1 (en) * 2011-04-08 2019-10-16 Immune Design Corp. Immunogenic compositions and methods of using the compositions for inducing humoral and cellular immune responses

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
EP1427806A4 (en) 2006-04-26
US8263394B2 (en) 2012-09-11
JP2013146270A (en) 2013-08-01
US20060057115A1 (en) 2006-03-16
WO2003020876A3 (en) 2004-01-08
AU2002316578A1 (en) 2003-03-18
CA2458995C (en) 2013-04-30
US20090004733A1 (en) 2009-01-01
CA2458995A1 (en) 2003-03-13
EP1427806A2 (en) 2004-06-16
JP2005521380A (en) 2005-07-21
US20030194800A1 (en) 2003-10-16
JP2009254383A (en) 2009-11-05
ZA200402513B (en) 2005-11-30

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US9598469B2 (en) HIV-1 south african subtype C env proteins
US7943375B2 (en) Polynucleotides encoding antigenic HIV type C polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
US8263394B2 (en) Polynucleotides encoding antigenic HIV type B polypeptides, polypeptides, and uses thereof
EP2311958B1 (en) Polynucleotides encoding antigenic HIV type C polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
US20080095833A1 (en) Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type b polypeptides, polypeptides, and uses thereof
US20030198621A1 (en) Polynucleotides encoding antigenic HIV type B and/or type C polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
CA2785699A1 (en) Polynucleotides encoding antigenic hiv type c polypeptides, polypeptides and uses thereof
EP1535995A1 (en) Polynucleotides encoding the antigenic HIV type C env polypeptide and uses thereof

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AK Designated states

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): AL AM AT AU AZ BA BB BG BR BY CH CN CU CZ DE DK EE ES FI GB GD GH GM HR HU ID IL IN IS JP KE KG KR KZ LC LK LR LS LT LU LV MD MK MN MW MX NO NZ PL PT RO RU SE SG SI SK SL TJ TM TR TT UA UG UZ VN YU ZA

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): AL AM AT AU AZ BA BB BG BR BY CA CH CN CU CZ DE DK EE ES FI GB GD GE GH GM HR HU ID IL IN IS JP KE KG KP KR KZ LC LK LR LS LT LU LV MD MG MK MN MW MX NO NZ PL PT RO RU SD SE SG SI SK SL TJ TM TR TT UA UG US UZ VN YU ZA ZW

AL Designated countries for regional patents

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): GH GM KE LS MW MZ SD SL SZ TZ UG ZM ZW AM AZ BY KG KZ MD RU TJ TM AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE ES FI FR GB GR IE IT LU MC NL PT SE SK TR BF BJ CF CG CI CM GA GN GQ GW ML MR NE SN TD TG

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): GH GM KE LS MW MZ SD SL SZ UG ZM ZW AM AZ BY KG KZ RU TJ TM AT BE BG CH CY CZ DK EE ES FI FR GB GR IE IT LU MC PT SE SK TR BF BJ CF CG CI GA GN GQ GW ML MR NE SN TD TG

121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application
DFPE Request for preliminary examination filed prior to expiration of 19th month from priority date (pct application filed before 20040101)
WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2458995

Country of ref document: CA

Ref document number: 2003525580

Country of ref document: JP

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2002746891

Country of ref document: EP

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 00403/KOLNP/2004

Country of ref document: IN

Ref document number: 403/KOLNP/2004

Country of ref document: IN

WWP Wipo information: published in national office

Ref document number: 2002746891

Country of ref document: EP